firstcal-10k_123111.htm


UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, DC 20549

Form 10-K 
 
þ
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
   
 
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011
   
 
OR
   
o
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
   
 
For the transition period from __________________to __________________
 
Commission file number 000-52498
 
FIRST CALIFORNIA FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)
   
Delaware
 
38-3737811
(State or Other Jurisdiction of
Incorporation or Organization)
 
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)
     
3027 Townsgate Road, Suite 300
Westlake Village, California
 
91361
(Address of Principal Executive Offices)
 
(Zip Code)
 
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (805) 322-9655
 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act:
 
Title of Each Class
 
Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered
Common Stock, $0.01 par value
 
The Nasdaq Global Select Market
 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act: None
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. o Yes þ No
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act. o Yes þ No
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. þ Yes o No
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes þ No o
 
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. o
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
 
Large accelerated filer o
Accelerated filer þ
Non-accelerated filer o
Smaller reporting company o
 
(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). o Yes þ No
 
Aggregate market value of common stock held by non-affiliates as of June 30, 2011: $80,865,130
 
As of March 12, 2012, there were 29,249,104 shares of Common Stock, $0.01 par value, outstanding.
 
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
 


 
 

 
 
INDEX
 
Part I    
       
   
1
       
   
15
       
   
23
       
   
24
       
   
25
       
   
25
       
Part II    
       
   
26
       
   
27
       
   
28
       
   
60
       
   
61
       
   
113
       
   
113
       
   
114
       
Part III    
       
   
115
       
   
115
       
   
115
       
   
115
       
   
115
       
Part IV    
       
   
115
       
Signatures   122
       
Certifications    
 
 
 

 
 
PART I
 
Item 1.
 
Our Business
 
As used herein, the term “First California Financial Group,” “First California,” “FCAL,” “the Company,” “our,” “us,” “we” or similar expression includes First California Financial Group, Inc. and First California Bank unless the context indicates otherwise.
 
Business of First California Financial Group
 
First California is a bank holding company registered under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, or the BHCA. First California’s primary function is to coordinate the general policies and activities of its bank subsidiary, First California Bank, or the Bank, as well as to consider from time to time other legally available investment opportunities. SC Financial is an inactive subsidiary of First California.
 
First California incorporated under the laws of the State of Delaware on June 7, 2006. The Company formed as a wholly-owned subsidiary of National Mercantile Bancorp, a California corporation, or National Mercantile, for the purposes of facilitating the mergers of National Mercantile and FCB Bancorp, a California corporation, or FCB. On March 12, 2007, National Mercantile merged with and into First California. Immediately thereafter, the parties completed the previously announced merger of FCB with and into First California. In this document, we refer to the two-step merger of National Mercantile into First California and FCB into First California as the Mergers. As a result of the Mergers, the separate corporate existence of National Mercantile and FCB ceased, and First California succeeded, and assumed all the rights and obligations of, National Mercantile, whose principal assets were the capital stock of two bank subsidiaries, Mercantile National Bank, or Mercantile, and South Bay Bank, N.A., or South Bay, and the rights and obligations of FCB, whose principal assets was the capital stock of First California Bank. On June 18, 2007, First California integrated its bank subsidiaries into First California Bank. All references to the Bank on or before June 18, 2007 refer to the Bank, Mercantile and South Bay.
 
Business of First California Bank
 
The Bank is a full-service commercial bank headquartered in Westlake Village, California. The Bank is chartered under the laws of the State of California and is subject to supervision by the California Department of Financial Institutions, or the DFI. The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, or the FDIC, insures its deposits up to the maximum legal limit.
 
On November 5, 2010, the Bank assumed certain liabilities and acquired certain assets and substantially all of the operations of Western Commercial Bank, or WCB, located in Woodland Hills, California, from the FDIC. The Bank acquired, received and recognized certain assets with an estimated fair value of approximately $109 million, including $55 million of loans, $32 million of cash, $16.7 million of a FDIC shared-loss asset, $2 million of securities and $3 million of other assets. Liabilities with an estimated fair value of approximately $107 million were also assumed and recognized, including $105 million of deposits and $2 million of other liabilities. The Bank recorded a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $2.3 million in connection with this transaction. The transaction increased the number of the Bank’s full-service branch locations to 18 and the Bank fully integrated the former WCB branch into its full-service branch network prior to December 31, 2010.
 
On February 18, 2011, the Bank assumed certain liabilities and acquired certain assets and substantially all of the operations of San Luis Trust Bank, or SLTB, located in San Luis Obispo, California, from the FDIC. The Bank acquired, received and recognized certain assets with an estimated fair value of approximately $367 million, including $139 million of loans, $99 million of cash and federal funds sold, $70 million of a FDIC shared-loss asset, $41 million of securities, $13 million of foreclosed property and $5 million of other assets. Liabilities with an estimated fair value of approximately $346 million were also assumed and recognized, including $266 million of deposits, $62 million of Federal Home Loan Bank advances, $15 million in a deferred tax liability, $2.6 million of a FDIC shared-loss liability and $0.4 million of other liabilities. The Bank recorded a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $36.5 million in connection with this transaction. This transaction increased the number of the Bank’s full-service branch locations to 19 and the Bank fully integrated the former SLTB branch into its full-service branch network in June 2011.
 
On April 8, 2011, the Bank completed the acquisition of the Electronic Banking Solutions division of Palm Desert National Bank. The transaction included the division’s customer base, core deposits, and employees. The Electronic Payment Services Division, or the EPS division, its new name under the Bank, issues prepaid cards and sponsors merchant acquiring services for all national and regional networks, including Visa, MasterCard, and Discover throughout all 50 states and U.S. territories. The Bank acquired cash of $85.4 million, recognized intangible assets of $6.0 million, assumed $91 million of deposits and recognized a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $0.5 million in connection with this transaction.
 
The Bank’s business strategy has been to attract individuals, professionals, and small- to mid-sized business borrowers in our primary service areas by offering a variety of loan products and a full range of banking services coupled with highly personalized service. The Bank’s operations are primarily located within the areas commonly known as the “101 corridor” stretching from the City of Ventura to Calabasas, California, the Moorpark-Simi Valley corridor, the western San Fernando Valley, the Tri-Cities area of Glendale-Burbank-Pasadena, the South Bay, the Inland Empire, north San Diego County, Century City and other parts of Los Angeles, Orange, San Luis Obispo and Ventura Counties in Southern California. Our lending products include revolving lines of credit, term loans, commercial real estate loans, construction loans and consumer and home equity loans, which often contain terms and conditions tailored to meet the specific demands of the market niche in which the borrower operates. Additionally, the Bank provides a wide array of deposit products serving the comprehensive banking needs of businesses and consumers in Los Angeles, Orange, Ventura, San Diego, Riverside, San Bernardino and San Luis Obispo counties through traditional business and consumer banking, construction finance, SBA lending, entertainment finance and commercial real estate lending via 19 full-service branch locations.
 
 
1

 
 
Business loans, represented by commercial mortgage loans, commercial loans and construction loans, comprise the largest portion of the Bank’s loan portfolio. Commercial real estate loans rely upon the cash flow originating from the underlying real property. Commercial real estate is a cyclical industry that is affected not only by general economic conditions but also by local supply and demand. Commercial loans rely upon the cash flow originating from the underlying business activity of the enterprise. The manufacture, distribution or sale of goods or sale of services are not only affected by general economic conditions but also by the ability of the enterprise’s management to adjust to local supply and demand conditions, maintain good labor, vendor and customer relationships, as well as market and sell their goods or services for a profit. Construction loans provide developers or owners with funds to build or improve properties that will ultimately be sold or leased. Construction loans are generally considered to involve a higher degree of risk than other loan categories because they rely upon the developer’s or owner’s ability to complete the project within specified cost and time limits.
 
Consumer loans, a smaller component of the Bank’s loan portfolio, are represented by home mortgages and home equity loans and lines of credit that are secured by first or second trust deeds on a borrower’s real estate property, typically their principal residence. These loans are dependent on a person’s ability to regularly pay the principal and interest due on the loan and, secondarily, on the value of real estate property that serves as collateral for the loan.
 
The Bank’s business strategy also stresses the importance of customer deposit relationships to support its lending activities. Checking deposits, savings deposits and certificates of deposit represent a significant low-cost and stable source of funds. Business customers are offered cash management products, including on-line banking and remote deposit capture, to meet their specific banking needs.
 
The Bank’s goal is to offer its customers a consistently high level of individualized personal service. Accordingly, in order to meet the changing needs of our customers, the Bank is constantly evaluating a variety of options to broaden the services and products it provides. The Bank’s strategy in attaining its goals has been to implement and maintain risk management and controls to achieve a safe and sound business policy, employing an aggressive marketing plan which emphasizes relationship banking and the “personal touch,” offering competitive products and managing growth. The Bank provides convenience through 19 banking offices with ATM access, 24 hour telephone access to account information, on-line banking, courier service and remote deposit capture. The diversity of our delivery systems enables customers to choose the method of banking that is most convenient for them. The Bank trains its staff to recognize each customer, greet them, and be able to address them by name so that they feel as if they have a “private banker.”
 
Financial and Statistical Disclosure
 
Certain of our financial and statistical information is presented within “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.” This information should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements contained in “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”
 
Competition
 
The banking business in California, generally, and in the Bank’s service areas, specifically, is highly competitive with respect to both loans and deposits and is dominated by a number of major banks that have many offices operating over wide geographic areas. The Bank competes for deposits and loans principally with these major banks and other financial institutions located in our market areas. Among the advantages that the major banks have over the Bank are their ability to finance extensive advertising campaigns and to allocate their investment assets to regions of highest yield and demand. Many of the major commercial banks operating in the Bank’s service areas offer certain services (such as trust and international banking services) that are not offered directly by the Bank and, by virtue of their greater total capitalization, such banks have substantially higher lending limits. Moreover, all banks face increasing competition for loans and deposits from non-bank financial intermediaries such as mortgage companies, insurance companies, credit unions and securities firms.
 
In November 1999, the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, or the GLBA, was signed into law. The GLBA significantly changed the regulatory structure and oversight of the financial services industry. The GLBA revised the BHCA and repealed the affiliation prohibitions of the Glass-Steagall Act of 1933. Consequently, a qualifying holding company, called a financial holding company, can engage in a full range of financial activities, including banking, insurance, and securities activities, as well as merchant banking and additional activities that are “financial in nature” or “incidental” to those financial activities. Expanded financial affiliation opportunities for existing bank holding companies are now permitted. Moreover, various non-bank financial services providers can acquire banks while also offering services like securities underwriting and underwriting and brokering insurance products. The GLBA also expanded passive investment activities by financial holding companies, permitting investments in any type of company, financial or non-financial, through acquisitions of merchant banking firms and insurance companies.
 
 
2

 
 
Given that the traditional distinctions between banks and other providers of financial services have been effectively eliminated, the Bank has faced and will continue to face additional competition from thrift institutions, credit unions, insurance companies and securities firms. Additionally, the Bank’s ability to cross-market banking products to existing customers or the customers of affiliated companies may make it more difficult to compete.
 
In order to compete, the Bank uses to the fullest extent possible the familiarity of its directors and officers with the market area and its residents and businesses and the flexibility that the Bank’s independent status will permit. This includes an emphasis on specialized services, local promotional activity, and personal contacts by directors, officers and other employees. The Bank uses advertising, including newspaper ads and direct mail pieces, to inform the community of the services it offers. The Bank also utilizes emerging marketing techniques, such as the Internet, to reach target markets. The Bank also has an active calling program where officers, including commissioned business development officers, contact targeted prospects to solicit both deposit and loan business.
 
The Bank has developed programs that specifically address the needs of consumers, professionals and small-to medium-sized businesses. In the event there are customers whose loan demands exceed the Bank’s lending limits, it arranges for such loans on a participation basis with other financial institutions and intermediaries. The Bank also assists those customers requiring other services not offered by the Bank to obtain those services from correspondent banks. In addition, the Bank offers ATM services, a night depository, remote deposit capture, courier services, bank-by-mail services, merchant windows, lockbox and direct deposit services.
 
The Bank’s management believes that the Bank’s reputation in the communities served and personal service philosophy enhance the ability to compete favorably in attracting and retaining individual, professional and business clients. The Bank also believes that it has an advantage over the larger national and “super regional” institutions because it is managed by locally-known, well-respected and experienced bankers. Moreover, our larger competitors may not offer adequate personalized banking services, since their emphasis is on large volume and standardized retail products.
 
The Bank also faces growing competition from other community banks. These institutions have similar marketing strategies, have also been successful and offer strong evidence regarding the potential success of the community banking sector.
 
No assurance can be given that ongoing efforts to compete will continue to be successful.
 
Dependence on One or a Few Major Customers; Business Concentrations
 
No individual or single group of related accounts is considered material in relation to our total assets or to the assets or deposits of the Bank, or in relation to our overall business. However, approximately 82% of our loan portfolio at December 31, 2011 consisted of real estate-secured loans, including commercial real estate loans, construction loans, home mortgage loans, home equity loans and lines of credit. See “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Financial Position — December 31, 2011 compared with December 31, 2010” in Part II of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Moreover, our business activities are currently focused primarily in Southern California, with the majority of our business concentrated in Ventura, Orange and Los Angeles Counties. Consequently, our results of operations and financial condition are dependent upon the general trends in the Southern California economies and, in particular, the residential and commercial real estate markets. In addition, the concentration of our operations in Southern California exposes us to greater risk than other banking companies with a wider geographic base in the event of catastrophes, such as earthquakes, fires and floods in this region.
 
Internet Banking Services
 
The Bank maintains an internet website, which serves as an additional means of providing customer access to a variety of banking services, including 24/7 online banking. The Bank’s website address is www.fcbank.com. No information contained on the website is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Employees
 
At December 31, 2011, the Bank had 304 full-time equivalent employees. The Bank’s employees are not represented by any union or other collective bargaining agreement and the Bank considers its relations with employees to be excellent.
 
 
3

 
 
Supervision and Regulation
 
Recent Developments
 
On July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, or Dodd-Frank, was signed into law. Dodd-Frank will have a broad impact on the financial services industry and will impose significant new regulatory and compliance requirements, including the designation of certain financial companies as systemically significant, the imposition of increased capital, leverage and liquidity requirements, and numerous other provisions designed to improve supervision and oversight of, and strengthen safety and soundness within, the financial services sector. Additionally, Dodd-Frank establishes a new framework of authority to conduct systemic risk oversight within the financial system to be distributed among new and existing regulatory agencies, including the Financial Stability Oversight Council, or Council, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, or FRB, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency, or OCC, and the FDIC. The rules and regulations promulgated under Dodd-Frank are likely to impact our operations and cost. Dodd-Frank includes, among other things, the following:
 
(i)
the creation of a Financial Stability Oversight Counsel to identify emerging systemic risks and improve interagency cooperation;
   
(ii)
requirement by statute that bank holding companies serve as a source of financial strength for their depository institution subsidiaries;
   
(iii)
the elimination and phase-out of trust preferred securities from Tier 1 capital with certain exceptions;
   
(iv)
the elimination of remaining barriers to de novo interstate branching by banks;
   
(v)
expanded FDIC resolution authority to conduct the orderly liquidation of certain systemically significant non-bank financial companies in addition to depository institutions;
   
(vi)
enhanced regulation of financial markets, including the derivative and securitizations markets, and the elimination of certain proprietary trading activities by banks;
   
(vii)
the establishment of strengthened capital and liquidity requirements for banks and bank holding companies, including minimum leverage and risk-based capital requirements no less than the strictest requirements in effect for depository institutions as of the date of enactment;
   
(viii)
a permanent increase of the previously implemented temporary increase of FDIC deposit insurance to $250,000 and an extension of federal deposit coverage until January 1, 2013 for the full net amount held by depositors in non-interest bearing transaction accounts;
   
(ix)
authorization for financial institutions to pay interest on business checking accounts;
   
(x)
changes in the calculation of FDIC deposit insurance assessments, such that the assessment base will no longer be the institution’s deposit base, but instead, will be its average consolidated total assets less its average tangible equity and increase the minimum reserve ratio for the Deposit Insurance Fund, or DIF, from 1.15 percent to 1.35 percent;
   
(xi)
the transfer of oversight of savings and loan holding companies to the FRB, federally chartered thrift institutions to the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency and state-chartered savings banks to the FDIC, and the elimination of the Office of Thrift Supervision;
   
(xii)
the creation of a Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, or CFPB, which is authorized to promulgate and enforce consumer protection regulations relating to bank and non-bank financial products and examine and enforce these regulations on banks with more than $10 billion in assets;
   
(xiii)
expanded restrictions on transactions with affiliates and insiders under Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act and lending limits for derivative transactions, repurchase agreements and securities lending and borrowing transactions; and
   
(xiv)
provisions that affect corporate governance and executive compensation at most United States publicly traded companies, including (1) stockholder advisory votes on executive compensation, (2) executive compensation “clawback” requirements for companies listed on national securities exchanges in the event of materially inaccurate statements of earnings, revenues, gains or other criteria similar to the requirements of the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 for the Troubled Assets Relief Program Capital Purchase Program for the SEC recipients, (3) enhances independence requirements for compensation committee members, and (4) authority for the SEC to adopt proxy access rules which would permit stockholders of publicly traded companies to nominate candidates for election as a director and have those nominees included in a company’s proxy statement.
 
We cannot predict the extent to which the interpretations and implementation of this wide-ranging federal legislation may affect us. Many of the requirements of Dodd-Frank will be implemented over time and most will be subject to regulations implemented over the course of several years. There can be no assurance that these or future reforms (such as possible new standards for commercial real estate lending or new stress testing guidance for all banks) arising out of studies and reports required by Dodd-Frank will not significantly increase our compliance or other operating costs and earnings or otherwise have a significant impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Dodd-Frank is likely to impose upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise adversely affect our business. As a result of the changes required by Dodd-Frank, the profitability of our business activities may be impacted and we may be required to make changes to certain of our business practices. These changes may also require us to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make any changes necessary to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements.
 
 
4

 
 
In response to the financial crisis affecting the banking system and financial markets and going concern threats to investment banks and other financial institutions, on October 3, 2008, the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008, or the EESA, became law. Through its authority under the EESA, the Treasury announced in October 2008 the Troubled Asset Relief Program—Capital Purchase Program, or the CPP, a program designed to bolster healthy institutions, like First California, by making $250 billion of capital available to U.S. financial institutions in the form of preferred stock.
 
We participated in the CPP in December 2008 so that we could continue to lend and support our current and prospective clients, especially during this unstable economic environment. Under the terms of our participation, we received $25 million in exchange for the issuance of preferred stock and a warrant to purchase common stock, and became subject to various requirements, including certain restrictions on paying dividends on our common stock and repurchasing our equity securities, unless the Treasury has consented. The common stock warrant entitled the Treasury to purchase 599,042 shares of our common stock at an exercise price of $6.26 for a term of ten years. On July 14, 2011, we redeemed all 25,000 preferred stock series B shares and exited the CPP program. On August 24, 2011, we purchased the 10-year warrant from the Treasury for $599,042. In connection with the redemption of the preferred stock series B shares, the Company accelerated the amortization of the remaining difference between the par amount and the initially recorded fair value of the preferred stock series B shares. This $1.1 million deemed dividend reduced the amount of net income available to common shareholders in 2011.
 
We redeemed the $25 million of preferred stock series B shares with the $25 million of proceeds received in exchange for issuing 25,000 preferred stock series C shares to the Treasury as a participant in the Small Business Lending Fund program, or the SBLF. The preferred stock series C shares will receive non-cumulative quarterly dividends and the initial dividend rate was 5 percent. The dividend rate can fluctuate between 1 percent and 5 percent during the next eight quarters and is a function of the growth in qualified small business loans each quarter.
 
    The EESA also temporarily increased FDIC deposit insurance on most accounts from $100,000 to $250,000. Dodd-Frank made the $250,000 deposit insurance limit permanent. In addition, the FDIC has implemented two temporary programs under the Temporary Liquidity Guaranty Program, or the TLGP, to provide deposit insurance for the full amount of most non-interest bearing transaction accounts through June 30, 2010 (for depository institutions that did not opt out prior to November 2, 2009) and to guarantee certain unsecured debt of financial institutions and their holding companies through June 2012. The Bank did not participate in these TLGP programs. Dodd-Frank extended until January 1, 2013 deposit insurance for the full net amount of non-interest bearing transaction accounts. The FDIC charges “systemic risk special assessments” to depository institutions that participate in the TLGP. The FDIC has recently proposed that Congress give the FDIC expanded authority to charge fees to the holding companies which benefit directly and indirectly from the FDIC guarantees. See “FDIC Deposit Insurance” below.
 
    Dodd-Frank adopts the so-called “Volcker Rule” which, subject to a transition period and certain exceptions, will become effective on July 21, 2012 and prohibits a banking entity from engaging in “proprietary trading,” which is defined as engaging as principal for the “trading account” of the banking entity in securities or other instruments, as determined by federal regulators. After the conformance period commencing July 21, 2012, the Volcker Rule prohibitions and restrictions will apply to banking entities, including the Company, the Bank and their affiliates, unless an exception applies. Certain forms of proprietary trading may qualify as “permitted activities,” and thus not be subject to the ban on proprietary trading, such as “market-making-related activities”, “risk-mitigating hedging activities”, and trading in U.S. government or agency obligations, certain other U.S., state or municipal obligations, and the obligations of Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac or Ginnie Mae. Additionally, subject to a transition period and certain exceptions, the rule restricts a banking entity from sponsoring or investing in certain private funds. A banking entity that sponsors or invests in certain private funds is also restricted from providing credit or other support to the fund or permitting the fund to use the name of the bank. In October 2011, the OCC, FRB, FDIC, and SEC, in consultation with the Commodity Futures Trading Commission, jointly released a notice of proposed rulemaking implementing the Volcker Rule limitations of Dodd-Frank. In light of the complexity of the proposed regulation and the likelihood that a substantial number of comments will be submitted, the Company cannot fully assess the impact of the Volcker Rule on its business until final rules and regulations are adopted.
 
General
 
Banking is a complex, highly regulated industry. The primary goals of the regulatory scheme are to maintain a safe and sound banking system, protect depositors and the FDIC insurance fund, and facilitate the conduct of sound monetary policy. This regulatory scheme is not designed for the benefit of stockholders of the Company or its successors. In furtherance of these goals, Congress and the states have created several largely autonomous regulatory agencies and enacted numerous laws that govern banks, bank holding companies and the financial services industry. Consequently, the growth and earnings performance of the Company or its successors and the Bank can be affected not only by management decisions and general economic conditions, but also by the requirements of applicable state and federal statues, regulations and the policies of various governmental regulatory authorities, including the FRB, the FDIC, the DFI, and the United States Department of the Treasury, or the Treasury.
 
 
5

 
 
The commercial banking business is also influenced by the monetary and fiscal policies of the federal government and the policies of the FRB. The FRB implements national monetary policies (with objectives such as curbing inflation and combating recession) by its open-market operations in United States Government securities, by adjusting the required level of reserves for financial intermediaries subject to its reserve requirements and by varying the discount rates applicable to borrowings by depository institutions. The actions of the FRB in these areas influence the growth of bank loans, investments and deposits and also affect interest rates charged on loans and paid on deposits. Indirectly, such actions may also impact the ability of non-bank financial institutions to compete with the Bank. The nature and impact of any future changes in monetary policies cannot be predicted.
 
The system of supervision and regulation applicable to financial services businesses governs most aspects of the business of the Company and the Bank, including: (i) the scope of permissible business; (ii) investments; (iii) reserves that must be maintained against deposits; (iv) capital levels that must be maintained; (v) the nature and amount of collateral that may be taken to secure loans; (vi) the establishment of new branches; (vii) mergers and consolidations with other financial institutions; and (viii) the payment of dividends.
 
From time to time laws or regulations are enacted which have the effect of increasing the cost of doing business, limiting or expanding the scope of permissible activities, or changing the competitive balance between banks and other financial and non-financial institutions. Proposals to change the laws and regulations governing the operations of banks and bank holding companies are frequently made in Congress, in the California legislature and by various bank and other regulatory agencies. For example, as noted above, Dodd-Frank, among other things, creates CFPB which has broad powers to regulate consumer financial services and products, creates the Financial Stability Oversight Council with regulatory authority over certain financial companies and activities, and would give shareholders a “say on pay” regarding executive compensation. The FRB has also issued proposed guidance on incentive compensation to ensure that banking organizations’ incentive compensation policies do not undermine the safety and soundness of their organizations. Future changes in the laws, regulations or polices that impact the Company or its successors and the Bank cannot necessarily be predicted, but they may have a material effect on the business and earnings of the Company and the Bank.
 
Set forth below is a summary description of certain of the material laws and regulations that relate to our operations and those of the Bank. The description does not purport to be a complete description of these laws and regulations and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the applicable laws and regulations.
 
Regulation of First California
 
As a registered bank holding company, First California and its subsidiaries are subject to the FRB’s supervision, regulation and examination under the BHCA. Under the BHCA, we are subject to periodic examination by the FRB. We are also required to file with the FRB periodic reports of our operations and such additional information regarding the Company and its subsidiaries as the FRB may require.
 
Under FRB regulations, a bank holding company is required to serve as a source of financial and managerial strength to its subsidiary banks and may not conduct its operations in an unsafe or unsound manner. In addition, it is the FRB’s policy that in serving as a source of strength to its subsidiary banks, a bank holding company should stand ready to use available resources to provide adequate capital funds to its subsidiary banks during periods of financial stress or adversity and should maintain the financial flexibility and capital-raising capacity to obtain additional resources for assisting its subsidiary banks. A bank holding company’s failure to meet its obligations to serve as a source of strength to its subsidiary banks will generally be considered by the FRB to be an unsafe and unsound banking practice or a violation of the FRB’s regulations or both.
 
    Dodd-Frank amends the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, or FDIA, to obligate the FRB to require bank holding companies to serve as a source of financial strength for any subsidiary depository institution. The appropriate federal banking agency for such a depository institution may require reports from companies that own the insured depository institution to assess their ability to serve as a source of strength and to enforce compliance with the source-of-strength requirements. The term “source of financial strength” is defined as the ability of a company to provide financial assistance to its insured depository institution subsidiaries in the event of financial distress at such subsidiaries. Under this requirement, First California in the future could be required to provide financial assistance to the Bank should it experience financial distress.
 
First California is required to obtain the FRB’s prior approval before acquiring ownership or control of more than 5% of the outstanding shares of any class of voting securities, or substantially all the assets, of any company, including a bank or bank holding company. Further, we are allowed to engage, directly or indirectly, only in banking and other activities that the FRB deems to be so closely related to banking or managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto. Pursuant to the GLBA, in order to elect and retain financial holding company status, a bank holding company and all depository institution subsidiaries must be well capitalized, well managed, and, except in limited circumstances, be in satisfactory compliance with the Community Reinvestment Act, or the CRA.
 
First California’s securities are registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission, or the SEC, under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange Act, and listed on the NASDAQ Global Select Market. As such, First California is subject to the information, proxy solicitation, insider trading, corporate governance, and other requirements and restrictions of the Exchange Act, as well as the Marketplace Rules and other requirements promulgated by the NASDAQ Stock Market, Inc.
 
 
6

 
 
First California is subject to the accounting oversight and corporate governance requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, including, among other things, required executive certification of financial reports, increased requirements for board audit committees and their members, and enhanced disclosure of controls and procedures and internal controls over financial reporting.
 
First California’s earnings and activities are affected by legislation, by regulations and by local legislative and administrative bodies and decisions of courts in the jurisdictions in which First California and the Bank conduct business. For example, these include limitations on the ability of the Bank to pay dividends to us and our ability to pay dividends to our stockholders. It is the policy of the FRB that bank holding companies should pay cash dividends on common stock only out of income available over the past year and only if prospective earnings retention is consistent with the organization’s expected future needs and financial condition. The policy provides that bank holding companies should not maintain a level of cash dividends that undermines the bank holding company’s ability to serve as a source of strength to its banking subsidiaries. Various federal and state statutory provisions limit the amount of dividends that subsidiary banks can pay to their holding companies without regulatory approval. In addition to these explicit limitations, the federal regulatory agencies have general authority to prohibit a banking subsidiary or bank holding company from engaging in an unsafe or unsound banking practice. Depending upon the circumstances, the agencies could take the position that paying a dividend would constitute an unsafe or unsound banking practice. In addition, as discussed below under “Regulation of the Bank”, a bank holding company such as the Company is required to maintain minimum ratios of Tier 1 capital and total capital to total risk-weighted assets, as well as a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to total adjusted quarterly average assets as defined in such regulations.
 
Under the terms of the SBLF, for so long as any preferred stock issued under the SBLF remains outstanding, First California is permitted to make dividend payments to, or effectuate share repurchases from, other shareholders, provided that after the payment or repurchase, the institution’s Tier 1 capital would be at least 90 percent of the amount existing at the time immediately after the SBLF closing date, excluding any subsequent net charge-offs and partial repayments of the SBLF funding.
 
Regulation of the Bank
    The Bank is extensively regulated under both federal and state law. The Bank, as a California state chartered bank which is not a member of the Federal Reserve System, is subject to regulation, supervision, and regular examination by the DFI and the FDIC. The Bank’s deposits are insured by the FDIC up to the maximum extent provided by law. The regulations of these agencies govern most aspects of the Bank’s business. California law exempts all banks from usury limitations on interest rates. Various consumer laws and regulations also affect the Bank’s operations, such as the CRA, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Truth in Lending Act, the Fair Housing Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, and the Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act. These laws primarily protect depositors and other customers of the Bank, rather than First California or its stockholders. The creation of the CFPB by Dodd-Frank is also likely to lead to enhanced and strengthened enforcement of consumer financial protection laws. On July 21, 2011, the CFPB assumed its authority to supervise and enforce existing consumer financial protection rules. On January 4, 2012, President Obama named Richard Cordray as the Director of the CFPB via recess appointment. The validity of this recess appointment may be subject to challenge, creating uncertainty because the full authority to approve new consumer financial protection rules is vested in the director of the CFPB. Additionally, Dodd-Frank does not allow the CFPB to promulgate regulations until it has a director that has been confirmed by the Senate. At this time it is still unclear as to whether the recess appointment is sufficient to meet this statutory requirement. Accordingly, at this time the Company cannot fully assess the impact of the CFPB on its business.
 
Various requirements and restrictions under the laws of the State of California and the United States affect the operations of the Bank. State and federal statutes and regulations relate to many aspects of the Bank’s operations, including standards for safety and soundness, reserves against deposits, interest rates payable on deposits and loans, investments, mergers and acquisitions, borrowings, dividends, locations of branch offices, fair lending requirements, CRA activities and loans to affiliates. Further, the Bank is required to maintain certain levels of capital.
 
Dividends and Capital Distributions
 
Dividends and capital distributions from the Bank constitute the principal source of cash to First California. As a result, First California’s ability to pay dividends on its capital stock will depend primarily on the ability of the Bank to pay dividends to First California in amounts sufficient to service its obligations. The Bank is subject to various federal or state statutory and regulatory limitations on its ability to pay dividends and capital distributions to its shareholder, generally based on capital levels and current or retained earnings. The ability of the Bank to pay dividends is also subject to regulatory restrictions if paying dividends would impair its profitability, financial condition or other cash flow requirements.
 
The FRB has issued a policy statement with regard to the payment of cash dividends by bank holding companies. The policy statement provides that, as a matter of prudent banking, a bank holding company should not maintain a rate of cash dividends unless its net income available to common stockholders has been sufficient to fully fund the dividends, and the prospective rate of earnings retention appears to be consistent with the holding company’s capital needs, asset quality and overall financial condition. Accordingly, a bank holding company should not pay cash dividends that exceed its net income or can only be funded in ways that weaken the bank holding company’s financial health, such as by borrowing.
 
 
7

 
 
Under California law, banks may declare a cash dividend out of their net profits up to the lesser of retained earnings or the net income for the last three fiscal years (less any distributions made to shareholders during such period), or with the prior written approval of the DFI, in an amount not exceeding the greatest of (i) the retained earnings of the Bank, (ii) the net income of the Bank for its last fiscal year or (iii) the net income of the Bank for its current fiscal year. In addition, under federal law, banks are prohibited from paying any dividends if after making such payment they would fail to meet any of the minimum regulatory capital requirements. The federal regulators also have the authority to prohibit state banks from engaging in any business practices which are considered to be unsafe or unsound, and in some circumstances the regulators might prohibit the payment of dividends on that basis even though such payments would otherwise be permissible.
 
The Bank may from time to time be permitted to make additional capital distributions to its shareholder with the consent of the DFI. It is not anticipated that such consent could be obtained unless the distributing bank were to remain “well-capitalized” following such distribution.
 
Regulatory Capital Guidelines. Both the Company and the Bank are required to maintain certain levels of capital. The FRB and the FDIC have substantially similar risk-based capital ratio and leverage ratio guidelines for banking organizations. The current risk-based capital guidelines that apply to First California and the Bank, commonly referred to as Basel I, are based upon the 1988 capital accord of the International Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, or the Basel Committee, a committee of central banks and bank supervisors. The guidelines are intended to ensure that banking organizations have adequate capital given the risk levels of assets and off-balance sheet financial instruments.
 
Under the existing Basel I-based guidelines, the minimum ratio of total capital to risk-weighted assets (which are primarily the credit risk equivalents of balance sheet assets and certain off-balance sheet items such as standby letters of credit, but also include a nominal market risk equivalent balance related to foreign exchange and debt/equity trading activities) is eight percent, of which at least four percent must be composed of tier 1 capital. The FRB also has adopted a minimum leverage ratio for most bank holding companies, requiring tier 1 capital of at least four percent of average quarterly total consolidated assets, net of loan loss reserve, goodwill and certain other intangible assets. The federal banking regulators have also established risk-based and leverage capital guidelines that insured banks are required to meet. These regulations are generally similar to those established by the FRB for bank holding companies.
 
For purposes of calculating the ratios, a banking organization’s assets and some of its specified off-balance sheet commitments and obligations are assigned to various risk categories. A depository institution’s or holding company’s capital, in turn, is classified in one of three tiers, depending on type:
 
 
Core Capital (Tier 1): Tier 1 capital includes common equity, retained earnings, qualifying non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, a limited amount of qualifying cumulative perpetual stock at the holding company level, minority interests in equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries, and qualifying trust preferred securities less goodwill, most intangible assets and certain other assets.
     
 
Supplementary Capital (Tier 2): Tier 2 capital includes, among other things, perpetual preferred stock and trust preferred securities not meeting the Tier 1 definition, qualifying mandatory convertible debt securities, qualifying subordinated debt, and allowances for possible loan and lease losses, subject to limitations.
     
 
Market Risk Capital (Tier 3): Tier 3 capital includes qualifying unsecured subordinated debt.
 
 
8

 
 
The following table sets forth the regulatory capital guidelines and the actual capitalization levels for the Bank and the Company as of December 31, 2011 and 2010:
 
   
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
 
To be Well-
Capitalized Under
Prompt Corrective
Action Provision
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
   
(in thousands)
December 31, 2011
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total capital (to risk weighted assets)
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
First California Financial Group, Inc.
  $ 194,694       17.32 %   $ 89,924  
 8.00 %
 
 
 
 
First California Bank
  $ 192,227       17.10 %   89,944  
≥ 8.00 %
  $ 112,430  
≥ 10.00 %
Tier I capital (to risk weighted assets)
                       
 
       
 
First California Financial Group, Inc.
  180,597       16.07 %   44,962  
≥ 4.00 %
       
 
First California Bank
  178,126       15.84 %   44,972  
≥ 4.00 %
  67,458  
≥ 6.00 %
Tier I capital (to average assets)
                       
 
       
 
First California Financial Group, Inc.
  180,597       10.33 %   69,906  
≥ 4.00 %
       
 
First California Bank
  178,126       10.18 %   69,968  
≥ 4.00 %
  87,460  
≥ 5.00 %
 
   
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
 
To be Well-
Capitalized Under
Prompt Corrective
Action Provision
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
   
(in thousands)
December 31, 2010
                           
Total capital (to risk weighted assets)
                           
First California Financial Group, Inc.
  $ 172,599       16.79 %   $ 82,242  
≥ 8.00 %
       
First California Bank
  167,395       16.31 %   82,090  
≥ 8.00 %
  $ 102,613  
≥ 10.00 %
Tier I capital (to risk weighted assets)
                                   
First California Financial Group, Inc.
  159,695       15.53 %   41,121  
≥ 4.00 %
         
First California Bank
  154,515       15.06 %   41,045  
≥ 4.00 %
  61,658  
≥ 6.00 %
Tier I capital (to average assets)
                                   
First California Financial Group, Inc.
  159,695       11.00 %   58,052  
≥ 4.00 %
         
First California Bank
  154,515       10.63 %   58,134  
≥ 4.00 %
  72,668  
≥ 5.00 %
 
We recognize that a strong capital position is vital to growth, continued profitability, and depositor and investor confidence. Our policy is to maintain sufficient capital at not less than the well-capitalized thresholds established by banking regulators.
 
The Basel Accords. The current risk-based capital guidelines which apply to First California and the Bank are based upon the 1988 capital accord of the Basel Committee. A new international accord, referred to as Basel II, became mandatory for large, internationally active banking organizations, known as “core” banking organizations, in 2008 (total assets of $250 billion or more or consolidated foreign exposures of $10 billion or more). Basel II emphasizes internal assessment of credit, market and operational risk, as well as supervisory assessment and market discipline in determining minimum capital requirements. It is optional for other banks, and if adopted, must first be complied with in a “parallel run” for two years along with the existing Basel I standards. In January 2009, the Basel Committee proposed to reconsider regulatory-capital standards, supervisory and risk-management requirements and additional disclosures to further strengthen the Basel II framework in response to recent worldwide developments. First California is not required to comply with Basel II and elected not to apply the Basel II requirements when they became effective.
 
On September 12, 2010, the Group of Governors and Heads of Supervision, the oversight body of the Basel Committee, announced agreement on the calibration and phase-in arrangements for a strengthened set of capital requirements, known as Basel III. Under these standards, when fully phased-in on January 1, 2019, banking institutions will be required to satisfy three risk-based capital ratios:
 
 
A tier 1 common equity ratio of at least 7.0%, inclusive of 4.5% minimum tier 1 common equity ratio, net of regulatory deductions, and the new 2.5% “capital conservation buffer” of common equity to risk-weighted assets;
     
 
A tier 1 capital ratio of at least 8.5%, inclusive of the 2.5% capital conservation buffer; and
     
 
A total capital ratio of at least 10.5%, inclusive of the 2.5% capital conservation buffer.
 
The capital conservation buffer is designed to absorb losses during periods of economic stress. Banking institutions with a tier 1 common equity ratio above the minimum but below the conservation buffer may face constraints on dividends, equity repurchases and compensation based on the amount of such shortfall. The Basel Committee also announced a “countercyclical buffer” of 0% to 2.5% of common equity or other loss-absorbing capital “will be implemented according to national circumstances” as an “extension” of the conservation buffer during periods of excess credit growth.
 
 
9

 
 
    Basel III introduces a non-risk adjusted tier 1 leverage ratio of 3%, based on a measure of total exposure rather than total assets and new liquidity standards. The phase-in of the new rules is to commence on January 1, 2013, with the phase-in of the capital conservation buffer commencing on January 1, 2015 and the rules to be fully phased-in by January 1, 2019.
 
    In November 2010, Basel III was endorsed by the Seoul G20 Leaders Summit and will be subject to individual adoption by member nations, including the United States. On December 16, 2010, the Basel Committee issued text of the Basel III rules, which presents the details of global regulatory standards on bank capital adequacy and liquidity agreed to by the Basel Committee and endorsed by the Seoul G20 Leaders Summit. The federal banking agencies will likely implement changes to the current capital adequacy standards applicable to First California and the Bank in light of Basel III. If adopted by federal banking agencies, Basel III could lead to significantly higher capital requirements and more restrictive leverage and liquidity ratios. First California cannot determine the ultimate effect that potential legislation, or subsequent regulations, if enacted, would have upon First California’s earnings or financial position. In addition, significant questions remain as to how the capital and liquidity mandates of Dodd-Frank will be integrated with the requirements of Basel III.
 
    Note that Dodd-Frank also requires the establishment of more stringent prudential standards by requiring the federal banking agencies to adopt capital and liquidity requirements which address the risks that the activities of an institution pose to the institution and the public and private stakeholders, including risks arising from certain enumerated activities. In particular, Dodd-Frank excludes trust preferred securities issued on or after May 19, 2010 from tier 1 capital. For depository institution holding companies with total consolidated assets of more than $15 billion at December 31, 2009, trust preferred securities issued before May 19, 2010 will be phased-out of tier 1 capital over a three-year period.
 
Prompt Corrective Action and Other General Enforcement Authority. The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act, or FDICIA, requires each federal banking agency to take prompt corrective action to resolve the problems of insured depository institutions, including undercapitalization. Each federal banking agency has issued regulations defining five capital categories: “well- capitalized,” “adequately capitalized,” “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized,” and “critically undercapitalized.” Under the regulations, a bank shall be deemed to be:
 
 
“well-capitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 10.0% or more, has a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or more, has a leverage capital ratio of 5.0% or more, and is not subject to specified requirements to meet and maintain a specific capital level for any capital measure;
     
 
“adequately capitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or more, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4.0% or more, and a leverage capital ratio of 4.0% or more (3.0% under certain circumstances) and does not meet the definition of “well capitalized”;
     
 
“undercapitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio that is less than 8.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio that is less than 4.0%, or a leverage capital ratio that is less than 4.0% (3.0% under certain circumstances);
     
 
“significantly undercapitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio that is less than 6.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio that is less than 3.0% or a leverage capital ratio that is less than 3.0%; and
     
 
“critically undercapitalized” if it has a ratio of tangible equity to total assets that is equal to or less than 2.0%.
 
Banks are prohibited from paying dividends or management fees to controlling persons or entities if, after making the payment, the bank would be “undercapitalized,” that is, the bank fails to meet the required minimum level for any relevant capital measure. Asset growth and branching restrictions apply to “undercapitalized” banks. Banks classified as “undercapitalized” are required to submit acceptable capital plans guaranteed by their holding companies, if any. Broad regulatory authority was granted with respect to “significantly undercapitalized” banks, including forced mergers, growth restrictions, ordering new elections for directors, forcing divestiture by its holding company, if any, requiring management changes, and prohibiting the payment of bonuses to senior management. Even more severe restrictions are applicable to “critically undercapitalized” banks, those with capital at or less than 2%. Restrictions for these banks include the appointment of a receiver or conservator. All of the federal banking agencies have promulgated substantially similar regulations to implement this system of prompt corrective action.
 
A bank, based upon its capital levels, that is classified as “well capitalized,” “adequately capitalized” or “undercapitalized” may be treated as though it were in the next lower capital category if the appropriate federal banking agency, after notice and opportunity for a hearing, determines that an unsafe or unsound condition, or an unsafe or unsound practice, warrants such treatment. At each successive lower capital category, an insured bank is subject to more restrictions. The federal banking agencies, however, may not treat an institution as “critically undercapitalized” unless its capital ratios actually warrant such treatment.
 
In addition to measures taken under the prompt corrective action provisions, insured banks may be subject to potential enforcement actions by the federal banking agencies for unsafe or unsound practices in conducting their businesses or for violations of any law, rule, regulation or any condition imposed in writing by the agency or any written agreement with the agency. Enforcement actions may include the imposition of a conservator or receiver, the issuance of a cease-and-desist order that can be judicially enforced, the termination of insurance of deposits (in the case of a depository institution), the imposition of civil money penalties, the issuance of directives to increase capital, the issuance of formal and informal agreements, the issuance of removal and prohibition orders against institution-affiliated parties. The enforcement of such actions through injunctions or restraining orders may be based upon a judicial determination that the agency would be harmed if such equitable relief was not granted.
 
 
10

 
 
The DFI, as the primary regulator for California state-chartered banks, also has a broad range of enforcement measures, from cease and desist powers and the imposition of monetary penalties to the ability to take possession of a bank, including causing its liquidation.
 
Safety and Soundness Standards. The federal banking agencies have adopted guidelines designed to assist the federal banking agencies in identifying and addressing potential safety and soundness concerns before capital becomes impaired. The guidelines set forth operational and managerial standards relating to (i) internal controls, information systems and internal audit systems; (ii) loan documentation; (iii) credit underwriting; (iv) asset growth; (v) earnings; and (vi) compensation, fees and benefits.
 
In addition, the federal banking agencies have also adopted safety and soundness guidelines with respect to asset quality and for evaluating and monitoring earnings to ensure that earnings are sufficient for the maintenance of adequate capital and reserves. These guidelines provide six standards for establishing and maintaining a system to identify problem assets and prevent those assets from deteriorating. Under these standards, an insured depository institution should (i) conduct periodic asset quality reviews to identify problem assets; (ii) estimate the inherent losses in problem assets and establish reserves that are sufficient to absorb estimated losses; (iii) compare problem asset totals to capital; (iv) take appropriate corrective action to resolve problem assets; (v) consider the size and potential risks of material asset concentrations; and (vi) provide periodic asset quality reports with adequate information for management and the board of directors to assess the level of asset risk.
 
Transactions with Affiliates. Under Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act and the FRB’s Regulation W, loans by the Bank to affiliates, investments by them in affiliates’ stock, and taking affiliates’ stock as collateral for loans to any borrower is limited to 10% of the Bank’s capital, in the case of any one affiliate, and is limited to 20% of the Bank’s capital, in the case of all affiliates. The Bank’s holding company and any subsidiaries it may purchase or organize are generally deemed to be affiliates of the Bank within the meaning of Section 23A and 23B and Regulation W. In addition, transactions between the Bank and other affiliates must be on terms and conditions that are consistent with safe and sound banking practices; in particular, a bank and its subsidiaries generally may not purchase from an affiliate a low-quality asset, as defined in the Federal Reserve Act. These restrictions also prevent a bank holding company and its other affiliates from borrowing from a banking subsidiary of the bank holding company unless the loans are secured by marketable collateral of designated amounts. The Company or its successors and the Bank are also subject to certain restrictions with respect to engaging in the underwriting, public sale and distribution of securities.
 
Dodd-Frank generally enhances the restrictions on transactions with affiliates under Section 23A and 23B, including an expansion of the definition of “covered transactions” to include credit exposures related to derivatives, repurchase agreements and securities lending arrangements, and an increase in the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered credit transactions must be satisfied. The definition of “affiliate” was expanded to include any investment fund to which First California or an affiliate serves as an investment adviser. The ability of the FRB to grant exemptions from these restrictions was also narrowed, including by requiring coordination with other bank regulators.
 
Loans to Insiders. Extensions of credit by the Bank to insiders of both the Bank and First California are subject to prohibitions and other restrictions imposed by federal regulations. For purposes of these limits, “insiders” include directors, executive officers and principal shareholders of the Bank or First California and their related interests. The term “related interest” means a company controlled by a director, executive officer or principal shareholder of the Bank or First California. The Bank may not extend credit to an insider of the Bank or First California unless the loan is made on substantially the same terms as, and subject to credit underwriting procedures that are no less stringent than, those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with non-insiders. Under federal banking regulations, the Bank may not extend a loan to insiders in an amount greater than $500,000 without prior board approval (with any interested person abstaining from participating directly or indirectly in the voting). The federal regulations place additional restrictions on loans to executive officers, and generally prohibit loans to executive officers other than for certain specified purposes. The Bank is required to maintain records regarding insiders and extensions of credit to them.
 
Federal Deposit Insurance. The FDIC insures our customer deposits through the Deposit Insurance Fund, or the DIF, up to prescribed limits for each depositor. Pursuant to the EESA, the basic limit on federal deposit insurance coverage was temporarily raised from $100,000 to $250,000 per depositor. Dodd-Frank made the $250,000 deposit insurance limit permanent. The federal banking agencies also recently issued final rules implementing the Dodd-Frank repeal of the prohibition on paying interest on demand deposits. Further, as required under Section 343 of Dodd-Frank, the FDIC has adopted a final rule that provides temporary unlimited deposit insurance coverage for non-interest-bearing transaction accounts. As mandated by Dodd-Frank, the FDIC will fully insure the amounts in non-interest-bearing transaction accounts without limits from December 31, 2010 through December 31, 2012. The unlimited coverage would be separate from, and in addition to, the coverage provided to depositors with other accounts held at an institution. Beginning January 1, 2013, the unlimited coverage will cease and these accounts will be insured under the FDIC’s general deposit insurance coverage rules.
 
 
11

 
 
Dodd-Frank changes the deposit insurance assessment framework, primarily by basing assessments on an institution’s total assets less tangible equity (subject to risk-based adjustments that would further reduce the assessment base for custodial banks) rather than domestic deposits, which is expected to shift a greater portion of the aggregate assessments to large banks. Dodd-Frank also increases the minimum designated reserve ratio of the DIF from 1.15% to 1.35% of the estimated amount of total insured deposits by September 30, 2020, eliminates the upper limit for the reserve ratio designated by the FDIC each year, and eliminates the requirement that the FDIC pay dividends to depository institutions when the reserve ratio exceeds certain thresholds.
 
On December 14, 2010, the FDIC raised the minimum designated reserve ratio of the DIF to 2%. The ratio is higher than the minimum reserve ratio of 1.35% as set by Dodd-Frank.
 
On February 7, 2011, the FDIC approved a final rule on Assessments, Dividends, Assessment Base and Large Bank Pricing. The final rule, mandated by Dodd-Frank, changes the deposit insurance assessment system from one that is based on domestic deposits to one that is based on average consolidated total assets minus average tangible equity. Because the new assessment base under Dodd-Frank is larger than the current assessment base, the final rule’s assessment rates are lower than the current rates, which achieves the FDIC’s goal of not significantly altering the total amount of revenue collected from the industry. In addition, the final rule adopts a “scorecard” assessment scheme for larger banks and suspends dividend payments if the DIF reserve ratio exceeds 1.5 % but provides for decreasing assessment rates when the DIF reserve ratio reaches certain thresholds. The final rule further reduces the assessment base for custodial banks by the daily or weekly average of a certain amount of low-risk assets (i.e., assets with a Basel risk weighting of 0%, regardless of maturity, plus 50% of assets with a Basel risk weighting of 20%, again regardless of maturity) subject to the limitation that the daily or weekly average value of these assets cannot exceed the daily or weekly average value of those deposits classified as transaction accounts and identified by the institution as being directly linked to a fiduciary or custodial and safekeeping account. The final rule identifies custodial banks as insured depository institutions with previous calendar year-end trust assets (i.e., fiduciary and custody and safekeeping assets) of at least $50 billion or those insured depository institutions that derived more than 50% of their revenue (interest income plus non-interest income) from trust activity over the previous calendar year. The final rule took effect for the quarter beginning April 1, 2011, and was reflected in the invoices for assessments due September 30, 2011.
 
Continued action by the FDIC to replenish the DIF, as well as the changes in Dodd-Frank, are likely to result in higher assessment rates, which would reduce the profitability of the Bank.
 
In addition to its insurance assessment, each insured bank was subject in 2011 to quarterly debt service assessments in connection with bonds issued by a government corporation that financed the federal savings and loan bailout. The first quarter 2011 debt service assessment was .0102%.
 
Money Laundering, Currency Controls and Economic Sanctions. Various federal statutory and regulatory provisions are designed to enhance record-keeping and reporting of currency and foreign transactions. Pursuant to the Bank Secrecy Act, financial institutions must report high levels of currency transactions or face the imposition of civil monetary penalties for reporting violations. The Money Laundering Control Act imposes sanctions, including revocation of federal deposit insurance, for institutions convicted of money laundering.
 
The International Money Laundering Abatement and Financial Anti-Terrorism Act of 2001, or the IMLAFATA, a part of the USA Patriot Act, authorizes the Secretary of the Treasury, in consultation with the heads of other government agencies, to adopt special measures applicable to banks and other financial institutions to enhance record-keeping and reporting requirements for certain financial transactions that are of primary money laundering concern. Among its other provisions, IMLAFATA requires each financial institution to: (i) establish an anti-money laundering program; (ii) establish due diligence policies, procedures and controls with respect to its private banking accounts and correspondent banking accounts involving individuals and certain foreign banks; and (iii) avoid establishing, maintaining, administering, or managing correspondent accounts in the United States for, or on behalf of, a foreign bank that does not have a physical presence in any country. In addition, IMLAFATA contains a provision encouraging cooperation among financial institutions, regulatory authorities and law enforcement authorities with respect to individuals, entities and organizations engaged in, or reasonably suspected of engaging in, terrorist acts or money laundering activities.
 
The Treasury’s regulations implementing IMLAFATA mandate that federally-insured banks and other financial institutions establish customer identification programs designed to verify the identity of persons opening new accounts, maintain the records used for verification, and determine whether the person appears on any list of known or suspected terrorists or terrorist organizations.
 
The U.S. Department of the Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control, or OFAC, is responsible for requiring that U.S. entities do not engage in transactions with certain prohibited parties, as defined by various Executive Orders and Acts of Congress. OFAC publishes lists of persons, organizations and countries suspected of aiding, harboring or engaging in terrorist acts, known as Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked Persons. If First California and the Bank finds a name on any transaction, account or wire transfer that is on an OFAC list, First California or the Bank must freeze or block such account or transaction, file a report of blocked or rejected transaction and notify OFAC.
 
 
12

 
 
Patriot Act. On October 26, 2001, the President signed into law comprehensive anti-terrorism legislation, the Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001, known as the Patriot Act. The Patriot Act was designed to deny terrorists and others the ability to obtain access to the United States financial system, and has significant implications for depository institutions and other businesses involved in the transfer of money. The Patriot Act, as implemented by various federal regulatory agencies, required financial institutions, including the Bank, to implement policies and procedures or amend existing policies and procedures with respect to, among other matters, anti-money laundering, compliance, suspicious activity and currency transaction reporting and due diligence on customers. The Patriot Act and its underlying regulations also permit information sharing for counter-terrorist purposes between federal law enforcement agencies and financial institutions, as well as among financial institutions, subject to certain conditions, and require the FRB and other federal banking agencies to evaluate the effectiveness of an applicant in combating money laundering activities when considering applications filed under Section 3 of the BHCA or the Bank Merger Act. The Bank has adopted comprehensive policies and procedures to address the requirements of the Patriot Act. The Bank believes that the ongoing cost of compliance with the Patriot Act is not likely to be material to the Bank.
 
Community Reinvestment Act. The Bank is subject to the CRA. The CRA is intended to encourage insured depository institutions, while operating safely and soundly, to help meet the credit needs of their communities. The CRA specifically directs the federal bank regulatory agencies, in examining insured depository institutions, to assess their record of helping to meet the credit needs of their entire community, including low-and moderate-income neighborhoods, consistent with safe and sound banking practices. The CRA further requires the agencies to take a financial institution’s record of meeting its community credit needs into account when evaluating applications for, among other things, domestic branches, consummating mergers or acquisitions, or holding company formations. The Bank’s compliance with the CRA is reviewed and evaluated by the FDIC, which assigns the Bank a publicly available CRA rating at the conclusion of the examination.
 
The federal banking agencies have adopted regulations which measure a bank’s compliance with its CRA obligations on a performance-based evaluation system. This system bases CRA ratings on an institution’s actual lending service and investment performance rather than the extent to which the institution conducts needs assessments, documents community outreach or complies with other procedural requirements. In connection with its assessment of CRA performance, the FDIC assigns a rating of “outstanding”, “satisfactory”, “needs to improve” or “substantial noncompliance”. Failure of an institution to receive at least a “Satisfactory” rating could inhibit such institution or its holding company from undertaking certain activities, including acquisitions.
 
The Bank had a CRA rating of “Satisfactory” as of its most recent regulatory examination.
 
Interstate Banking and Branching. Federal law permits an adequately capitalized and adequately managed bank holding company, with FRB approval, to acquire banking institutions located in states other than the bank holding company’s home state without regard to whether the transaction is prohibited under state law. In addition, national banks and state banks with different home states are permitted to merge across state lines, with the approval of the appropriate federal banking agency, unless the home state of a participating banking institution passed legislation prior to June 1, 1997 that expressly prohibits interstate mergers. Dodd-Frank permits a national bank or a state bank, with the approval of its regulator, to open a branch in any state if the law of the state in which the branch is to be located would permit the establishment of the branch if the bank were a bank chartered in that state.
 
Sarbanes-Oxley Act. On July 30, 2002, the President signed into law the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act aims to restore the credibility lost as a result of high profile corporate scandals by addressing, among other issues, corporate governance, auditing and accounting, executive compensation and enhanced and timely disclosure of corporate information. The NASDAQ Stock Market has adopted corporate governance rules intended to allow shareholders to more easily and effectively monitor the performance of companies and directors. The principal provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, many of which have been interpreted through regulations released in 2003, provide for and include, among other things: (i) the creation of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board; (ii) auditor independence provisions that restrict non-audit services that accountants may provide to their audit clients; (iii) additional corporate governance and responsibility measures, including the requirement that the chief executive officer and chief financial officer of a public company certify financial statements; (iv) the forfeiture of bonuses or other incentive-based compensation and profits from the sale of an issuer’s securities by directors and senior officers in the twelve month period following initial publication of any financial statements that later require restatement; (v) an increase in the oversight of, and enhancement of certain requirements relating to, audit committees of public companies and how they interact with that company’s independent auditors; (vi) requirements that audit committee members must be independent and are barred from accepting consulting, advisory or other compensatory fees from the issuer; (vii) requirements that companies disclose whether at least one member of the audit committee is a “financial expert’ (as such term is defined by the Securities and Exchange Commission, (or “SEC”) and if not disclosed, why the audit committee does not have a financial expert; (viii) expanded disclosure requirements for corporate insiders, including accelerated reporting of stock transactions by insiders and a prohibition on insider trading during pension blackout periods; (ix) a prohibition on personal loans to directors and officers, except certain loans made by insured financial institutions on non-preferential terms and in compliance with other bank regulatory requirements; (x) disclosure of a code of ethics and filing a Form 8-K for a change or waiver of such code; (xi) a range of enhanced penalties for fraud and other violations; and (xii) expanded disclosure and certification relating to an issuer’s disclosure controls and procedures and internal controls over financial reporting.
 
 
13

 
 
As a result of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, and its implementing regulations, we have incurred substantial costs to interpret and ensure compliance with the law and its regulations. Future changes in the laws, regulation, or policies that impact us cannot necessarily be predicted and may have a material effect on our business and earnings.
 
Environmental Regulation. Federal, state and local laws and regulations regarding the discharge of harmful materials into the environment may have an impact on the Bank. Since the Bank is not involved in any business that manufactures, uses or transports chemicals, waste, pollutants or toxins that might have a material adverse effect on the environment, the Bank’s primary exposure to environmental laws is through its lending activities and through properties or businesses the Bank may own, lease or acquire. Based on a general survey of the Bank’s loan portfolio, conversations with local appraisers and the type of lending currently and historically done by the Bank, management is not aware of any potential liability for hazardous waste contamination that would be reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on the Company or its successors as of the date of this report.
 
Safeguarding of Customer Information and Privacy. In 1970, the Federal Fair Credit Reporting Act, or the FCRA, was enacted to insure the confidentiality, accuracy, relevancy and proper utilization of consumer credit report information. The FCRA affirmatively preempts state law in a number of areas, including the ability of entities affiliated by common ownership to share and exchange information freely, and the requirements on credit bureaus to reinvestigate the contents of reports in response to consumer complaints, among others.
 
The Fair and Accurate Credit Transaction Act, or the FACT Act, became law in 2003, effectively extending and amending provisions of the FCRA. The FACT Act created many new responsibilities for consumer reporting agencies and users of consumer reports. It contains many new consumer disclosure requirements as well as provisions to address identity theft.
 
The FRB and other bank regulatory agencies have adopted guidelines for safeguarding confidential, personal customer information. These guidelines require financial institutions to create, implement and maintain a comprehensive written information security program designed to ensure the security and confidentiality of customer information, protect against any anticipated threats or hazard to the security or integrity of such information and protect against unauthorized access to or use of such information that could result in substantial harm or inconvenience to any customer. The Bank has adopted a customer information security program to comply with such requirements.
 
Federal banking rules also limit the ability of banks and other financial institutions to disclose non-public information about consumers. Pursuant to these rules, financial institutions must provide: (i) initial notices to customers about their privacy policies, describing the conditions under which they may disclose nonpublic personal information to nonaffiliated third parties and affiliates; (ii) annual notices of their privacy policies to current customers; and (iii) a reasonable method for customers to “opt out” of disclosures to nonaffiliated third parties. These privacy provisions affect how consumer information is transmitted through diversified financial companies and conveyed to outside vendors. We have implemented our privacy policies in accordance with the law.
 
In recent years, a number of states have implemented their own versions of privacy laws. For example, in 2003, California adopted standards that are more restrictive than federal law, allowing bank customers the opportunity to bar financial companies from sharing information with their affiliates. More specifically, the California Financial Information Privacy Act requires a financial institution to provide specific information to a consumer related to the sharing of that consumer’s nonpublic personal information. The Act allows a consumer to direct the financial institution not to share his or her nonpublic personal information with affiliated or nonaffiliated companies with which a financial institution has contracted to provide financial products and services, and requires that permission from each such consumer be acquired by a financial institution prior to sharing such information.
 
Other Aspects of Banking Law. The Bank is also subject to federal statutory and regulatory provisions covering, among other things, security procedures, insider and affiliated party transactions, management interlocks, electronic funds transfers, funds availability, and truth-in-savings. There are also a variety of federal statutes which regulate acquisitions of control and the formation of bank holding companies.
 
Impact of Monetary Policies
 
Banking is a business that depends on rate differentials. In general, the difference between the interest rate paid by a bank on its deposits and its other borrowings and the interest rate earned on its loans, securities and other interest-earning assets comprises the major source of a Bank’s earnings. These rates are highly sensitive to many factors which are beyond the Bank’s control and, accordingly, the earnings and growth of the Bank are subject to the influence of economic conditions generally, both domestic and foreign, including inflation, recession, and unemployment; and also to the influence of monetary and fiscal policies of the United States and its agencies, particularly the FRB. The FRB implements national monetary policy, such as seeking to curb inflation and combat recession, by:
 
 
Open-market dealings in United States government securities;
     
 
Adjusting the required level of reserves for financial institutions subject to reserve requirements; and
     
 
Adjusting the discount rate applicable to borrowings by banks which are members of the Federal Reserve System.
 
 
14

 
 
The actions of the FRB in these areas influence the growth of bank loans, investments, and deposits and also affect interest rates. The nature and timing of any future changes in the FRB’s policies and their impact on the Company and its successors and the Bank cannot be predicted; however, depending on the degree to which our interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities are rate sensitive, increases in rates would have a temporary effect of increasing our net interest margin, while decreases in interest rates would have the opposite effect. In addition, adverse economic conditions could make a higher provision for loan losses a prudent course and could cause higher loan charge-offs, thus adversely affecting our net income or other operating costs.
 
Available Information
 
We maintain an Internet website at www.fcalgroup.com, and a website for First California Bank at www.fcbank.com. At www.fcalgroup.com and via the “Investor Relations” link at the Bank’s website, our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to such reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act are available, free of charge, as soon as reasonably practicable after such forms are electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. The public may read and copy any materials we file with the SEC at the SEC’s Public Reference Room, located at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, D.C. 20549 on official business days during the hours of 10:00 a.m. to 3:00 p.m. The public may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC also maintains an Internet site at www.sec.gov that contains reports, proxy and information statements, and other information regarding issuers that file electronically with the SEC. You may obtain copies of the Company’s filings on the SEC site. These documents may also be obtained in print upon request by our shareholders to our Investor Relations Department.
 
You may contact our Investor Relations Department at First California Financial Group, Inc., 3027 Townsgate Road, Suite 300, Westlake Village, California 91361, telephone number (805) 322-9655.
 
(All website addresses given in this document are for information only and are not intended to be an active link or to incorporate any website information into this document.)
 
We have adopted a written code of ethics that applies to all directors, officers and employees of the Company, including our principal executive officer and senior financial officers, in accordance with Section 406 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission promulgated thereunder. The code of ethics is available on our website at www.fcalgroup.com and also upon request, at no charge. Requests for copies should be directed to: Investor Relations Department, 3027 Townsgate Road, Suite 300, Westlake Village, California 91361, telephone number (805) 322-9655. In the Corporate Governance section of our corporate website we have also posted the charters for our Audit Committee, Compensation Committee and Governance and Nominating Committee.
 
Risk Factors
 
Ownership of our common stock involves risks. You should carefully consider the risks described below in addition to the other information set forth herein. Events or circumstances arising from one or more of these risks could adversely affect our business, financial condition, operating results, cash flows and prospects, and the value and market price of our securities could decline. The risks identified below are not intended to be a comprehensive list of all risks we face and additional risks that we may currently view as not material may also impair our business operations and results. Unless otherwise specified, references to “we,” “our” and “us” in this subsection mean First California and its subsidiaries.
 
Risks Related to Our Business
 
Our business has been and may continue to be adversely affected by current conditions in the financial markets and economic conditions generally.
 
The global, U.S. and California economies are experiencing significantly reduced business activity and consumer spending as a result of, among other factors, disruptions in the capital and credit markets. Dramatic declines in the housing market during the past several years, with falling home prices and increasing foreclosures and unemployment, have resulted in significant write-downs of asset values by financial institutions, including government-sponsored entities and major commercial and investment banks. A sustained weakness or weakening in business and economic conditions generally or specifically in the principal markets in which we do business could have one or more of the following adverse effects on our business:
 
 
a decrease in the demand for loans or other products and services offered by us;
     
 
a decrease in the value of our loans or other assets secured by consumer or commercial real estate;
     
 
a decrease to deposit balances due to overall reductions in the accounts of customers;
     
 
an impairment of certain intangible assets or investment securities;
     
 
a decreased ability to raise additional capital on terms acceptable to us or at all; or
     
 
an increase in the number of borrowers who become delinquent, file for protection under bankruptcy laws or default on their loans or other obligations to us. An increase in the number of delinquencies, bankruptcies or defaults could result in a higher level of nonperforming assets, net charge-offs and provision for credit losses, which would reduce our earnings
 
Until conditions improve, we expect our business, financial condition and results of operations to be adversely affected.
 
 
15

 
 
Recent and future legislation and regulatory initiatives to address current market and economic conditions may not achieve their intended objectives, including stabilizing the U.S. banking system or reviving the overall economy.
 
Recent and future legislative and regulatory initiatives to address current market and economic conditions, such as Dodd-Frank, EESA or the ARRA, may not achieve their intended objectives, including stabilizing the U.S. banking system or reviving the overall economy. EESA was enacted in October 2008 to restore confidence and stabilize the volatility in the U.S. banking system and to encourage financial institutions to increase their lending to customers and to each other. Treasury and banking regulators have implemented, and likely will continue to implement, various other programs under this legislation to address capital and liquidity issues in the banking system, including the Troubled Asset Relief Program, or TARP, the CPP, President Obama’s Financial Stability Plan announced in February 2009, the ARRA and the FDIC’s TLGP. There can be no assurance as to the actual impact that any of the recent, or future, legislative and regulatory initiatives will have on the financial markets and the overall economy. Any failure of these initiatives to help stabilize or improve the financial markets and the economy, and a continuation or worsening of current financial market and economic conditions could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations, access to credit or the trading price of our common stock. In addition, many aspects of Dodd-Frank are subject to rulemaking and will take effect over several years, making it difficult to anticipate the overall financial impact on us and the financial services industry more generally.
 
Current levels of market volatility are unprecedented.
 
The capital and credit markets have been experiencing volatility and disruption for several years. The volatility and disruption has reached unprecedented levels. In some cases, the markets have produced downward pressure on stock prices and credit availability for certain issuers without regard to those issuers’ underlying financial strength. If current levels of market disruption and volatility continue or worsen, there can be no assurance that we will not experience an adverse effect, which may be material, on our ability to access capital and on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
Additional requirements under our regulatory framework, especially those imposed under Dodd-Frank, ARRA, EESA or other legislation intended to strengthen the U.S. financial system, could adversely affect us.
 
Recent government efforts to strengthen the U.S. financial system, including the implementation of Dodd-Frank, ARRA, EESA, the TLGP and special assessments imposed by the FDIC, subject participants to additional regulatory fees and requirements, including heightened compliance requirements, corporate governance requirements, executive compensation restrictions, restrictions on declaring or paying dividends, restrictions on share repurchases, limits on executive compensation tax deductions and prohibitions against golden parachute payments. These requirements, and any other requirements that may be subsequently imposed, may have a material and adverse effect on our business, financial condition, and results of operations.
 
Our growth presents certain risks, including a possible decline in credit quality or capital adequacy.
 
The asset growth experienced by National Mercantile and FCB in the years prior to the Mergers and by us after the Mergers presents certain risks. While we believe we have maintained good credit quality notwithstanding such growth, rapid growth is frequently associated with a decline in credit quality. Accordingly, continued asset growth could lead to a decline in credit quality in the future. In addition, continued asset growth could cause a decline in capital adequacy for regulatory purposes, which could in turn cause us to have to raise additional capital in the future to maintain or regain “well capitalized” status as defined under applicable banking regulations.
 
We may be subject to more stringent capital requirements.
 
    Dodd-Frank requires federal banking agencies to establish minimum leverage and risk-based capital requirements that will apply to both insured banks and their holding companies. The federal banking agencies are in the process of developing regulations to implement these requirements. Implementation of these standards, or any other new regulations, including Basel III, may adversely affect our ability to pay dividends, or require us to reduce business levels or raise capital, including in ways that may adversely affect our results of operations of financial condition.
 
Our performance and growth are dependent on maintaining a high quality of service for our customers, and will be impaired by a decline in our quality of service.
 
Our growth will be dependent on maintaining a high quality of service for our customers. As a result of the Mergers and the corresponding growth, it may become increasingly difficult to maintain high service quality for our customers. This could cause a decline in our performance and growth with respect to net income, deposits, assets and other benchmarks.
 
 
16

 
 
The fair value of our investment securities can fluctuate due to market conditions out of our control.
 
Our investment securities portfolio is comprised mainly of U.S. treasury notes/bills, U.S. government agency notes, U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities and U.S. government agency collateralized mortgage obligations. At December 31, 2011, gross unrealized losses on our investment portfolio were $5.6 million. The majority of unrealized losses at December 31, 2011 were related to a type of mortgage-backed security also known as private-label collateralized mortgage obligations. As of December 31, 2011, the amortized cost of these securities, rated triple-A at purchase, was $15.9 million and the gross unrealized loss was $2.8 million and these securities represented 3 percent of our securities portfolio. We also own one pooled trust preferred security, rated triple-A at purchase, with an amortized cost basis of $4.7 million and an unrealized loss of $2.1 million at December 31, 2011. This unrealized loss is primarily caused by a severe disruption in the market for these securities.
 
Factors beyond our control can significantly influence the fair value of securities in our portfolio and can cause potential adverse changes to the fair value of these securities. These factors include but are not limited to rating agency downgrades of the securities, defaults by the issuer or with respect to the underlying securities, changes in market interest rates and continued instability in the credit markets. Any of these mentioned factors could cause an other-than-temporary impairment in future periods and result in a realized loss.
 
If borrowers and guarantors fail to perform as required by the terms of their loans, we will sustain losses.
 
A significant source of risk arises from the possibility that losses will be sustained if our borrowers and guarantors fail to perform in accordance with the terms of their loans and guaranties. This risk increases when the economy is weak. We have adopted underwriting and credit monitoring procedures and credit policies, including the establishment and review of the allowance for loan losses, that we believe are appropriate to minimize this risk by assessing the likelihood of nonperformance, tracking loan performance and diversifying our credit portfolio. These policies and procedures, however, may not prevent unexpected losses that could materially adversely affect our results of operations.
 
Our allowance for loan losses may not be adequate to cover actual losses.
 
In accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, we maintain an allowance for loan losses to provide for probable loan and lease losses. Our allowance for loan losses may not be adequate to cover actual loan and lease losses, and future provisions for credit losses could materially and adversely affect our operating results. Our allowance for loan losses is based on prior experience, as well as an evaluation of the risks in the current portfolio. The amount of future losses is susceptible to changes in economic, operating and other conditions, including changes in interest rates that may be beyond our control, and these losses may exceed current estimates. Federal and state regulatory agencies, as an integral part of their examination process, review our loans and allowance for loan losses. While we believe that our allowance for loan losses is adequate to cover probable losses, it is possible that we will further increase the allowance for loan losses or that regulators will require increases. Either of these occurrences could materially and negatively affect our earnings.
 
The banking business is subject to interest rate risk and variations in interest rates may negatively affect our financial performance.
 
Changes in the interest rate environment may reduce our profits. It is expected that we will continue to realize income from the differential between the interest earned on loans, securities and other interest-earning assets, and interest paid on deposits, borrowings and other interest-bearing liabilities. Net interest margin is affected by the difference between the maturities and repricing characteristics of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities. In addition, loan volume and yields are affected by market interest rates on loans, and rising interest rates generally are associated with a lower volume of loan originations. We may not be able to minimize our interest rate risk. In addition, while an increase in the general level of interest rates may increase our net interest margin and loan yield, it may adversely affect the ability of certain borrowers with variable rate loans to pay the interest on and principal of their obligations. Accordingly, changes in levels of market interest rates could materially and adversely affect our net interest margin, asset quality, loan origination volume and overall profitability.
 
We face strong competition from financial services companies and other companies that offer banking services which could negatively affect our business.
 
We conduct our banking operations in Los Angeles, Orange, Riverside, San Bernardino, San Diego, San Luis Obispo and Ventura counties, California. Increased competition in these markets may result in reduced loans and deposits. Ultimately, we may not be able to compete successfully against current and future competitors. Many competitors offer the same banking services that we offer in our service areas. These competitors include national banks, regional banks and other community banks. We also face competition from many other types of financial institutions, including without limitation, savings and loan institutions, finance companies, brokerage firms, insurance companies, credit unions, mortgage banks and other financial intermediaries. In particular, competitors include several major financial companies whose greater resources may afford them a marketplace advantage by enabling them to maintain numerous banking locations and ATMs and conduct extensive promotional and advertising campaigns.
 
 
17

 
 
Additionally, banks and other financial institutions with larger capitalizations and financial intermediaries not subject to bank regulatory restrictions have larger lending limits than we have and are thereby able to serve the credit needs of larger customers. Areas of competition include interest rates for loans and deposits, efforts to obtain deposits, and range and quality of products and services provided, including new technology-driven products and services. Technological innovation continues to contribute to greater competition in domestic and international financial services markets as technological advances enable more companies to provide financial services. We also face competition from out-of-state financial intermediaries that have opened low-end production offices or that solicit deposits in our market areas. If we are unable to attract and retain banking customers, we may be unable to continue to grow our loan and deposit portfolios and our results of operations and financial condition may otherwise be adversely affected.
 
Changes in economic conditions, in particular an economic slowdown in Southern California, could materially and negatively affect our business.
 
Our business is directly impacted by factors such as economic, political and market conditions, broad trends in industry and finance, legislative and regulatory changes, changes in government monetary and fiscal policies and inflation, all of which are beyond our control. Any further deterioration in economic conditions, whether caused by national or local concerns, in particular any further economic slowdown in Southern California, could result in the following consequences, any of which could hurt our business materially: loan delinquencies may increase; problem assets and foreclosures may increase; demand for our products and services may decrease; low cost or noninterest bearing deposits may decrease; and collateral for loans made by us, especially real estate, may decline in value, in turn reducing customers’ borrowing power, and reducing the value of assets and collateral associated with our existing loans. The State of California and certain local governments in our market area continue to face fiscal challenges upon which the long-term impact on the State’s or the local economy cannot be predicted.
 
A portion of our loan portfolio consists of construction and land development loans in Southern California, which have greater risks than loans secured by completed real properties.
 
At December 31, 2011, we had outstanding construction and land development loans in Southern California in the amount of $58.0 million, representing 5% of our loan portfolio. These types of loans generally have greater risks than loans on completed homes, multifamily properties and commercial properties. A construction loan generally does not cover the full amount of the construction costs, so the borrower must have adequate funds to pay for the balance of the project. Price increases, delays and unanticipated difficulties can materially increase these costs. Further, even if completed, there is no assurance that the borrower will be able to sell the project on a timely or profitable basis, as these are closely related to real estate market conditions, which can fluctuate substantially between the start and completion of the project. If the borrower defaults prior to completion of the project, the value of the project will likely be less than the outstanding loan, and we could be required to complete construction with our own funds to minimize losses on the project.
 
Further disruptions in the real estate market could materially and negatively affect our business.
 
There has been a slow-down in the real estate market due to negative economic trends and credit market disruption, the impacts of which are not yet completely known or quantified. At December 31, 2011, approximately 82% of our loans are secured by real estate. Any further downturn in the real estate market could materially and adversely affect our business because a significant portion of our loans is secured by real estate. Our ability to recover on defaulted loans by selling the real estate collateral would then be diminished and we would be more likely to suffer losses on defaulted loans. An increase in losses on defaulted loans may have a material impact on our financial condition and results of operations, by reducing income, increasing expenses, and leaving less cash available for lending and other activities.
 
Substantially all of our real property loan collateral is located in Southern California. Real estate values have declined recently, particularly in California. If real estate sales and appreciation continue to weaken, especially in Southern California, the collateral for our loans would provide less security. Real estate values have been and could be affected by, among other things, an economic recession or slowdown, an increase in interest rates, earthquakes, brush fires, flooding and other natural disasters particular to California.
 
We are subject to extensive regulation which could adversely affect our business.
 
Our operations are subject to extensive regulation by federal, state and local governmental authorities and are subject to various laws and judicial and administrative decisions imposing requirements and restrictions on part or all of our operations. Because our business is highly regulated, the laws, rules and regulations applicable to us are subject to regular modification and change. There are currently proposed laws, rules and regulations that, if adopted, would impact our operations. For example, Dodd-Frank will have a broad impact on the financial services industry, including imposing significant regulatory and compliance changes, such as: (1) enhanced resolution authority of troubled and failing banks and their holding companies; (2) enhanced lending limits strengthening the existing limits on a depository institution’s credit exposure to one borrower; (3) increased capital and liquidity requirements; (4) increased regulatory examination fees; (5) changes to assessments to be paid to the FDIC for federal deposit insurance; (6) prohibiting bank holding companies, such as us, from including in regulatory Tier 1 capital future issuances of trust preferred securities or other hybrid debt and equity securities; and (7) numerous other provisions designed to improve supervision and oversight of, and strengthening safety and soundness for, the financial services sector. Additionally, Dodd-Frank establishes a new framework for systemic risk oversight within the financial system to be distributed among new and existing federal regulatory agencies, including the Financial Stability Oversight Council, the FRB, the OCC and the FDIC. Further, Dodd-Frank addresses many corporate governance and executive compensation matters that will affect most U.S. publicly traded companies, including us. Many of the requirements called for in Dodd-Frank will be implemented over time and most will be subject to implementing regulations over the course of several years. Given the uncertainty associated with the manner in which the provisions of Dodd-Frank will be implemented by the various regulatory agencies and through regulations, the full extent of the impact such requirements will have on our operations is unclear. The changes resulting from Dodd-Frank may impact the profitability of our business activities, require changes to certain of our business practices, impose upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage ratio requirements or otherwise adversely affect our business. In particular, the potential impact of Dodd-Frank on our operations and activities, both currently and prospectively, include, among others:
 
 
18

 
 
 
a reduction in our ability to generate or originate revenue-producing assets as a result of compliance with heightened capital standards;
     
 
increased cost of operations due to greater regulatory oversight, supervision and examination of banks and bank holding companies, and higher deposit insurance premiums;
     
 
the limitation on our ability to raise capital through the use of trust preferred securities as these securities will no longer be included in Tier 1 capital going forward; and
     
 
the limitation on our ability to expand consumer product and service offerings due to anticipated stricter consumer protection laws and regulations
 
    Further, we may be required to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make necessary changes in order to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements. Failure to comply with the new requirements may negatively impact our results of operations and financial condition. While we cannot predict what effect any presently contemplated or future changes in the laws or regulations or their interpretations would have on us, these changes could be materially adverse to our investors.
 
    In addition, there are other currently proposed laws, rules and regulations that, if adopted, would impact our operations. For example, federal bank regulators have enacted regulations that would (1) require banking organizations to report the structures of all incentive-based compensation arrangements and (2) prohibit incentive-based payment arrangements that encourage inappropriate risks by providing employees, directors, or principal shareholders with excessive compensation or that could lead to material financial loss to the organization.
 
Additionally, in order to conduct certain activities and transactions, including acquisitions, we are required to obtain regulatory approval. There can be no assurance that any required approvals can be obtained, or obtained without conditions or on a timeframe acceptable to us. For more information, please see the section entitled “Item 1. Business-Supervision and Regulation” above.
 
We are exposed to risk of environmental liabilities with respect to properties to which we take title.
 
In the course of our business, we may own or foreclose and take title to real estate, and could be subject to environmental liabilities with respect to these properties. We may be held liable to a governmental entity or to third parties for property damage, personal injury, investigation and clean-up costs incurred by these parties in connection with environmental contamination, or may be required to investigate or clean up hazardous or toxic substances, or chemical releases at a property. The costs associated with investigation or remediation activities could be substantial. In addition, as the owner or former owner of a contaminated site, we may be subject to common law claims by third parties based on damages and costs resulting from environmental contamination emanating from the property. If we ever become subject to significant environmental liabilities, our business, financial condition, liquidity and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected.
 
Our internal operations are subject to a number of risks.
 
We are subject to certain operational risks, including, but not limited to, data processing system failures and errors, customer or employee fraud, security breaches of our computer systems and catastrophic failures resulting from terrorist acts or natural disasters. We maintain a system of internal controls to mitigate against such occurrences and maintain insurance coverage for such risks that are insurable, but should such an event occur that is not prevented or detected by our internal controls and uninsured or in excess of applicable insurance limits, it could have a significant adverse impact on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
 
We face reputation and business risks due to our interactions with business partners, service providers and other third parties.
 
We rely on third parties in a variety of ways, including to provide key components of our business infrastructure or to further our business objectives. These third parties may provide services to us and our clients or serve as partners in business activities. We rely on these third parties to fulfill their obligations to us, to accurately inform us of relevant information and to conduct their activities professionally and in a manner that reflects positively on us. Any failure of our business partners, service providers or other third parties to meet their commitments to us or to perform in accordance with our expectations could harm our business and operations, financial performance, strategic growth or reputation.
 
 
19

 
 
We face risks in connection with our strategic undertakings.
 
If appropriate opportunities present themselves, we may engage in strategic activities, which may include acquisitions, investments, asset purchases or other business growth initiatives or undertakings. There can be no assurance that we will successfully identify appropriate opportunities, that we will be able to negotiate or finance such activities or that such activities, if undertaken, will be successful.
 
In order to finance future strategic undertakings, we might obtain additional equity or debt financing. Such financing might not be available on terms favorable to us, or at all. If obtained, equity financing could be dilutive and the incurrence of debt and contingent liabilities could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
Our ability to execute strategic activities successfully will depend on a variety of factors. These factors likely will vary based on the nature of the activity but may include our success in integrating the operations, services, products, personnel and systems of an acquired company into our business, operating effectively with any partner with whom we elect to do business, retaining key employees, achieving anticipated synergies, meeting management’s expectations and otherwise realizing the undertaking’s anticipated benefits. Our ability to address these matters successfully cannot be assured. In addition, our strategic efforts may divert resources or management’s attention from ongoing business operations and may subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny. If we do not successfully execute a strategic undertaking, it could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations, reputation and growth prospects. In addition, if we were to conclude that the value of an acquired business had decreased and that the related goodwill had been impaired, that conclusion would result in an impairment of goodwill charge to us, which would adversely affect our results of operations.
 
We are dependent on key personnel and the loss of one or more of those key personnel may materially and adversely affect our prospects.
 
We depend heavily on the services of our President and Chief Executive Officer, C. G. Kum, our Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer/Chief Financial Officer, Romolo C. Santarosa and a number of other key management personnel. The loss of any of their services or that of other key personnel could materially and adversely affect our future results of operations and financial condition. Our success also depends in part on our ability to attract and retain additional qualified management personnel. Competition for such personnel is strong in the banking industry and we may not be successful in attracting or retaining the personnel we require.
 
We may incur impairments to goodwill.
 
We assess goodwill for impairment on an annual basis or at interim periods if an event occurs or circumstances change which may indicate a change in the implied fair value of the goodwill. Impairment exists when the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds its implied fair value. It is our practice to perform the annual impairment assessment at the end of our fiscal year and to use independent data to assist us in determining the fair value of the Company and in determining appropriate market factors to be used in the fair value calculations. At December 31, 2011 the annual assessment resulted in the conclusion that goodwill was not impaired. A significant decline in our stock price, a significant decline in our expected future cash flows, a significant change in the fair values of our assets and liabilities, a significant adverse change in the business climate or slower growth rates could result in impairment of our goodwill. If we were to conclude that a future write-down of our goodwill is necessary, then we would record the appropriate non-cash charge, which could have an adverse effect on our operating results and financial position.
 
We are a holding company and depend on our banking subsidiary for dividends, distributions and other payments.
 
We are a holding company that conducts substantially all our operations through our banking subsidiary, First California Bank. As a result, our ability to make dividend payments on our common and preferred stock and debt service payments depends upon the ability of the Bank to make payments, distributions and loans to us. The ability of the Bank to make payments, distributions and loans to us is limited by, among other things, its earnings, its obligation to maintain sufficient capital, and by applicable regulatory restrictions. For example, if, in the opinion of an applicable regulatory authority, the Bank is engaged in or is about to engage in an unsafe or unsound practice, which could include the payment of dividends under certain circumstances, such authority may take actions requiring that the Bank refrain from the practice. Additionally, under applicable California law, the Bank generally cannot make any distribution (including a cash dividend) to its stockholder, us, in an amount which exceeds the lesser of: (1) the retained earnings of the Bank and (2) the net income of the Bank for its last three fiscal years, less the amount of any distributions made by the Bank to its stockholder during such period. If the Bank is not able to make payments, distributions and loans to us, we may not be unable to pay dividends on our common and preferred stock or make debt service payments.
 
 
20

 
 
If we are unable to increase our small business loans within 2 years, the cost of the Series C Preferred Stock will increase to us.
 
If we are unable to redeem the series C non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock prior to December 31, 2013, and we have not increased the amount of qualified small business loans above our baseline amount, the cost of this capital to us will increase substantially on that date, from a maximum of 5.0% per annum (approximately $1.25 million annually) to 7.0% per annum (approximately $1.75 million annually). Depending on our financial condition at the time, this increase in the annual dividend rate on the series C non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock could have a material negative effect on our liquidity and our earnings available to common stockholders.
 
We may experience difficulty in managing the loan portfolios acquired through FDIC-assisted acquisitions, which are within the limits of the shared-loss protection provided by the FDIC.
 
The Bank entered into shared-loss agreements with the FDIC that covered most of SLTB’s and all of WCB’s loans and foreclosed property. The Bank shares in the losses, beginning with the first dollar of loss incurred, on the loans and foreclosed property covered under the shared-loss agreements, or covered assets. Pursuant to the terms of the shared-loss agreements, the FDIC is obligated to reimburse the Bank 80 percent of eligible losses with respect to the covered assets. The Bank has a corresponding obligation to reimburse the FDIC for 80 percent of eligible recoveries with respect to covered assets.
 
The shared-loss agreements for commercial and single-family residential loans are in effect for 5 years and 10 years, respectively, from the acquisition date and the loss recovery provisions are in effect for 8 years and 10 years, respectively, from the acquisition date. Ten years after the acquisition date, the Bank is required to pay the FDIC 50 percent of the excess, if any, of specific amounts stated in the original agreements for each respective acquisition. Although we have expertise in asset resolution, we cannot guarantee that we will be able to adequately manage the loan portfolio within the limits of the shared-loss protection provided by the FDIC. Failure to comply with the requirements of the shared-loss agreements could result in loss of indemnification by the FDIC. Additionally, the Bank is subject to audits by the FDIC, through its designated agent, under the terms of the shared-loss agreements. The requirements of the shared-loss agreements are extensive and failure to comply with any of the guidelines could potentially result in a specific asset or group of assets losing shared-loss coverage.
 
 
21

 
 
Risks Related to Our Common Stock
 
Certain preferences and rights of preferred stockholders of First California may negatively affect the rights of holders of First California common stock.
 
First California’s certificate of incorporation authorizes its Board of Directors to issue up to 2,500,000 shares of preferred stock and to determine the rights, preferences, powers and restrictions granted or imposed upon any series of preferred stock without prior stockholder approval. The preferred stock that may be authorized could have preference over holders of First California common stock with respect to dividends and other distributions upon the liquidation or dissolution of First California. If First California’s Board of Directors authorizes the issuance of additional series of preferred shares having a voting preference over common stock, such issuances may inhibit or delay the approval of measures supported by holders of common stock that require stockholder approval and consequently may make it difficult and expensive for a third party to pursue a tender offer, change in control or takeover attempt that is opposed by our management and Board of Directors. Accordingly, such issuance could substantially impede the ability of public stockholders to benefit from a change in control or change of our management and Board of Directors and, as a result, may adversely affect the market price of our common stock and the stockholders’ ability to realize any potential change of control premium.
 
Currently, in the event of a voluntary or involuntary liquidation or dissolution, holders of series A convertible perpetual preferred stock of First California are entitled to receive a liquidation preference of $1,000 plus an amount equal to 8.5% per annum of the $1,000, which is deemed to have commenced accrual on December 10, 2001. Also, holders of series C non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock of First California are entitled to receive a liquidation preference of $1,000 plus an accrued amount equal to the per-share amount of any unpaid dividends for the then-current period, if any. These amounts are payable out of the assets of First California before any distribution to holders of common stock. If the number of preferred shares having a similar liquidation preference increases, the chance that holders of common stock may receive a smaller distribution upon liquidation or dissolution may be higher.
 
Certain regulations and restrictions will affect our ability to declare or pay dividends and repurchase our shares.
 
As a result of our participation in the SBLF, our ability to declare or pay dividends on any of our common stock has been limited. Specifically, we are not able to repurchase shares or declare dividend payments on our common, junior preferred or pari passu preferred stock if we are in arrears on the dividends on our series C non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock. Furthermore, First California is permitted to make dividend payments to, or effectuate share repurchases from, other shareholders, provided that after the payment or repurchase, the institution’s Tier 1 capital would be at least 90 percent of the amount existing at the time immediately after the SBLF closing date, excluding any subsequent net charge-offs and partial repayments of the SBLF funding.
 
Our ability to pay dividends to holders of our common stock may be restricted by Delaware law and under the terms of indentures governing the trust preferred securities we have issued.
 
Our ability to pay dividends to our stockholders is restricted in specified circumstances under indentures governing the trust preferred securities we have issued, and we may issue additional securities with similar restrictions in the future. In addition, our ability to pay any dividends to our stockholders is subject to the restrictions set forth under Delaware law. We cannot assure you that we will meet the criteria specified under these agreements or under Delaware law in the future, in which case we may not be able to pay dividends on our common stock even if we were to choose to do so.
 
The price of our common stock may fluctuate significantly, and this may make it difficult for you to resell our common stock when you want to or at prices you find attractive.
 
We cannot predict how our common stock will trade in the future. The market value of our common stock will likely continue to fluctuate in response to a number of factors including the following, most of which are beyond our control, as well as the other factors described in this “RISK FACTORS” section:
 
 
actual or anticipated quarterly fluctuations in our operating and financial results;
     
 
developments related to investigations, proceedings or litigation that involve us;
     
 
changes in financial estimates and recommendations by financial analysts;
     
 
dispositions, acquisitions and financings;
     
 
actions of our current stockholders, including sales of our Common Stock by existing stockholders and our directors and executive officers;
     
 
fluctuations in the stock price and operating results of our competitors;
     
 
regulatory developments; and
     
 
developments related to the financial services industry.
 
 
22

 
 
Only a limited trading market exists for our common stock, which could lead to significant price volatility.
 
Our common stock was designated for listing on the NASDAQ Global Market in March 2007 under the trading symbol “FCAL” and trading volumes since that time have been modest. The limited trading market for our common stock may cause fluctuations in the market value of our common stock to be exaggerated, leading to price volatility in excess of that which would occur in a more active trading market of our common stock. In addition, even if a more active market in our common stock develops, we cannot assure you that such a market will continue or that stockholders will be able to sell their shares.
 
A holder with as little as a 5% interest in First California could, under certain circumstances, be subject to regulation as a “Bank Holding Company.”
 
Any entity (including a “group” composed of natural persons) owning 25% or more of the outstanding First California common stock, or 5% or more if such holder otherwise exercises a “controlling influence” over First California, may be subject to regulation as a “bank holding company” in accordance with the BHCA. In addition, (i) any bank holding company or foreign bank with a U.S. presence may be required to obtain the approval of the FRB under the BHCA to acquire or retain 5% or more of the outstanding First California common stock and (ii) any person other than a bank holding company may be required to obtain the approval of the FRB under the Change in Bank Control Act to acquire or retain 10% or more of the outstanding First California common stock. Becoming a bank holding company imposes certain statutory and regulatory restrictions and burdens, and might require the holder to divest all or a portion of the holder’s investment in First California. In addition, because a bank holding company is required to provide managerial and financial strength for its bank subsidiary, such a holder may be required to divest investments that may be deemed incompatible with bank holding company status, such as a material investment in a company unrelated to banking.
 
Concentrated ownership of our common stock creates risks for our stockholders, including a risk of sudden changes in our share price.
 
As of January 31, 2012, directors, executive officers and other affiliates of First California owned approximately 22% of First California’s outstanding common stock (not including vested option shares). As a result, if all of these stockholders were to take a common position, they would be able to significantly affect the election of directors, with respect to which stockholders are authorized to use cumulative voting, as well as the outcome of most corporate actions requiring stockholder approval, such as the approval of mergers or other business combinations. Such concentration may also have the effect of delaying or preventing a change in control of First California. In some situations, the interests of First California’s directors and executive officers may be different from other stockholders.
 
Investors who purchase our common stock may be subject to certain risks due to the concentrated ownership of our common stock. The sale by any of our large stockholders of a significant portion of that stockholder’s holdings could have a material adverse effect on the market price of our common stock. Furthermore, a group of our large stockholders can also demand that we register their shares under certain circumstances. Any such increase in the number of our publicly registered shares may cause the market price of our common stock to decline or fluctuate significantly.
 
We do not expect to pay dividends on our common stock in the foreseeable future.
 
We have never paid a cash dividend on our common stock and we do not expect to pay a cash dividend in the foreseeable future. We presently intend to retain earnings and increase capital in furtherance of our overall business objectives. We will periodically review our dividend policy in view of the operating performance of the company, and may declare dividends in the future if such payments are deemed appropriate.
 
There may be future sales of additional common stock or preferred stock or other dilution of our equity, which may adversely affect the market price of our common stock.
 
We are not restricted from issuing additional common stock or preferred stock, including any securities that are convertible into or exchangeable for, or that represent the right to receive, common stock or preferred stock or any substantially similar securities. On March 3, 2010, a proposal was approved by our stockholders to amend our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation to increase the number of authorized shares of our common stock from 25,000,000 shares to 100,000,000 shares. This increase in the number of our authorized shares of common stock provides us with the flexibility to consider and respond to future business opportunities and needs as they arise, including equity offerings, acquisitions, stock dividends, issuances under stock incentive plans and other corporate purposes. The market value of our common stock could decline as a result of sales by us of a large number of shares of common stock or preferred stock or similar securities in the market or the perception that such sales could occur.
 
Unresolved Staff Comments
 
None.
 
 
23

 
 
Properties
 
The Bank leases approximately 21,900 square feet of space at Westlake Park Place, 3027 Townsgate Road, Westlake Village, California for its administrative headquarters. The lease term will expire in February 2019.
 
The Bank also leases approximately 13,900 square feet of space for administrative functions located at 1880 Century Park East, Los Angeles, California. The lease term will expire in May 2014. The Bank has sublet approximately half of this space through March 2014.
 
The Bank owns its Camarillo Branch Office located at 1150 Paseo Camarillo, Camarillo, California. The building has approximately 9,000 square feet of space.
 
The Bank leases approximately 4,000 square feet of space for its Westlake Village Branch Office located at 32111 Agoura Road, Westlake Village, California. The lease term will expire in December 2014.
 
The Bank leases approximately 2,200 square feet of space for its Ventura Branch Office located at 1794 S. Victoria Avenue, Suite B, Ventura, California. The lease term will expire in May 2012.
 
The Bank leases approximately 1,700 square feet of space for its Oxnard Branch Office located at 300 Esplanade Drive, Suite 102, Oxnard, California. The lease term will expire in January 2016.
 
The Bank leases approximately 3,850 square feet of space for its Thousand Oaks Branch Office located at 11 E. Hillcrest Drive, Suite A, Thousand Oaks, California. The lease term will expire in October 2013 with two 5-year renewal options.
 
The Bank leases approximately 27,000 square feet of land for its Simi Valley Branch Office located at Simi Valley Towne Center, Simi Valley, California. The Bank owns the building which has approximately 5,000 square feet of space. The land lease term commenced in January 2006 and expires in 20 years.
 
The Bank leases approximately 1,900 square feet of space for its Century City Branch Office located at 1880 Century Park East, Los Angeles, California. The lease term will expire in June 2014.
 
The Bank leases approximately 1,650 square feet of space for its Encino Branch Office located at 16661 Ventura Boulevard, Encino, California. The lease term will expire in May 2012.
 
The Bank owns its Torrance Branch Office located at 2200 Sepulveda Blvd., Torrance, California. The building has approximately 15,966 square feet of space.
 
The Bank owns its Irvine Branch Office located at 19752 MacArthur Blvd., Irvine, California 92612. The building has approximately 21,000 square feet of space. The Bank has sublet a portion of this space through July 2013.
 
The Bank leases approximately 6,000 square feet of space for its Woodland Hills Branch Office located at 21550 Oxnard Street, Suite 100, Woodland Hills, California. The lease term will expire in March 2016.
 
The Bank leases approximately 3,500 square feet of space for its Glendale Branch Office located at 505 North Brand Boulevard, Glendale, California. The lease has an initial term of five years and will expire in November 2013.
 
The Bank leases approximately 8,500 square feet of space for its Redlands Branch Office located at 218 East State Street, Redlands, California. The lease term will expire in July 2014.
 
The Bank leases approximately 5,100 square feet of space for its Brea Branch Office located at 10 Pointe Drive, Suite 130, Brea, California. The lease term will expire in May 2014.
 
The Bank leases approximately 3,700 square feet of space for its Escondido Office located at 320 West Mission Avenue, Escondido, California. The lease term will expire in February 2021.
 
The Bank leases approximately 4,500 square feet of space for its Palm Desert Branch Office located at 78-000 Fred Waring Drive, suite 100, Palm Desert, California. The lease term will expire in May 2014.
 
The Bank leases approximately 4,600 square feet of space for its Irwindale Branch Office located at 15622 Arrow Highway, Irwindale, California. The lease term will expire in May 2014.
 
The Bank leases approximately 5,000 square feet of space for its Temecula Branch Office located at 27645 Jefferson Avenue, Temecula, California. The lease term will expire in June 2012.
 
The Bank lease approximately 5,120 square feet of space for its San Luis Obispo Office located at 1001 Marsh Street, San Luis Obispo, California. The lease term will expire in August 2016.
 
 
24

 
 
The Bank leases approximately 1,220 square feet of space for its temporary Palm Springs Office located at 333 S. Indian Canyon Drive, suite E, Palm Springs, California. The lease term will expire in November 2012.
 
The Bank leases approximately 8,800 square feet of space for its Electronic Payment Services Division located at 70115 Highway 111, Rancho Mirage, California. The lease term will expire in December 2018.
 
The Bank believes that its premises will be adequate for present and anticipated needs. The Bank also believes that it has adequate insurance to cover its owned and leased premises.
 
Legal Proceedings
 
The information set forth in “Note 22-Commitments and Contingencies” of the Company’s Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Mine Safety Disclosures
 
    Not Applicable.
 
 
25

 
 
PART II
 
Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
The common stock of First California began trading on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “FCAL” on March 13, 2007. Prior to that time, the common stock of National Mercantile, First California’s predecessor, traded on the NASDAQ Capital Market under the symbol “MBLA”. The information in the following table indicates the high and low sales prices for First California’s common stock from January 1, 2010 to December 31, 2011, as reported by NASDAQ. Because of the limited market for First California’s common stock, these prices may not be indicative of the fair market value of the common stock. The information does not include transactions for which no public records are available. The trading prices in such transactions may be higher or lower than the prices reported below.
 
   
Common Stock
 
   
High
   
Low
 
2010
           
First Quarter
  $ 3.38     $ 2.54  
Second Quarter
    3.50       2.61  
Third Quarter
    2.91       2.36  
Fourth Quarter
    2.90       2.26  
                 
2011
               
First Quarter
  $ 4.09     $ 2.80  
Second Quarter
    4.00       3.40  
Third Quarter
    3.95       2.77  
Fourth Quarter
    3.72       2.79  
 
At March 12, 2012, First California had 386 stockholders of record for its common stock. The number of beneficial owners for the common stock is higher, as many people hold their shares in “street” name.
 
Dividends
 
From its inception and until the completion of the Mergers in March 2007, First California was a “business combination shell company,” conducting no operations or owning or leasing any real estate or other property. Accordingly, First California did not pay any dividends to its sole stockholder, National Mercantile, prior to the Mergers, nor has First California paid any dividends to its common stockholders since the completion of the Mergers. Our common stockholders are entitled to receive dividends when and as declared by our Board of Directors, out of funds legally available therefore, subject to the restrictions set forth in the Delaware General Corporation Law, or the DGCL. The DGCL provides that a corporation may declare and pay dividends out of any surplus, and, if it has no surplus, out of any net profits for the fiscal year in which the dividend was declared or for the preceding fiscal year (provided that the payment will not reduce capital to an amount less than the aggregate amount of the capital represented by the issued and outstanding stock of all classes having a preference upon the distribution of assets). In addition, First California may not pay dividends on its capital stock if it is in default or has elected to defer payments of interest under its junior subordinated debentures. The Company cannot declare or pay a dividend on its common stock if we are in arrears on the dividends on our series C non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock.
 
We do not currently expect to pay a cash dividend to our common stockholders in the foreseeable future. We presently intend to retain earnings and increase capital in furtherance of our overall business objectives. We will periodically review our dividend policy in view of the operating performance of the company, and may declare dividends in the future if such payments are deemed appropriate.
 
 
26

 
 
Securities Authorized for Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans
 
The following table sets forth as of December 31, 2011 information regarding outstanding options and the number of shares available for future option grants under all of our equity compensation plans. All equity plans of FCB Bancorp, in addition to those of National Mercantile Bancorp and all outstanding option awards were assumed by First California in connection with the Mergers.
 
Plan Category
 
Number of
securities to be
issued upon exercise
of outstanding
options, warrants
and rights
   
Weighted-average
exercise price of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights
   
Number of
securities remaining
available for future
issuance under equity
compensation plans
(excluding securities
reflected in column
(a))
 
   
(a)
   
(b)
   
(c)
 
Equity compensation plans approved
by shareholders (1)
    590,008     $ 7.86       1,501,910  
Equity compensation plans not approved by shareholders
    N/A       N/A       N/A  
Total
    590,008     $ 7.86       1,501,910  
 

(1)
Includes the First California 2007 Omnibus Equity Incentive Plan (as amended May 26, 2011), FCFG FCB 2005 Stock Option Plan, FCFG 2005 NMB Stock Incentive Plan, FCFG Amended 1996 NMB Stock Incentive Plan, FCFG 1994 NMB Stock Option Plan.
 
Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities
 
None
 
Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
There were no shares repurchased by the Company during the year ended December 31, 2011.
 
Selected Financial Data
 
Not applicable.
 
 
27

 
 
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
 
Forward-Looking Statements
 
This discussion contains certain forward-looking information about us; we intend such statements to fall under the safe harbor for “forward-looking statements” provided by the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. All statements other than statements of historical fact are forward-looking statements. Such statements involve inherent risks and uncertainties, many of which are difficult to predict and are generally beyond our control. We caution readers that a number of important factors could cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in, implied or projected by, such forward-looking statements. Risks and uncertainties include, but are not limited to:
 
 
revenues are lower than expected;
     
 
credit quality deterioration, which could cause an increase in the provision for loan losses;
     
 
competitive pressure among depository institutions increases significantly;
     
 
changes in consumer spending, borrowings and savings habits;
     
 
our ability to successfully integrate acquired entities or to achieve expected synergies and operating efficiencies within expected time-frames or at all;
     
 
a slowdown in construction activity;
     
 
technological changes;
     
 
the cost of additional capital is more than expected;
     
 
a change in the interest rate environment reduces interest margins;
     
 
asset/liability repricing risks and liquidity risks;
     
 
general economic conditions, particularly those affecting real estate values, either nationally or in the market areas in which we do or anticipate doing business, are less favorable than expected;
     
 
legislative, accounting or regulatory requirements or changes adversely affecting our business;
     
 
the effects of and changes in monetary and fiscal policies and laws, including the interest rate policies of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve, or the Federal Reserve Board;
     
 
the costs and effects of legal, accounting and regulatory developments;
     
 
recent volatility in the credit or equity markets and its effect on the general economy;
     
 
regulatory approvals for acquisitions cannot be obtained on the terms expected or on the anticipated schedule; and
     
 
demand for the products or services of First California and the Bank, as well as their ability to attract and retain qualified people.
 
If any of these risks or uncertainties materializes, or if any of the assumptions underlying such forward-looking statements proves to be incorrect, our results could differ materially from those expressed in, implied or projected by, such forward-looking statements. For information with respect to factors that could cause actual results to differ from the expectations stated in the forward-looking statements, see “Risk Factors” under Part I, Item 1A of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. We urge investors to consider all of these factors carefully in evaluating the forward-looking statements contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. We make these forward-looking as of the date of this document and we do not intend, and assume no obligation, to update the forward-looking statements or to update the reasons why actual results could differ from those expressed in, or implied or projected by, the forward-looking statements. All forward-looking statements contained in this document and all subsequent written and oral forward-looking statements attributable to us or any other person acting on our behalf, are expressly qualified by these cautionary statements.
 
Overview
 
First California Financial Group, Inc., or First California, or the Company, is a bank holding company which serves the comprehensive banking needs of businesses and individuals in Los Angeles, Orange, Riverside, San Bernardino, San Diego, San Luis Obispo and Ventura counties through our wholly-owned subsidiary, First California Bank, or the Bank. The Bank is a state chartered commercial bank that provides traditional business and consumer banking products and services through 19 full-service branch locations. The Company also has two unconsolidated statutory business trust subsidiaries, First California Capital Trust I and FCB Statutory Trust I, which raised capital through the issuance of trust preferred securities.
 
At December 31, 2011, we had consolidated total assets of $1.8 billion, total loans of $1.1 billion, total deposits of $1.4 billion and shareholders’ equity of $223.1 million. A year ago, at December 31, 2010, we had consolidated total assets of $1.5 billion, total loans of $1.0 billion, total deposits of $1.2 billion and shareholders’ equity of $198.0 million. The increase in loans and deposits was due in part to the FDIC-assisted San Luis Trust Bank transaction and the acquisition of the EPS division during 2011.
 
 
28

 
 
On November 5, 2010, the Bank assumed all of the deposits and substantially all of the assets of Western Commercial Bank, located in Woodland Hills, California, from the FDIC. The Bank acquired approximately $109 million of total assets, including $55 million in loans related to the transaction. The Bank assumed approximately $105 million of deposits related to the transaction. We accounted for the FDIC-assisted Western Commercial Bank transaction using the acquisition method of accounting; accordingly, our balance sheet includes the estimates of the fair value of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed. Our results of operations for the twelve months ended December 31, 2010 include the effects of the FDIC-assisted Western Commercial Bank transaction from the date of the transaction. As part of the Purchase and Assumption Agreement, the Bank and the FDIC entered into shared-loss agreements, whereby the FDIC will cover a substantial portion of any future losses on loans (and related unfunded loan commitments), foreclosed property and accrued interest on loans for up to 90 days. Under the terms of the shared-loss agreements, the FDIC will absorb 80 percent of losses and share in 80 percent of loss recoveries. The shared-loss agreements for commercial mortgage loans are in effect for 5 years from the November 5, 2010 acquisition date and the loss recovery provisions are in effect for 8 years from the acquisition date. The Bank continues to operate the one former WCB branch location as part of the Bank’s 19 branch locations.
 
On February 18, 2011, the Bank assumed certain liabilities and acquired certain assets and substantially all of the operations of San Luis Trust Bank, or SLTB, located in San Luis Obispo, California, from the FDIC. The Bank acquired, received and recognized certain assets with an estimated fair value of approximately $367 million, including $139 million of loans, $99 million of cash and federal funds sold, $70 million of a FDIC shared-loss asset, $41 million of securities, $13 million of foreclosed property and $5 million of other assets. The Bank also assumed and recognized liabilities with an estimated fair value of approximately $346 million, including $266 million of deposits, $62 million of Federal Home Loan Bank advances, $15 million in a deferred tax liability, $2.6 million of a FDIC shared-loss liability and $0.4 million of other liabilities. The Bank recorded a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $36.5 million in connection with this transaction. As part of the Purchase and Assumption Agreement, the Bank and the FDIC entered into shared-loss agreements, whereby the FDIC will cover a substantial portion of any future losses on loans (and related unfunded loan commitments), foreclosed property and accrued interest on loans for up to 90 days. Under the terms of the shared-loss agreements, the FDIC will absorb 80 percent of losses and share in 80 percent of loss recoveries. The shared-loss agreements for commercial and residential mortgage loans are in effect for 5 years and 10 years, respectively, from the February 18, 2011 acquisition date and the loss recovery provisions are in effect for 8 years and 10 years, respectively, from the acquisition date. Our results of operations for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 include the effects of the FDIC-assisted San Luis Trust bank transaction from the date of the transaction. The Bank continues to operate the one former SLTB branch location as part of the Bank’s 19 branch locations.
 
On April 8, 2011, the Bank completed the acquisition of the Electronic Banking Solutions division of Palm Desert National Bank. The transaction included the division’s customer base, core deposits, and employees. The Electronic Payment Services Division, or the EPS division, its new name under the Bank, issues prepaid cards and sponsors merchant acquiring services for all national and regional networks, including Visa, MasterCard, and Discover throughout all 50 states and U.S. territories. The Bank acquired cash of $85.4 million, recognized intangible assets of $6.0 million, assumed $91 million of deposits and recognized a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $0.5 million in connection with this transaction. Our results of operations for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 include the effects of the EPS acquisition from the date of the transaction.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2011, we had net income of $23.4 million compared to net income of $1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. After dividend payments of $2.6 million on our Series B and Series C preferred shares, including a $1.1 million deemed dividend related to the full redemption of our Series B preferred shares in the third quarter of 2011, we had net income per diluted common share of $0.71 for the year ended December 31, 2011. After dividend payments of $1.3 million on our Series B preferred shares, we had net income per diluted common share of $0.01 for the year ended December 31, 2010. The significant increase in net income in 2011 was due largely to the bargain purchase gains on the SLTB and EPS acquisitions.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2010, we had net income of $1.4 million compared to a net loss of $4.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2009. After dividend payments of $1.3 million on our Series B preferred shares, we had net income per diluted common share of $0.01 for the year ended December 31, 2010. After dividend payments of $1.1 million on our Series B preferred shares, we incurred a loss per diluted common share of $0.50 for the year ended December 31, 2009. The net loss for 2009 was largely due to the $16.6 million provision for loan losses. The provision for loan losses was $8.3 million for 2010.
 
Critical Accounting Policies
 
We base our discussion and analysis of our consolidated results of operations and financial condition on our audited consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. The preparation of these consolidated financial statements requires us to make estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, income and expense, and the related disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of these consolidated financial statements. We believe these estimates and assumptions to be reasonably accurate; however, actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or circumstances. The following are our critical accounting policies and estimates.
 
 
29

 
 
Allowance for loan losses
 
We establish the allowance for loan losses through a provision charged to expense. We charge-off loans against the allowance when we believe that the collectability of the loan is unlikely. We perform periodic and systematic detailed reviews of the loan portfolio to identify trends and to assess the overall collectability of the loan portfolio. The allowance is an amount that we believe will be adequate to absorb probable losses on existing loans that may become uncollectible based on evaluations of the collectability of loans and prior loan loss experience. We believe the accounting estimate related to the allowance for loan losses is a “critical accounting estimate” because: changes in it can materially affect the provision for loan losses and net income, it requires management to predict borrowers’ likelihood or capacity to repay, and it requires management to distinguish between losses incurred as of a balance sheet date and losses expected to be incurred in the future. Accordingly, this is a highly subjective process and requires significant judgment since it is often difficult to determine when specific loss events may actually occur. Our evaluation includes an assessment of the following factors: any external loan review and any regulatory examination, estimated probable loss exposure on each pool of loans, concentrations of credit, value of collateral, the level of delinquent and nonaccrual loans, trends in the portfolio volume, effects of any changes in the lending policies and procedures, changes in lending personnel, present economic conditions at the local, state and national levels, the amount of undisbursed off-balance sheet commitments, and a migration analysis of historical losses and recoveries for the prior twenty quarters. We also evaluate individual loans for impairment and if a portion of a loan is impaired, we charge-off the impaired amount or allocate a specific reserve for that loan. Various regulatory agencies, as a regular part of their examination process, periodically review our allowance for loan losses. Such agencies may require us to recognize additions to the allowance based on their judgment of information available to them at the time of their examinations. The allowance for loan losses was $17.7 million at December 31, 2011 and $17.0 million at December 31, 2010.
 
Non-covered foreclosed property
 
    We acquire, through foreclosure or through full or partial satisfaction of a non-covered loan, real or personal property. At the time of foreclosure, we obtain an appraisal of the property and record the property at its estimated fair value less costs to sell. We charge the allowance for loan losses for the loan amount in excess of the fair value of the non-covered foreclosed property received; we credit earnings for the fair value amount of the non-covered foreclosed property in excess of the non-covered loan due. Subsequent to foreclosure, we periodically assess our disposition efforts and the estimated fair value less costs to sell of the non-covered foreclosed property. We establish a valuation allowance through a charge to earnings for estimated declines in fair value subsequent to foreclosure. Operating income and operating expense related to non-covered foreclosed property is included in earnings as are any ultimate gains or losses on the sale of the non-covered foreclosed property. Our recognition of gain is, however, dependent on the buyer’s initial investment in the purchase of the non-covered foreclosed property meeting certain criteria. The estimated fair value of non-covered foreclosed property was $20.3 million at December 31, 2011 and $26.0 million at December 31, 2010.
 
Covered foreclosed property
 
    All foreclosed property acquired in FDIC-assisted acquisitions that are subject to a FDIC shared-loss agreement are referred to as “covered foreclosed property” and reported separately in our consolidated balance sheets. Covered foreclosed property is reported exclusive of expected reimbursement cash flows from the FDIC. Foreclosed covered loan collateral is transferred into covered foreclosed property at the collateral’s net realizable value, less estimated selling costs.
 
    Covered foreclosed property was initially recorded at its estimated fair value on the acquisition date based on similar market comparable valuations less estimated selling costs. Any subsequent valuation adjustments due to declines in fair value will be charged to non-interest expense, and will be mostly offset by non-interest income representing the corresponding increase to the FDIC shared-loss asset for the offsetting loss reimbursement amount. Any recoveries of previous valuation adjustments will be credited to non-interest expense with a corresponding charge to non-interest income for the portion of the recovery that is due to the FDIC. The estimated fair value of covered foreclosed property was $14.6 million at December 31, 2011 and $1.0 million at December 31, 2010.
 
Deferred income taxes
 
    We recognize deferred tax assets subject to our judgment that realization of the assets are more-likely-than-not. We establish a valuation allowance when we determine that realization of income tax benefits may not occur in future years. There were net deferred tax liabilities of $7.4 million at December 31, 2011 and net deferred tax assets of $4.6 million at December 31, 2010. There were no valuation allowances at either year-end.
 
FDIC shared-loss asset
 
We initially recorded the FDIC shared-loss asset at fair value, based on the discounted value of expected future cash flows under the shared-loss agreements. We accrete into non-interest income over the life of the FDIC shared-loss asset the difference between the present value and the undiscounted cash flows we expect to collect from the FDIC. Subsequent to initial recognition, we review quarterly the FDIC shared-loss asset and adjust for any changes in expected cash flows based on recent performance and expectations for future performance of the covered portfolio. We measure these adjustments on the same basis as the related covered loans, at a pool level, and covered foreclosed property. Generally, any increases in cash flow of the covered assets over those previously expected will result in prospective increases in the loan pool yield and amortization of the FDIC shared-loss asset. Any decreases in cash flow of the covered assets under those previously expected will trigger impairments on the underlying loan pools and will result in a corresponding gain on the FDIC shared-loss asset. We record increases and decreases to the FDIC shared-loss asset as adjustments to non-interest income. The FDIC shared-loss asset was $68.1 million at December 31, 2011 and $16.7 million at December 31, 2010.
 
 
30

 
 
FDIC shared-loss liability
 
    Forty-five days following the tenth anniversary of the WCB and SLTB acquisition dates, we will be required to perform a calculation and determine if a payment to the FDIC is necessary. The payment amount will be 50 percent of the excess, if any, of (i) 20 percent of the intrinsic loss estimate minus (ii) the sum of (a) 20 percent of the net loss amount, plus (b) 25 percent of the asset discount bid, plus (c) 3.5 percent of total loss share assets at acquisition. Our estimate for the present value of this liability was $3.8 million and $1.0 million at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
Derivative instruments and hedging
 
For derivative instruments designated in cash flow hedging relationships, we assess the effectiveness of the instruments in offsetting changes in the overall cash flows of designated hedged transactions on a quarterly basis. The Company recognizes the unrealized gains or losses of derivative instruments directly in current period earnings to the extent these instruments are not effective. At December 31, 2011, the Company had $37.1 million notional interest rate caps to limit the variable interest rate payments on our $26.8 million junior subordinated debentures. Our quarterly effectiveness assessments throughout 2011 indicated that these instruments were effective.
 
At December 31, 2011, the Bank had $120 million notional interest rate caps that do not meet the criteria for hedge accounting to manage the interest rate risk associated with its fixed rate securities and loans. Derivatives not designated as hedges are marked-to-market each period through earnings. At December 31, 2011, the estimated fair value of these interest rate caps was $291,000 and this amount is recorded within “accrued interest receivable and other assets” on the consolidated balance sheets.
 
Assessments of impairment
 
We assess goodwill for impairment on an annual basis as of December 31, or at interim periods if an event occurs or circumstances change that may indicate impairment may potentially exist. We estimate the implied fair value of goodwill by comparing the estimated fair value of the Company to the estimated fair value of the Company’s individual assets, liabilities, and identifiable intangible assets. Impairment exists when the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds this implied fair value.
 
At December 31, 2011, we had goodwill of $60.7 million. We recognized goodwill of $50.1 million in connection with the Merger in 2007 and $10.6 million in connection with the FDIC-assisted 1st Centennial Bank transaction in 2009. We consolidated all operations under First California Bank at the time of each transaction; accordingly, we performed our goodwill impairment analysis on a consolidated or single unit basis.
 
The first step of our analysis compared the fair value of the Company to the carrying amount of the Company, including goodwill. At December 31, 2011, the measurement date, the carrying amount of the Company was $223.1 million. We used various approaches to estimate the fair value of the Company as described below:
 
Market Approach—Publicly Traded Companies—This approach considers the fair value of the Company based on observed, traded values of similar companies. We identified 15 publicly traded financial institutions to serve as guideline companies based on size, geography and performance metrics. We made an adjustment for a control premium, or the price at which a willing buyer and seller would complete a transaction. We assigned a weighting of 20 percent to this methodology.
 
Market Approach—Recent Transactions—This approach considers the fair value of the Company based on observed, key pricing multiples arising from similar control transactions using recent transactions. We assigned a weighting of 20 percent to this methodology.
 
Market Price Analysis—This approach considers the trading price of the Company as of the valuation date and adjusts for a control premium. We listed our common stock on the NASDAQ Global Market under the trading symbol “FCAL” and our trading volumes have been modest since the Merger. The limited trading for our common stock, we believe, causes exaggerated fluctuations in the market value of our common stock, leading to price volatility in excess of that which would occur in a more active trading market of our common stock. We used this method as a benchmark to the valuation performed in the Income approach below and was not a direct component of the valuation.
 
 
31

 
 
Income Approach—Discounted Cash Flow Method—This approach considers the present value of the Company’s expected future cash flows. We believe this approach is the most theoretically correct method of valuation since it explicitly considers the future benefits associated with owning the business. We estimated our five-year future free cash flow and then discounted these to a present value at a rate of return that considers the relative risk of achieving the projected cash flows and the time value of money. We also estimated the residual or terminal free cash flow at the end of the projection period and discounted this to a present value. We assigned a weighting of 60 percent to this methodology.
 
Based on this first step of the impairment analysis, we determined that the carrying value of goodwill exceeded its fair value and therefore indicated a potential impairment. If this first step indicates a potential impairment, we next determine or estimate the implied fair value of the goodwill. That is, we estimated the fair value of the Company’s individual assets and liabilities and then compared these to the fair value determined above. The excess of the fair value of the Company over the fair value of its tangible and intangible assets and liabilities is the implied fair value of goodwill as of the measurement date.
 
The following provides a summary of the valuation methodology we used in determining the fair values of major tangible assets, intangible assets and liabilities. We believe these methodologies are consistent with industry practices:
 
Securities —valued in the same manner as presented on our balance sheet.
 
Non-covered and covered loans —We divided loans into three major groups. The loan groups included (1) loans that mature or re-price in three months or less, (2) loans that amortize or mature in more than three months, and (3) impaired loans. We estimated the fair value of impaired loans and loans that mature or re-price within three months at their carrying value. We used a discounted cash flow methodology to estimate the fair value of loans that amortize or mature in more than three months. We developed pools of these loans based on similar characteristics such as underlying type of collateral, fixed or adjustable rate of interest, payment or amortization method and other factors. We projected monthly principal and interest cash flows based on the contractual terms of the loan, adjusted for assumed prepayments, and discounted these at a rate that considered funding costs, a market participant’s required rate of return and adjusted for servicing costs and a liquidity discount.
 
Deposits and borrowings with maturities—We used a discounted cash flow methodology to estimate the fair value of our certificates of deposits, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, Federal Home Loan Bank advances and junior subordinated debentures. The discount rate for certificates of deposits considered published retail and brokered rates as of the measurement date. The discount rate for securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Federal Home Loan Bank advances considered published rates as of the measurement date. The discount rate for our junior subordinated debentures considered comparable rates from recent and comparable issuances.
 
Core deposit intangibles—Core deposits are comprised of checking, savings and money market deposits. The value ascribed to the core deposit base is equal to the present value of the difference in cash flows between maintaining the existing core deposit base and obtaining alternative funds over the life of the deposit base. The cost of maintaining the existing core deposit base includes both the interest cost associated with the deposit and net maintenance costs (i.e., FDIC insurance, opportunity cost of reserve requirements, less service charge income and other deposit related revenue). We assumed the cost of alternative funding to be equivalent to brokered CD rates for deposit equivalent durations as of the measurement date. The discount rate considered the relative risk of achieving the projected cash flows and the time value of money.
 
Based on the results of this second step of the impairment analysis, we concluded that the implied fair value of goodwill was greater than our carrying value and that no goodwill impairment existed at December 31, 2011.
 
A significant decline in our stock price, a significant decline in our expected future cash flows, a significant change in the fair values of our assets and liabilities, a significant adverse change in the business climate or slow growth rates could result in impairment of our goodwill. If we were to conclude that a future write-down of our goodwill is necessary, we would record the appropriate non-cash charge, which could have a material adverse effect on our operating results and financial position; however, such non-cash charge would have no effect on our cash balances, liquidity or regulatory risk-based capital ratios.
 
We also undertake an impairment analysis on our debt and equity securities each quarter. When we do not intend to sell, and it is more-likely-than-not that we are not required to sell, a debt security before recovery of its cost basis, we separate other-than-temporary impairment into (a) the amount representing credit loss and (b) the amount related to other factors. We recognize in earnings the amount of the other-than-temporary impairment related to credit loss. We recognize in other comprehensive income the amount of other-than-temporary impairment related to other factors. Our assessment of other-than-temporary declines in fair value considers the duration the debt security has been in a continuous unrealized loss position, the severity of the decline in value, the rating of the debt security, and the long-term financial outlook of the issuer. In addition, we consider the expected future cash flows of the debt security and our ability and intent on holding the debt security until the fair values recover.
 
For 2011, other-than-temporary impairment related to the credit loss on debt securities and recognized in earnings was $1.4 million.
 
For 2010, other-than-temporary impairment related to the credit loss on debt securities and recognized in earnings was $0.7 million. In addition, we recognized impairment of $41,000 on a $1.0 million community development-related equity investment.
 
For 2009, other-than-temporary impairment related to the credit loss on debt securities and recognized in earnings was $1.1 million. In addition, we recognized impairment of $392,000 on a $1.0 million community development-related equity investment.
 
 
32

 
 
Results of Operations—for the two years ended December 31, 2011
 
Net interest income
 
Our earnings are derived predominantly from net interest income, which is the difference between interest and fees earned on loans, securities and federal funds sold (these asset classes are commonly referred to as interest-earning assets) and the interest paid on deposits, borrowings and debentures (these liability classes are commonly referred to as interest-bearing funds). The net interest margin is net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets.
 
Our net interest income for 2011 was $59.5 million, up 33 percent from $44.7 million last year. The increase in our net interest income principally reflects the increase in interest-earning assets from the SLTB acquisition combined with a lower cost of interest-bearing liabilities.
 
Our net interest margin (on a taxable equivalent basis) was 3.92 percent for 2011 compared with 3.46 percent for 2010. The increase in our net interest margin was primarily due to a 39 basis point reduction in the cost of our interest-bearing liabilities. The rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities for 2011 was 1.16 percent compared with 1.55 percent for 2010. The improvement in the yield on interest-earning assets also contributed to the increase in the net interest margin. The yield on interest-earning assets for 2011 increased 20 basis points to 4.79 percent from 4.59 percent for 2010.
 
The following table presents the average balances, the amount of interest earned or incurred and the applicable taxable equivalent yields for interest-earning assets and the costs of interest-bearing liabilities that generate net interest income:
 
Average Balance Sheet and Analysis of Net Interest Income
 
   
Year Ended
 
Year Ended
   
December 31, 2011
 
December 31, 2010
   
Average
Amount
   
Interest
Income/
Expense
   
Weighted
Average
Yield/
Rate
 
Average
Amount
   
Interest
Income/
Expense
   
Weighted
Average
Yield/
Rate
                                     
Loans (1)
  $ 1,065,350     $ 65,945     6.19 %   $ 931,271     $ 53,240     5.72 %
Securities
    325,850       6,303     1.97 %     300,162       5,914     2.00 %
Federal funds sold and deposits with banks
    127,470       350     0.27 %     63,042       196     0.31 %
                                             
Total earning assets
    1,518,670       72,598     4.79 %     1,294,475       59,350     4.59 %
                                             
Non-earning assets
    267,839                     165,642                
                                             
Total average assets
  $ 1,786,509                   $ 1,460,117                
                                             
Interest-bearing checking
  $ 99,900       340     0.34 %   $ 81,016       277     0.34 %
Savings and money market
    469,468       3,922     0.84 %     367,371       3,611     0.98 %
Certificates of deposit
    401,859       3,750     0.93 %     334,914       4,085     1.22 %
                                             
Total interest-bearing deposits
    971,227       8,012     0.82 %     783,301       7,973     1.02 %
                                             
Borrowings
    128,947       3,750     2.91 %     133,995       4,945     3.69 %
Junior subordinated debentures
    26,805       1,342     5.01 %     26,779       1,736     6.48 %
                                             
Total borrowed funds
    155,752       5,092     3.26 %     160,774       6,681     4.14 %
                                             
Total interest-bearing liabilities
    1,126,979       13,104     1.16 %     944,075       14,654     1.55 %
                                             
Noninterest checking
    422,933                     317,533                
Other liabilities
    22,807                     9,543                
Shareholders’ equity
    213,790                     188,966                
                                             
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
  $ 1,786,509                   $ 1,460,117                
                                             
Net interest income
          $ 59,494                   $ 44,696        
                                             
Net interest margin (tax 
equivalent) (2)
                  3.92 %                   3.46 %
 

(1)
Yields and amounts earned on loans include loan fees and discount/premium accretion of $2.9 million and ($0.5) million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. The average loan balance includes nonaccrual loans; however, there is no interest income related to nonaccrual loans in the amount earned on loans.
(2)
Includes tax equivalent adjustments related to tax-exempt income on securities.
 
 
33

 
 
Our net interest income changes with the level and mix of average interest-earning assets and average interest-bearing funds. We call the changes between periods in interest-earning assets and interest-bearing funds balance changes. We measure the effect on our net interest income from balance changes by multiplying the change in the average balance between the current period and the prior period by the prior period average rate.
 
Our net interest income also changes with the average rate earned or paid on interest-earning assets and interest-bearing funds. We call the changes between periods in average rates earned and paid rate changes. We measure the effect on our net interest income from rate changes by multiplying the change in average rates earned or paid between the current period and the prior period by the prior period average balance.
 
We allocate the change in our net interest income attributable to both balance and rate on a pro rata basis to the change in average balance and the change in average rate. The following table presents the changes in our interest income and interest expense:
 
Increase (Decrease) in Net Interest Income/Expense Due to Change in Average Volume and Average Rate (1)
 
   
2011 vs. 2010
 
   
Increase
    Net  
   
(Decrease) due to:
    Increase  
   
Volume
   
Rate
   
(Decrease)
 
Interest Income:
                 
Interest on loans (2)
  $ 7,665     $ 5,040     $ 12,705  
Interest on securities
    513       (124 )     389  
Interest on Federal funds sold and deposits with banks
    200       (46 )     154  
                         
Total interest income
    8,378       4,870       13,248  
                         
Interest Expense:
                       
Interest on deposits
    1,913       (1,874 )     39  
Interest on borrowings
    (186 )     (1,009 )     (1,195 )
Interest on junior subordinated debentures
    2       (396 )     (394 )
                         
Total interest expense
    1,729       (3,279 )     (1,550 )
                         
Net interest income
  $ 6,649     $ 8,149     $ 14,798  
 

(1)
The change in interest income or interest expense that is attributable to both changes in average balance and average rate has been allocated to the changes due to (i) average balance and (ii) average rate in proportion to the relationship of the absolute amounts of changes in each.
(2)
Table does not include interest income that would have been earned on nonaccrual loans.
 
Provision for loan losses
 
The provision for loan losses was $5.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared with $8.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. The decrease in the provision for loan losses in 2011 compared to 2010 reflects a decline in non-covered loan balances. We revised downward in the fourth quarter of 2011 our estimated loss factors for the qualitative considerations used in the determination of the adequacy of our allowance for loan losses. We revised upward in the first three quarters of 2011 and revised downward in the final quarter of 2011, our estimated loss factors for the quantitative considerations used in the determination of the adequacy of our allowance for loan losses. The change in our estimated loss factors for the 2011 period was less than the change for the 2010 period; however, the changes resulted in a higher ratio of the allowance for loan losses to non-covered loans. At December 31, 2011, the ratio of the allowance for loan losses to non-covered loans was 1.90 percent compared with 1.80 percent at December 31, 2010.
 
 
34

 
 
Noninterest income
 
Noninterest income was $44.6 million for 2011 compared with $8.8 million for 2010. The increase is primarily due to gain on acquisitions.
 
Service charges on deposit accounts were $3.4 million for 2011, up 7 percent from $3.2 million for 2010. The increase reflects the related growth in our deposit balances from $1.2 billion at December 31, 2010 to $1.4 billion at December 31, 2011.
 
In 2011, we did not sell any loans. During 2010 we sold one loan for a gain of $8,000. We did not receive commissions on brokered commercial and multifamily mortgages in 2011 compared with $47,000 in 2010.
 
For all of 2011 we sold $39.0 million of securities and net gains from the sales of these securities were $1.0 million. For all of 2010 we sold $236.0 million of securities and net gains from the sales of these securities were $2.0 million.
 
In 2011, we recognized other-than-temporary impairment losses on private-label collateralized mortgage obligations of $1.4 million. In 2010, we recognized other-than-temporary impairment losses on private-label collateralized mortgage obligations of $0.7 million. In addition, we recognized an impairment loss of $41,000 on a $1.0 million community development-related equity investment. We will continue to evaluate our securities portfolio for other-than-temporary impairment at each reporting date and we can provide no assurance there will not be impairment losses in future periods.
 
In the 2011 fourth quarter we completed the foreclosures on a $1.4 million office building and a $0.9 million multifamily property. We obtained current appraisals and determined the fair values of these properties were $0.4 million higher than the loan balances. Accordingly, we recognized a $0.4 million market gain on foreclosed assets in the 2011 fourth quarter. In the 2010 second quarter we completed the foreclosure on a $21.0 million completed office construction project. This project consisted of 20 completed units ranging from approximately 1,650 square feet to 14,600 square feet in size. We obtained a current appraisal, evaluated the estimated retail sales prices as well as the estimated costs to sell and determined the fair value of this project to be $21.7 million. Accordingly, in the 2010 second quarter, we recognized a market value gain on foreclosed assets of $0.7 million.
 
On February 18, 2011, the Bank assumed all of the deposits and substantially all of the assets of San Luis Trust Bank, located in San Luis Obispo, California, from the FDIC. We recognized a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $36.5 million in connection with this transaction. On April 8, 2011, the Bank acquired the Electronic Banking Solutions division of Palm Desert National Bank. We recognized a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $0.5 million in connection with this transaction. On November 5, 2010, the Bank assumed all of the deposits and substantially all of the assets of Western Commercial Bank, located in Woodland Hills, California, from the FDIC. We recognized a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $2.3 million in connection with this transaction.
 
Other income was $3.7 million for 2011, up 363 percent from $0.8 million in 2010. The significant increase was due to the acquisition of the EPS division in April 2011 that generates fee income from the issuance of prepaid cards and sponsoring merchant acquiring services for all national and regional credit card networks.
 
The following table presents a summary of noninterest income:
 
   
For the years ended
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
  $ 3,447     $ 3,225  
Earnings on cash surrender value of life insurance
    438       441  
Loan sales and commissions
          55  
Net gain on sale of securities
    1,022       2,014  
Impairment losses on securities
    (1,387 )     (749 )
Market gain on foreclosed assets
    429       691  
Gain on acquisition
    36,922       2,312  
Other income
    3,738       807  
                 
Total noninterest income
  $ 44,609     $ 8,796  
 
Noninterest expense
 
Our noninterest expense for 2011 was $58.5 million, up 37 percent from $42.8 million for 2010. The increase in noninterest expense was largely in salaries and benefits expense, professional expense and loss on and expense of foreclosed properties. Salaries and benefits expense reflects the workforce increases from the acquisitions of Western Commercial Bank in November 2010, San Luis Trust Bank in February 2011 and the EPS division in April 2011. Full-time equivalent employees were 304 at December 31, 2011 as compared with 248 at December 31, 2010. Professional expense increased to $5.6 million in 2011 from $2.0 million in 2010. The increase was due to litigation expense related to ongoing legal cases and a high level of legal loan collection expense. Loss on and expense of foreclosed properties increased to $5.2 million in 2011 from $3.0 million in 2010. The increase was mainly due to valuation allowances recorded on our two largest foreclosed properties.
 
 
35

 
 
The following table presents a summary of noninterest expense:
 
   
For the years ended
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Salaries and employee benefits
  $ 26,510     $ 19,014  
Premises and equipment
    6,298       6,268  
Data processing
    3,500       2,564  
Legal, audit, and other professional services
    5,570       2,033  
Printing, stationary, and supplies
    366       258  
Telephone
    800       841  
Directors’ fees
    460       428  
Advertising and marketing
    1,637       918  
Postage
    222       212  
Insurance and regulatory assessments
    2,199       2,944  
Loss on and expense of foreclosed property, net
    5,178       2,954  
Amortization of intangible assets
    2,289       1,666  
Other expenses
    3,435       2,705  
                 
Total noninterest expense
  $ 58,464     $ 42,805  
 
Our efficiency ratio was 75 percent for both 2011 and 2010. The efficiency ratio is the percentage relationship of noninterest expense, excluding amortization of intangibles, loss on and expense of foreclosed property and integration/conversion expenses related to acquisitions, to the sum of net interest income and noninterest income, excluding gains or losses on security sales, other-than-temporary impairment losses and gain on acquisitions.
 
Income taxes
 
The income tax provision was $16.9 million for 2011 compared with $0.9 million for 2010. The effective tax rate was 42.0 percent for 2011 compared with 40.0 percent for 2010.
 
The combined federal and state statutory rate for 2011 and 2010 was 42.05 percent. The effective tax rates for 2011 and 2010 approximated the combined federal and state statutory tax rate because the additions to and exclusions from taxable income were not material.
 
Results of Operations—for the two years ended December 31, 2010
 
Net interest income
 
Our earnings are derived predominantly from net interest income, which is the difference between interest and fees earned on loans, securities and federal funds sold (these asset classes are commonly referred to as interest-earning assets) and the interest paid on deposits, borrowings and debentures (these liability classes are commonly referred to as interest-bearing funds). The net interest margin is net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets.
 
Our net interest income for 2010 was $44.7 million, down 1 percent from $45.1 million last year. The decrease in our net interest income principally reflects the decline in interest income derived from securities.
 
Our net interest margin (on a taxable equivalent basis) was 3.46% for 2010 compared with 3.53% for 2009. The decrease in our net interest margin was primarily due to lower yields on our securities and reflects the shift in the composition of our securities to lower yielding, shorter-term securities. The yield on interest-earning assets for 2010 was 4.59 percent, down 49 basis points from 5.08 percent for 2009. The reduction in the cost of our interest-bearing liabilities, which equaled 1.55 percent for 2010, down 47 basis points from 2.02 percent for 2009, partially offset the effects of lower yields on interest-earning assets.
 
The following table presents the average balances, the amount of interest earned or incurred and the applicable taxable equivalent yields for interest-earning assets and the costs of interest-bearing liabilities that generate net interest income:
 
 
36

 
 
Average Balance Sheet and Analysis of Net Interest Income
 
   
Year Ended
 
Year Ended
   
December 31, 2010
 
December 31, 2009
   
Average
Amount
   
Interest
Income/
Expense
   
Weighted
Average
Yield/
Rate
 
Average
Amount
   
Interest
Income/
Expense
   
Weighted
Average
Yield/
Rate
                                     
Loans (1)
  $ 931,271     $ 53,240     5.72 %   $ 920,272     $ 52,439     5.70 %
Securities
    300,162       5,914     2.00 %     281,960       12,086     4.52 %
Federal funds sold and deposits with banks
    63,042       196     0.31 %     86,415       416     0.48 %
                                             
Total earning assets
    1,294,475       59,350     4.59 %     1,288,647       64,941     5.08 %
                                             
Non-earning assets
    165,642                     154,231                
                                             
Total average assets
  $ 1,460,117                   $ 1,442,878                
                                             
Interest-bearing checking
  $ 81,016       277     0.34 %   $ 78,581       235     0.30 %
Savings and money market
    367,371       3,611     0.98 %     276,097       3,007     1.10 %
Certificates of deposit
    334,914       4,085     1.22 %     445,293       8,889     2.00 %
                                             
Total interest-bearing deposits
    783,301       7,973     1.02 %     799,971       12,131     1.52 %
                                             
Borrowings
    133,995       4,945     3.69 %     155,252       5,924     3.82 %
Junior subordinated debentures
    26,779       1,736     6.48 %     26,727       1,832     6.85 %
                                             
Total borrowed funds
    160,774       6,681     4.14 %     181,979       7,756     4.25 %
                                             
Total interest-bearing liabilities
    944,075       14,654     1.55 %     981,950       19,887     2.02 %
                                             
Noninterest checking
    317,533                     288,893                
Other liabilities
    9,543                     11,711                
Shareholders’ equity
    188,966                     160,324                
                                             
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
  $ 1,460,117                   $ 1,442,878                
                                             
Net interest income
          $ 44,696                   $ 45,054        
                                             
Net interest margin (tax equivalent) (2)
                  3.46 %                   3.53 %
 

(1)
Yields and amounts earned on loans include loan fees of ($0.5) million and ($0.1) million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The average loan balance includes loans held-for-sale and nonaccrual loans; however, there is no interest income related to nonaccrual loans in the amount earned on loans.
(2)
Includes tax equivalent adjustments related to tax-exempt income on securities.
 
Our net interest income changes with the level and mix of average interest-earning assets and average interest-bearing funds. We call the changes between periods in interest-earning assets and interest-bearing funds balance changes. We measure the effect on our net interest income from balance changes by multiplying the change in the average balance between the current period and the prior period by the prior period average rate.
 
Our net interest income also changes with the average rate earned or paid on interest-earning assets and interest-bearing funds. We call the changes between periods in average rates earned and paid rate changes. We measure the effect on our net interest income from rate changes by multiplying the change in average rates earned or paid between the current period and the prior period by the prior period average balance.
 
 
 
37

 
 
We allocate the change in our net interest income attributable to both balance and rate on a pro rata basis to the change in average balance and the change in average rate. The following table presents the changes in our interest income and interest expense:
 
Increase (Decrease) in Net Interest Income/Expense Due to Change in Average Volume and Average Rate (1)
 
   
2010 vs 2009
 
   
Increase
    Net  
   
(Decrease) due to:
    Increase  
   
Volume
   
Rate
   
(Decrease)
 
Interest Income:
                 
Interest on loans (2)
  $ 627     $ 174     $ 801  
Interest on securities
    780       (6,952 )     (6,172 )
Interest on Federal funds sold and deposits with banks
    (112 )     (108 )     (220 )
                         
Total interest income
    1,295       (6,886 )     (5,591 )
                         
Interest Expense:
                       
Interest on deposits
    (253 )     (3,905 )     (4,158 )
Interest on borrowings
    (811 )     (168 )     (979 )
Interest on junior subordinated debentures
    4       (100 )     (96 )
                         
Total interest expense
    (1,060 )     (4,173 )     (5,233 )
                         
Net interest income
  $ 2,355     $ (2,713 )   $ (358 )
 

(1)
The change in interest income or interest expense that is attributable to both changes in average balance and average rate has been allocated to the changes due to (i) average balance and (ii) average rate in proportion to the relationship of the absolute amounts of changes in each.
(2)
Table does not include interest income that would have been earned on nonaccrual loans.
 
Provision for loan losses
 
The provision for loan losses was $8.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 compared with $16.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2009. The decrease in the provision for loan losses in 2010 compared to 2009 was the result of lower nonaccrual loans, past due loans and classified loans in 2010 as compared to 2009. We revised upward in the second quarter and fourth quarter of 2010 and in the first quarter of 2009, our estimated loss factors for the qualitative considerations used in the determination of the adequacy of our allowance for loan losses. The change in our estimated loss factors for the 2010 periods was less than the change for the 2009 period; however, the changes resulted in a higher ratio of the allowance for loan losses to non-covered loans. At December 31, 2010, the ratio of the allowance for loan losses to non-covered loans was 1.80 percent compared with 1.76 percent at December 31, 2009.
 
Noninterest income
 
Noninterest income was $8.8 million for 2010 compared with $10.0 million for 2009.
 
Service charges on deposit accounts were $3.2 million for 2010, down 8 percent from $3.5 million for 2009. The decrease reflects a lower incidence of customers drawing checks against their deposit account when insufficient funds are on deposit.
 
During 2010 we sold one loan for a gain of $8,000. In 2009, we did not sell any loans. Commissions received on brokered commercial and multifamily mortgages were $47,000 in 2010 compared with $70,000 in 2009.
 
For all of 2010, we sold $236.0 million of securities and net gains from the sale of these securities were $2.0 million. For all of 2009 we sold $244.1 million of securities and net gains from the sales of these securities were $6.5 million.
 
In 2010, we recognized other-than-temporary impairment losses on private-label collateralized mortgage obligations of $0.7 million. In addition, we recognized an impairment loss of $41,000 on a $1.0 million community development-related equity investment. In 2009, we recognized other-than-temporary impairment losses on private-label collateralized mortgage obligations of $1.1 million. In addition, we recognized an impairment loss of $392,000 on a $1.0 million community development-related equity investment. We will continue to evaluate our securities portfolio for other-than-temporary impairment at each reporting date and we can provide no assurance there will not be impairment losses in future periods.
 
 
38

 
 
In the 2010 second quarter we completed the foreclosure on a $21.0 million completed office construction project. This project consisted of 20 completed units ranging from approximately 1,650 square feet to 14,600 square feet in size. We obtained a current appraisal, evaluated the estimated retail sales prices as well as the estimated costs to sell and determined the fair value of this project to be $21.7 million. Accordingly, in the 2010 second quarter, we recognized a market value gain of $0.7 million. Subsequent to foreclosure, we sold one unit of approximately 4,100 square feet resulting in net proceeds of approximately $1.0 million. In the 2010 fourth quarter, a $2.1 million valuation reserve was established on this property as the time to sell the units will more likely than not be longer than that estimated in the June 2010 appraisal.
 
On November 5, 2010, the Bank assumed all of the deposits and substantially all of the assets of Western Commercial Bank, located in Woodland Hills, California, from the FDIC. The Bank recorded a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $2.3 million in connection with this transaction.
 
The following table presents a summary of noninterest income:
 
   
For the years ended
December 31,
 
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
  $ 3,225     $ 3,516  
Earnings on cash surrender value of life insurance
    441       437  
Loan sales and commissions
    55       70  
Net gain on sale of securities
    2,014       6,469  
Impairment losses on securities
    (749 )     (1,507 )
Market gain on foreclosed assets
    691        
Gain on acquisition
    2,312        
Other income
    807       1,049  
                 
Total noninterest income
  $ 8,796     $ 10,034  
 
Noninterest expense
 
Our noninterest expense for 2010 was $42.8 million down 9 percent from $46.9 million for 2009. The decrease in noninterest expense reflects the workforce reductions effected in the 2009 and 2010 third quarters. Noninterest expense for 2010 included integration and conversion expenses related to the FDIC-assisted Western Commercial Bank transaction of approximately $430,000. Noninterest expense for 2009 included integration and conversion expenses related to the FDIC-assisted 1st Centennial Bank transaction of approximately $774,000.
 
The following table presents a summary of noninterest expense:
 
   
For the years ended
December 31,
 
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Salaries and employee benefits
  $ 19,014     $ 20,867  
Premises and equipment
    6,268       6,538  
Data processing
    2,564       2,403  
Legal, audit, and other professional services
    2,033       2,719  
Printing, stationary, and supplies
    258       757  
Telephone
    841       986  
Directors’ fees
    428       521  
Advertising and marketing
    918       1,380  
Postage
    212       245  
Insurance and regulatory assessments
    2,944       3,376  
Loss on and expense of foreclosed property
    2,954       1,563  
Market value loss on loans held-for-sale
          709  
Amortization of intangible assets
    1,666       1,626  
Other expenses
    2,705       3,166  
                 
Total noninterest expense
  $ 42,805     $ 46,856  
 
 
39

 
 
Salaries and benefits fell 9 percent to $19.0 million for 2010 from $20.9 million for 2009. The decline reflects the 2009 and 2010 third quarter workforce reductions of approximately 10 percent. In addition, stock-based compensation expense decreased by approximately $0.5 million in 2010 compared to 2009.
 
The FDIC charged all institutions a special insurance assessment in 2009. Our special assessment was $668,000. The insurance and regulatory assessments expense shown above for 2009 includes the FDIC special assessment. The FDIC also implemented a rule requiring insured depository institutions to prepay their quarterly risk-based assessments for the fourth quarter of 2009, and all of 2010, 2011, and 2012 on December 30, 2009. Our prepaid assessment was $9.4 million. Our regular FDIC insurance expense was $2.2 million for both 2010 and 2009. We do not anticipate any further special assessments or prepaid assessments; however, we cannot assure you that the FDIC will not increase assessment rates in future periods.
 
We determined in the second quarter of 2009 not to pursue the sale of $31.2 million of loans previously classified as held-for-sale and returned these performing, multifamily mortgage loans to our regular portfolio. We recognized a market loss of $709,000 in noninterest expense to reduce our carrying value to the lower of cost or market value.
 
The cost of foreclosed real estate and the loss on sale of foreclosed real estate was $3.0 million for 2010 compared with $1.6 million for 2009. The increase was primarily due to the recognition of a $2.1 million loss in the fourth quarter of 2010 to reduce the carrying value of a $21.0 million office complex to its estimated fair value less estimated costs of disposal. It was determined that the time to sell the units would likely be longer than the estimated timeframe in the most current appraisal, thus, resulting in a further discounting of the expected cash flows. In the fourth quarter of 2009, we recognized a loss of $1.1 million to reduce the carrying value of one property to its then-appraised fair value less estimated costs of disposal.
 
Our efficiency ratio was 80 percent for 2010 compared with 91 percent for 2009. The efficiency ratio is the percentage relationship of noninterest expense, excluding amortization of intangibles, to the sum of net interest income and noninterest income, excluding gains or losses on security sales. The improvement in our efficiency ratio in 2010 reflects the decline in noninterest expense coupled with the benefit of the $2.3 million gain on the Western Commercial Bank transaction.
 
Income taxes
 
The income tax provision was $0.9 million for 2010 compared with a tax benefit of $3.8 million for 2009. The effective tax rate was 40.0 percent for 2010 compared with 44.6 percent for 2009.
 
The combined federal and state statutory rate for 2010 and 2009 was 42.05 percent. The effective tax rates for 2010 and 2009 approximated the combined federal and state statutory tax rate because the additions to and exclusions from taxable income were not material.
 
Financial Position
 
Lending and credit risk
 
We provide a variety of loan and credit-related products and services to meet the needs of borrowers primarily located in the six Southern California counties where our branches are located. Business loans, represented by commercial real estate loans, commercial loans and construction loans comprise the largest portion of the loan portfolio. Consumer or personal loans, represented by home mortgage, home equity and installment loans, comprise a smaller portion of the loan portfolio.
 
Credit risk is the risk to earnings or capital arising from an obligor’s failure to meet the terms of any contract with us or otherwise to perform as agreed. All activities in which success depends on counterparty, issuer, or borrower performance have credit risk. Credit risk is present any time we extend, commit or invest funds; whenever we enter into actual or implied contractual agreements for funds, whether on or off the balance sheet, credit risk is present.
 
All categories of loans present credit risk. Major risk factors applicable to all loan categories include changes in international, national and local economic conditions such as interest rates, inflation, unemployment levels, consumer and business confidence and the supply and demand for goods and services, among other factors.
 
Commercial real estate loans rely upon the cash flow originating from the underlying real property. Commercial real estate is a cyclical industry; general economic conditions and local supply and demand affect the commercial real estate industry. In the office sector, the demand for office space is highly dependent on employment levels. Consumer spending and confidence affect the demand for retail space and the levels of retail rents in the retail sector. The industrial sector has exposure to the level of exports, defense spending and inventory levels. Vacancy rates, location and other factors affect the amount of rental income for commercial property. Tenants may relocate, fail to honor their lease or go out of business. In the multifamily residential sector, the affordability of ownership housing, employment conditions and the vacancy of existing inventory heavily influences the demand for apartments. Population growth or decline and changing demographics, such as increases in the level of immigrants or retirees, are also factors influencing the multifamily residential sector.
 
 
40

 
 
Construction loans provide developers or owners with funds to build or improve properties; developers ultimately sell or lease these properties. Generally, construction loans involve a higher degree of risk than other loan categories because they rely upon the developer’s or owner’s ability to complete the project within specified cost and time limits. Cost overruns can cause the project cost to exceed the project sales price or exceed the amount of the committed permanent funding. Any number of reasons, such as poor weather, material or labor shortages, labor difficulties, or redoing substandard work to pass inspection, can delay construction projects. Furthermore, changes in market conditions or credit markets may affect a project’s viability once completed.
 
Commercial loans rely upon the cash flow originating from the underlying business activity of the enterprise. The manufacture, distribution or sale of goods or sale of services are not only affected by general economic conditions but also by the ability of the enterprise’s management to adjust to local supply and demand conditions, maintain good labor, vendor and customer relationships, as well as market, price and sell their goods or services for a profit. Customer demand for goods and services of the enterprise may change because of competition or obsolescence.
 
Home mortgages and home equity loans and lines of credit use first or second trust deeds on a borrower’s real estate property, typically their principal residence, as collateral. These loans depend on a person’s ability to regularly pay the principal and interest due on the loan and, secondarily, on the value of real estate property that serves as collateral for the loan. Generally, home mortgages involve a lower degree of risk than other loan categories because of the relationship of the loan amount to the value of the residential real estate and a person’s reluctance to forego their principal place of residence. General economic conditions and local supply and demand, however, affect home real estate values. Installment loans and credit card lines also depend on a person’s ability to pay principal and interest on a loan in a regular manner; however, generally these are unsecured loans or, if secured, the collateral value can rapidly decline, as is the case for automobiles. A person’s ability to service debt is highly dependent upon their continued employment or financial stability. Job loss, divorce, illness and bankruptcy are just a few of the risks that may affect a person’s ability to service their debt.
 
We obtain appraisals when extending credit for real estate secured loans as follows:
 
 
1.
All business loans in excess of $1,000,000 where real estate will be taken as collateral but where the sale or rental of the real estate is not the primary source of repayment;
     
 
2.
All business loans in excess of $250,000 where real estate will be taken as collateral and where the sale or rental of the real estate is the primary source of repayment; and
     
 
3.
All other real estate secured loans in excess of $250,000.
 
All real estate secured loans, at the time of origination, renewal or extension, require a current appraisal. A current appraisal is an appraisal with an “as of’ date not more than six months before the date of funding or renewal or extension. We also obtain updated appraisals when the useful life of the appraisal ceases. Under the Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice guidelines, the useful life of an appraisal, regardless of the dollar amount, is the life of the loan. However, useful life ends when (a) there has been a deterioration in the borrower’s performance and there is an increasing likelihood of a forced liquidation of the property and the existing appraisal is older than two years old, or (b) there has been deterioration in the property’s value due to a significant depreciation in local real estate values, lack of maintenance, changes in zoning, environmental contamination or other circumstances.
 
Since the risks in each category of loan changes based on a number of factors, it is not possible to state whether a particular type of lending carries with it a greater or lesser degree of risk at any specific time in the economic cycle. Generally, in a stabilized economic environment, home mortgage loans have the least risk, followed by home equity loans, multifamily property loans, commercial property loans, commercial loans and lines and finally construction loans. However, this ordering may vary from time to time and the degree of risk from the credits with the least risk to those with the highest risk profile may expand or contract with the general economy.
 
We manage credit risk through Board approved policies and procedures. At least annually, the Board reviews and approves these policies. Lending policies provide us with a framework for consistent loan underwriting and a basis for sound credit decisions. Lending policies specify, among other things, the parameters for the type or purpose of the loan, the required debt service coverage and the required collateral requirements. Credit limits are also established. Management's Loan Committee meets regularly to approve certain loans, monitor delinquencies and reports quarterly to the Directors' Credit Review Committee on compliance with policies. The Directors’ Credit Review Committee also engages a third party to perform a credit review of the loan portfolio to ensure compliance with policies and assist in the evaluation of the credit risk inherent in the loan portfolio.
 
Non-covered Loans
 
Non-covered loans decreased 1 percent to $936.1 million at December 31, 2011 from $947.7 million at December 31, 2010. The decline in commercial loans and lines of credit in 2011 includes the $3.8 million payoff of four motion picture and video production shared national credit loans. The decline in the remainder of non-covered loans in 2011 was due to payoffs and paydowns outpacing new originations for the period.
 
 
41

 
 
The following table presents our portfolio of non-covered loans:
 
   
For the years ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Commercial mortgage
  $ 393,376     $ 399,634     $ 381,334     $ 302,016     $ 295,496  
Commercial loans and lines of credit
    180,421       213,576       235,849       228,958       189,638  
Multifamily mortgage
    187,333       135,639       138,548       51,607       34,198  
Home mortgage
    106,350       108,076       51,036       45,202       46,193  
Construction and land development
    35,082       55,260       86,609       133,054       148,101  
Home equity loans and lines of credit
    28,645       29,828       40,122       22,568       22,519  
Installment & credit card
    4,896       5,724       5,748       5,016       10,034  
                                         
Total non-covered loans
    936,103       947,737       939,246       788,421       746,179  
Allowance for loan losses
    (17,747 )     (17,033 )     (16,505 )     (8,048 )     (7,828 )
                                         
Non-covered loans, net
  $ 918,356     $ 930,704     $ 922,741     $ 780,373     $ 738,351  
                                         
Loans held-for-sale
  $     $     $     $ 31,401     $ 11,454  
 
The loan categories above are derived from bank regulatory reporting standards for loans secured by real estate; however, a portion of the commercial and home mortgage loans above are loans that we consider to be commercial loans for which we have taken real estate collateral as additional support or from an abundance of caution. In these instances, we are not looking to the real property as its primary source of repayment, but rather as a secondary or tertiary source of repayment.
 
Commercial mortgage loans, the largest segment of our portfolio, were 42 percent of non-covered loans at December 31, 2011, and 2010. We had approximately 371 commercial mortgage loans with an average balance of $1,062,000. Many different commercial property types collateralize our commercial mortgage loans. Our top three categories have been industrial, office, and retail. In addition, most of our commercial property lending is in the seven Southern California counties where our branches are located. The following is a table of our non-covered commercial mortgage lending by county.
 
Non-covered commercial mortgage loans by county
 
At
December 31,
2011
   
At
December 31,
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Southern California
           
Los Angeles
  $ 182,282     $ 199,102  
Orange
    27,151       29,788  
Ventura
    122,921       109,684  
Riverside
    22,041       19,835  
San Bernardino
    15,538       16,233  
San Diego
    14,170       15,859  
Santa Barbara
    225       230  
                 
Total Southern California
    384,328       390,731  
                 
Northern California
               
Alameda
    343       344  
Alpine
    569        
Contra Costa
    354       383  
Fresno
    2,404       2,443  
Imperial
    335       352  
Kern
    672       920  
Madera
    521       536  
Placer
    603       613  
Sacramento
    333       348  
San Mateo
    2,363       2,401  
Solano
    265       272  
Tulare
    286       291  
                 
Total Northern California
    9,048       8,903  
                 
Total non-coverd commercial mortgage loans
  $ 393,376     $ 399,634  
 
 
42

 
 
The following table shows the distribution of our non-covered commercial mortgage loans by property type at December 31, 2011 and 2010.
 
Non-covered commercial mortgage loans by property type
 
At
December 31,
2011
   
At
December 31,
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Industrial/warehouse
  $ 113,480     $ 108,860  
Office
    87,136       98,277  
Retail
    64,646       65,917  
Hotel
    23,746       24,429  
Self storage
    19,752       19,409  
Medical
    14,043       10,388  
Mixed use
    12,343       14,528  
Restaurant
    7,771       9,419  
Assisted living
    5,649       5,768  
All other
    44,810       42,639  
                 
Total non-covered commercial mortgage loans
  $ 393,376     $ 399,634  
 
The following table shows the maturity of our non-covered commercial mortgage loans by origination year.
 
Non-covered commercial mortgage loans by origination year/maturity year
                   
                                     
(in thousands)
                                   
   
Year of maturity
       
Origination
                         
2016 and
       
Year
 
2012
   
2013
   
2014
   
2015
   
Thereafter
   
Total
 
                                     
2005 and earlier
  $ 1,964     $ 1,707     $ 12,363     $ 5,726     $ 74,350     $ 96,110  
                                                 
2006
    152       6,235             110       36,437       42,934  
                                                 
2007
    13,002       734       7,488             30,946       52,170  
                                                 
2008
    13,021       1,905       229       126       45,130       60,411  
                                                 
2009
    1,530             6,018       102       51,286       58,936  
                                                 
2010
    104       379             2,918       28,045       31,446  
                                                 
2011
    52                         51,317       51,369  
                                                 
Total
  $ 29,825     $ 10,960     $ 26,098     $ 8,982     $ 317,511     $ 393,376  
 
 
43

 
 
    We generally underwrite commercial mortgage loans with a maximum loan-to-value of 60 percent and a minimum debt-service-coverage ratio of 1.25. The weighted average loan-to-value ratio of our non-covered commercial mortgage portfolio was 58.6 percent and the weighted average debt-service-coverage ratio was 1.70 at December 31, 2011. At December 31, 2010, the weighted-average loan-to-value ratio was 59.4 percent and debt-service-coverage ratio was 1.62 for our non-covered commercial mortgage loan portfolio. We focus on cash flow; consequently, regardless the value of the collateral, the commercial real estate project must provide sufficient cash flow, or alternatively the principals must supplement the project with other cash flow, to service the debt. We generally require the principals to guarantee the loan. We also “stress-test” commercial mortgage loans to determine the potential affect changes in interest rates, vacancy rates, and lease or rent rates would have on the cash flow of the project. Additionally, at least on an annual basis, we require updates on the cash flow of the project and, where practicable, we visit the properties.
 
At December 31, 2011, commercial loans were 19 percent of non-covered loans, down from 23 percent at December 31, 2010. We had approximately 843 commercial loans with an average balance of $213,000. Unused commitments on commercial loans were $110.9 million at December 31, 2011 compared with $134.9 million at December 31, 2010. Working capital, equipment purchases or business expansion are the typical purposes for commercial loans. Commercial loans may be unsecured or secured by assets such as equipment, inventory, accounts receivables, and real property. Personal guarantees of the business owner may also be present. These loans may also have partial guarantees from the U.S. Small Business Administration, or SBA, or other federal or state agencies. Broadly diversified business sectors with the largest sectors in real estate/construction, finance and insurance, information, manufacturing and trade comprise the commercial loan portfolio. We also participate in larger credit facilities known as shared national credits. At December 31, 2011, five loans under these facilities had outstanding balances of $19.2 million. These loans consist of four motion picture and video production loan participations and a $0.9 million healthcare facility loan participation. At December 31, 2011, we also have a commitment of $10.0 million for one other motion picture and video production facility with no outstanding balances. Below is a table of our non-covered loans by business sector.
 
Non-covered commercial loans by industry/sector
 
At
December 31,
2011
   
At
December 31,
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Real estate
  $ 47,439     $ 54,387  
Services
    47,219       53,549  
Information
    30,040       44,193  
Trade
    22,988       22,488  
Manufacturing
    16,196       18,722  
Healthcare
    14,712       16,593  
Transportation and Warehouse
    1,827       3,644  
                 
Total non-covered commercial loans
  $ 180,421     $ 213,576  
 
We generally underwrite commercial loans with maturities not to exceed seven years and we generally require full amortization of the loan within the term of the loan. We generally underwrite working capital lines for a 12 month period and have a 30-day out-of-debt requirement. Accounts receivable and inventory financing revolving lines of credit have an annual maturity date, a maximum advance rate, and an annual field audit for lines of $200,000 or more. Third-party vendors perform field audits for our accounts receivable and inventory financing revolving lines of credit. The maximum advance rate for accounts receivable is 80 percent and the maximum advance rate for eligible inventory is 25 percent.
 
Non-covered construction and land development loans were 4 percent of non-covered loans at December 31, 2011 down from 6 percent at December 31, 2010. At December 31, 2011, we had 31 projects with an average commitment of $1,958,000. Construction loans represent single-family, multi-family and commercial building projects. The decline in construction and land loans since the end of 2009 reflects principally the successful completion and sale of projects as well as the general reduction in new business activity. At December 31, 2011, 18 percent of these loans or $6.3 million represent single-family residential construction projects and 35 percent, or $12.3 million were commercial projects. The remaining 47 percent or $16.5 million were land development projects. Construction loans are typically short term, with maturities ranging from 12 to 18 months. Beginning in the third quarter of 2009, we changed the maximum loan-to-value to 70 percent for both commercial and residential projects from 75 percent for commercial projects and 80 percent for residential projects. The weighted average loan-to-value ratio for our non-covered construction and land portfolio was 69.9 percent at December 31, 2011 and 61.7 percent at December 31, 2010. At the borrower’s expense, we use a third party vendor for funds control, lien releases and inspections. In addition, we regularly monitor the marketplace and the economic trends for evidence of deterioration in real estate values. Below is a table of our non-covered construction and land loans by county.
 
 
44

 
 
   
At December 31, 2011
   
At December 31, 2010
 
Non-covered construction/land loans by county
 
Commitment
   
Outstanding
   
Commitment
   
Outstanding
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Los Angeles
  $ 29,369     $ 11,603     $ 27,168     $ 21,786  
Orange
    5,857       2,909       15,019       14,239  
Ventura
    20,473       15,608       16,194       12,508  
Riverside
    3,772       3,726       3,983       3,906  
Santa Barbara
    1,239       1,236       2,840       2,823  
                                 
Total non-covered construction
  $ 60,710     $ 35,082     $ 65,204     $ 55,260  
 
We are mindful of the economic disruption in our marketplace and supplemented our regular monitoring practices with updated project appraisals, re-evaluation of estimated project marketing time and re-evaluation of the sufficiency of the original loan commitment to absorb interest charges (i.e., interest reserves) when necessary. We also re-evaluate the project sponsor’s ability, where applicable, to successfully complete other projects funded by other institutions. In circumstances where the interest reserve was not sufficient, we request the project sponsor to make payments to us from their general resources or request the project sponsor to place with us the proceeds from a portion of the project sales. While we believe that our monitoring practices are adequate, we cannot assure you that there will not be further delinquencies, lengthened project marketing time or declines in real estate values.
 
Multifamily residential mortgage loans were 20 percent of non-covered loans at December 31, 2011, up from 14 percent at December 31, 2010. We had approximately 184 multifamily loans with an average balance of $1,010,000. Apartments mostly located in our six-county market area serve as collateral for our multifamily loans. We underwrite multifamily mortgage loans in a fashion similar to commercial mortgage loans previously described. The weighted average loan-to-value ratio was 60.3 percent and the weighted average debt-service-coverage ratio was 1.44 for our non-covered multifamily portfolio at December 31, 2011. A year ago, the weighted average loan-to-value ratio was 60.3 percent and the weighted average debt-service-coverage ratio was 1.34 percent. Below is a table of our non-covered multifamily mortgage loans by county.
 
Non-covered multi-family mortgage loans by county
 
At
December 31,
2011
   
At
December 31,
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Southern California
           
Los Angeles
  $ 107,580     $ 92,897  
Orange
    15,638       15,948  
Ventura
    6,942       7,495  
Riverside
    496       502  
San Bernardino
    3,989       3,979  
San Diego
    20,965       4,999  
Santa Barbara
    1,853       1,876  
                 
Total
    157,463       127,696  
                 
Northern California
               
Alameda
    7,247       787  
Calaveras
    1,337       1,357  
Contra Costa
    613        
Fresno
    239       245  
Kern
    2,538       2,609  
Merced
    650       664  
Monterey
    373       379  
Mono
    224       228  
San Francisco
    4,228       1,329  
Santa Clara
    12,085        
Santa Cruz
    336       345  
                 
Total
    29,870       7,943  
                 
Total non-covered multifamily mortgage loans
  $ 187,333     $ 135,639  
 
 
45

 
 
The following table shows the maturity of our non-covered multifamily mortgage loans by origination year.
 
Non-covered multifamily mortgage loans by origination year/maturity year
             
                                     
(in thousands)
                                   
   
Year of maturity
       
Origination
                         
2016 and
       
Year
 
2012
   
2013
   
2014
   
2015
   
Thereafter
   
Total
 
                                     
2005 and earlier
  $ 880     $ 1,088     $     $     $ 11,702     $ 13,670  
                                                 
2006
                            1,337       1,337  
                                                 
2007
                            9,574       9,574  
                                                 
2008
                            41,321       41,321  
                                                 
2009
    237                         40,890       41,127  
                                                 
2010
                            9,711       9,711  
                                                 
2011
                            70,593       70,593  
                                                 
Total
  $ 1,117     $ 1,088     $     $     $ 185,128     $ 187,333  
 
The table below illustrates the distribution of our non-covered loan portfolio by loan size at December 31, 2011. We distribute all non-covered loans by loan balance outstanding except construction and land loans, which we distribute by loan commitment. At year-end 2011, 34 percent of our loans were less than $1 million; 79 percent of our loans were less than $5 million. We believe the high number of smaller-balance loans aids in the mitigation of credit risk; however, a prolonged and deep recession can affect a greater number of borrowers.
 
   
December 31, 2011
 
   
Less
than
$500,000
    $500,000
to
$999,999
    $1,000,000
to
$2,999,999
    $3,000,000
to
$4,999,999
    $5,000,000
to
$9,999,999
    $10,000,000
to
$12,600,000
 
Commercial mortgage
    10 %     14 %     32 %     14 %     19 %     11 %
Commercial loans and lines of credit
    29 %     12 %     32 %     13 %     14 %     0 %
Construction and land development
    3 %     7 %     45 %     15 %     30 %     0 %
Multifamily mortgage
    11 %     23 %     45 %     8 %     7 %     6 %
Home mortgage
    39 %     23 %     21 %     3 %     14 %     0 %
Home equity loans and lines of credit
    44 %     13 %     12 %     31 %     0 %     0 %
Installment & credit card
    87 %     13 %     0 %     0 %     0 %     0 %
                                                 
Totals
    18 %     16 %     33 %     12 %     15 %     6 %
 
 
46

 
 
The following table presents the scheduled maturities of fixed and variable rate loans for our non-covered and covered loan portfolios.
 
   
December 31, 2011
 
   
One year
or less
   
After one
year to
five
years
   
After five
years
   
Total
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Fixed rate loans
                       
Commercial mortgage
  $ 16,344     $ 49,922     $ 101,369     $ 167,635  
Commercial loans and lines
    16,773       31,474       19,097       67,344  
Multifamily mortgage
    4,601       4,518       43,021       52,140  
Home mortgage
    5,257       19,109       101,738       126,104  
Construction and land
    12,791       5,717       11,121       29,629  
Home equity loans
    291       2,420       6,208       8,919  
Installment & credit card
    1,530       923       726       3,179  
                                 
Total fixed rate loan maturities
    57,587       114,083       283,280       454,950  
                                 
Variable rate loans
                               
Commercial mortgage
    15,985       11,563       235,997       263,545  
Commercial loans and lines
    88,120       25,730       10,433       124,283  
Multifamily mortgage
    236       41,349       109,552       151,137  
Home mortgage
    1       1,090       15,891       16,982  
Construction and land
    17,014       8,260       3,054       28,328  
Home equity loans
    6,776       9,871       13,920       30,567  
Installment & credit card
    474       680       569       1,723  
                                 
Total adjustable rate loan maturities
    128,606       98,543       389,416       616,565  
                                 
Total maturities
  $ 186,193     $ 212,626     $ 672,696     $ 1,071,515  
 
Allowance for Loan Losses
 
We maintain an allowance for loan losses to provide for inherent losses in the non-covered loan portfolio. We establish the allowance through a provision charged to expense. We charge-off all loans judged uncollectible against the allowance while we credit any recoveries on loans to the allowance. We charge-off commercial and real estate loans — construction, commercial mortgage, multifamily mortgage and home mortgage — by the time their principal or interest becomes 120 days delinquent unless the loan is well-secured and in the process of collection. We also charge-off consumer loans by the time they become 90 days delinquent unless the loan is well-secured and in the process of collection. We also charge-off deposit overdrafts when they become more than 60 days old. We evaluate impaired loans on a case-by-case basis to determine the ultimate loss potential to us after considering the proceeds realizable from a sale of collateral. In those cases where the collateral value is less than the loan, we charge-off the loan to reduce the balance to a level equal to the net realizable value of the collateral. We consider a loan impaired when, based on current information and events, we do not expect to be able to collect all amounts due according to the loan contract, including scheduled interest payments.
 
Our loan policy provides procedures designed to evaluate and assess the risk factors associated with our loan portfolio, to enable us to assess such risk factors prior to granting new loans and to evaluate the sufficiency of the allowance for loan losses. We assess the allowance on a monthly basis and undertake a more critical evaluation quarterly. At the time of the quarterly review, the Board of Directors will examine and formally approve the adequacy of the allowance. The quarterly evaluation includes an assessment of the following factors: any external loan review and any regulatory examination, estimated probable loss exposure on each pool of loans, concentrations of credit, value of collateral, the level of delinquency and non-accruals, trends in the portfolio volume, effects of any changes in the lending policies and procedures, changes in lending personnel, present economic conditions at the local, state and national level, the amount of undisbursed off-balance sheet commitments, and a migration analysis of historical losses and recoveries for the prior twenty quarters.
 
Our evaluation of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses includes a review of individual loans to identify specific probable losses and assigns estimated loss factors to specific groups or types of loans to calculate possible losses. In addition, we estimate the probable loss on previously accrued but unpaid interest. We refer to these as quantitative considerations. Our evaluation also considers subjective factors such as changes in local and regional economic and business conditions, financial improvement or deterioration in business sectors and industries, changes in lending practices, changes in personnel, changes in the volume and level of past due and nonaccrual loans and concentrations of credit. We refer to these as qualitative considerations.
 
 
47

 
 
Our year-end 2011 evaluation of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses considered, among other things, estimated loss factors assigned to specific types of loans, changes and trends in the level of delinquencies, nonaccrual loans and loan charge-offs, changes in the value of collateral, changes in the local and regional economic and business conditions, the judgment of the bank regulatory agencies at the conclusion of their examination process with respect to information available to them during such examination process. Finally, we considered the weakness of the economic recovery and the impact it might have on our borrowers, especially our small business borrowers. More specifically, we revised downward, in the fourth quarter of 2011, our estimated loss factors for our qualitative considerations. We revised upward in each of the first three quarters of 2011 and then downward in the final quarter of 2011 our estimated loss factors for our quantitative considerations. Our reasons are as follows.
 
We considered the trend in the level of our loan credit quality indicators, delinquencies, nonaccrual loans and loan charge-offs. Loans rated Special mention, Substandard, Doubtful or Loss decreased to $68.6 million at December 31, 2011 from $75.1 million a December 31, 2010. Total non-covered past due loans and nonaccrual loans decreased to $17.3 million at December 31, 2011 from $29.9 million at December 31, 2010. Non-covered foreclosed property decreased to $20.3 million at December 31, 2011 from $26.0 million at December 31, 2010. Net non-covered loan charge-offs decreased to $4.6 million, or 0.51% of average non-covered loans for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared with $7.8 million, or 0.85% of average non-covered loans for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
We considered the marketing time and sales prices for our completed construction loan portfolio. Our non-covered construction and land loan portfolio was 4 percent of non-covered loans at December 31, 2011 compared with 6 percent at December 31, 2010. While this loan portfolio declined principally from successful marketing and sales efforts, the continued disruption in the residential and commercial mortgage loan markets and the continued downward pressure on real estate values may adversely affect these loans.
 
Finally, we considered the weakness of the economic recovery and the impact it might have on our borrowers, especially our small business borrowers, and the judgment of the bank regulatory agencies at the conclusion of their examination process with respect to information available to them during such examination process.
 
As a result, the allowance for loan losses increased to $17.7 million at December 31, 2011 from $17.0 million at December 31, 2010. The provision for loan losses was $5.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, compared with $8.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. The ratio of the allowance for loan losses to non-covered loans was 1.90 percent at December 31, 2011 compared with 1.80 percent at December 31, 2010.
 
We believe that our allowance for loan losses was adequate at December 31, 2011 and 2010. The determination of the allowance for loan losses, however, is a highly judgmental process and we cannot assure you that we will not further increase or decrease the allowance or that bank regulators will not require us to increase or decrease the allowance in the future.
 
The following table presents activity in the allowance for loan losses.
 
   
For the years ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Beginning balance
  $ 17,033     $ 16,505     $ 8,048     $ 7,828     $ 4,740  
Balance acquired in purchase
                            3,554  
Provision for loan losses
    5,346       8,337       16,646       1,150        
Loans charged-off
    (5,177 )     (8,535 )     (8,580 )     (1,075 )     (567 )
Transfer to undisbursed commitment
                             
Recoveries on loans charged-off
    545       726       391       145       101  
                                         
Ending balance
  $ 17,747     $ 17,033     $ 16,505     $ 8,048     $ 7,828  
                                         
Allowance to non-covered loans
    1.90 %     1.80 %     1.76 %     1.02 %     1.05 %
Net loans charged-off to average non-covered loans
    0.51 %     0.85 %     0.89 %     0.12 %     0.07 %
 
 
48

 
 
The following table presents the net loan charge-offs (recoveries) by non-covered loan type for the periods indicated.
 
   
Twelve months ended December 31,
 
(in thousands)
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Construction
  $ 176     $ 382     $ 853  
Home mortgage
    475       447       1,210  
Commercial loans & lines
    3,480       5,256       4,537  
Commercial mortgage
    366       1,680       1,599  
Home equity
    39              
Consumer
    96       44       (10 )
                         
 Total
  $ 4,632     $ 7,809     $ 8,189  
 
The following table presents the allocation of the allowance for loan losses to each loan category and the percentage relationship of loans in each category to total non-covered loans:
 
   
For the years ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
Allocation
of the
allowance
by loan
category
   
Percent of
Loans in
Category
to Total
Non-covered
Loans
   
Allocation
of the
allowance
by loan
category
   
Percent of
Loans in
Category
to Total
Non-covered
Loans
   
Allocation
of the
allowance
by loan
category
   
Percent of
Loans in
Category
to Total
Non-covered
Loans
   
Allocation
of the
allowance
by loan
category
   
Percent of
Loans in
Category
to Total
Non-covered
Loans
   
Allocation
of the
allowance
by loan
category
   
Percent of
Loans in
Category
to Total
Non-covered
Loans
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Commercial mortgage
  $ 6,091       42 %   $ 6,134       42 %   $ 4,850       41 %   $ 2,504       38 %   $ 2,928       40 %
Multifamily mortgage
    2,886       20 %     2,273       14 %     3,277       15 %     421       7 %     174       5 %
Commercial loans
    6,221       19 %     4,934       23 %     4,796       25 %     2,463       29 %     1,991       25 %
Construction loans
    814       4 %     1,698       6 %     2,460       9 %     2,069       17 %     1,836       20 %
Home equity loans
    390       3 %     416       3 %     453       4 %     186       3 %     75       3 %
Home mortgage
    1,274       11 %     1,496       11 %     605       5 %     362       6 %     471       6 %
Installment and credit card
    71       1 %     82       1 %     64       1 %     43       %     353       1 %
                                                                                 
Total
  $ 17,747       100 %   $ 17,033       100 %   $ 16,505       100 %   $ 8,048       100 %   $ 7,828       100 %
 
The amounts or proportions displayed above do not imply that charges to the allowance will occur in those amounts or proportions.
 
We had 16 non-covered restructured loans for $4.4 million at December 31, 2011; of these, six restructured loans for $0.9 million were current at December 31, 2011, one restructured loan for $0.7 million was included in the accruing loans past due 30 to 89 days category shown below and nine restructured loans for $2.8 million were included in the nonaccrual loan category shown below. We had twelve non-covered restructured loans for $4.2 million at December 31, 2010; of these, three restructured loans for $1.3 million were current at December 31, 2010, one restructured loan for $0.7 million was included in the accruing loans past due 30 to 89 days category shown below and eight restructured loans for $2.3 million were included in the $18.2 million nonaccrual loan category shown below.
 
The following table presents non-covered past due and nonaccrual loans.
 
   
For the years ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Accruing non-covered loans past due 30 to 89 days
  $ 3,449     $ 11,630     $ 14,592     $ 2,644     $ 4,746  
Accruing non-covered loans past due 90 days or more
  $     $     $ 200     $ 429     $ 2,848  
Nonaccrual loans
  $ 13,860     $ 18,241     $ 39,958     $ 8,475     $ 5,720  
Ratios:
                                       
Accruing loans past due 90 days or more to average non-covered  loans
                0.02 %     0.05 %     0.42 %
Non-covered nonaccrual loans to non-covered loans
    1.48 %     1.92 %     4.25 %     1.07 %     0.77 %
Interest foregone on non-covered nonaccrual loans
  $ 841     $ 2,066     $ 2,134     $ 543     $ 339  
 
Accruing non-covered loans past due 30 to 89 days decreased to $3.4 million at December 31, 2011 from $11.6 million at December 31, 2010. This category of non-covered loans historically has had the most fluctuation from period to period.
 
 
49

 
 
Our largest nonaccrual loan was a revolving credit facility to purchase and develop a film library with a balance of $8.5 million at December 31, 2011. This amount is after charge-offs of $3.3 million. The charge-off represented the estimated excess of the loan advances over the value of the film library. This loan is a participation in a credit facility also known as a shared national credit. We estimated at December 31, 2011 a specific loss allowance of $2.6 million for this loan.
 
Our next largest nonaccrual loan was a $1.2 million commercial business loan. This loan was performing in accordance with modified loan terms at December 31, 2011. We estimated a specific loss allowance of $306,000 for this loan at December 31, 2011.
 
Our third largest nonaccrual loan was a $1.1 million commercial restaurant loan. This loan was performing in accordance with modified loan terms at December 31, 2011. We estimated a specific loss allowance of $71,000 for this loan at December 31, 2011.
 
All other nonaccrual loans were individually under $1 million at December 31, 2011.
 
The following table presents the activity in our non-covered nonaccrual loan category for the periods indicated.
 
   
Twelve months ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
# of Loans
   
$ Amount
   
# of Loans
   
$ Amount
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Beginning balance
    28     $ 18,241       21     $ 39,958  
New loans added
    37       8,385       44       27,650  
Repurchase of SBA-guaranteed participation
                      317  
Loans transferred to foreclosed property
    (5 )     (3,103 )     (8 )     (24,806 )
Loans returned to accrual status
    (12 )     (2,955 )     (9 )     (4,380 )
Payoffs on existing loans
    (9 )     (2,144 )     (11 )     (11,585 )
Loans sold
                (1 )     (490 )
Partial charge-offs on existing loans
          (221 )           (6,170 )
Charge-offs on existing loans
    (10 )     (3,234 )     (8 )     (859 )
Payments on existing loans
          (1,109 )           (1,394 )
                                 
Ending balance
    29     $ 13,860       28     $ 18,241  
 
Non-covered foreclosed property at December 31, 2011 consists of a $14.0 million completed office complex project consisting of 16 buildings in Ventura County, a $2.8 million unimproved land property of 161 acres located in an unincorporated section of western Los Angeles County known as Liberty Canyon and a $1.8 million industrial building in Costa Mesa, California. The remainder consists of one multifamily property, repossessed equipment and two single-family residences.
 
The following table presents the activity of our non-covered foreclosed property for the periods indicated.
 
   
Twelve months ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
# of Properties
   
$ Amount
   
# of Properties
   
$ Amount
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Beginning balance
    8     $ 26,011       1     $ 4,893  
New properties added
    4       3,356       10       25,660  
Valuation allowances
          (5,784 )           (2,305 )
Sales of properties
    (5 )     (3,234 )     (3 )     (2,237 )
                                 
Ending balance
    7     $ 20,349       8     $ 26,011  
 
The allowance for losses on undisbursed commitments was $101,000 at both December 31, 2011, and December 31, 2010. The allowance for losses on undisbursed commitments is included in “accrued interest payable and other liabilities” on the consolidated balance sheets.
 
We consider a loan impaired when, based on current information and events, we do not expect to be able to collect all amounts due according to the loan contract, including scheduled interest payments. We determine loan impairment through periodic evaluation on an individual loan basis. The average investment in impaired loans was $17.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 and $26.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. Impaired loans were $13.9 million at December 31, 2011 and $17.2 million at December 31, 2010. Allowances for losses for individually impaired loans are based on either the estimated collateral value less estimated selling costs (if the loan is a collateral-dependent loan), or the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate. Of the $13.9 million of impaired loans at December 31, 2011, $11.1 million had specific allowances of $3.1 million. Of the $17.2 million of impaired loans at December 31, 2010, $12.5 million had specific allowances of $2.0 million.
 
 
50

 
 
Covered loans and FDIC shared-loss asset
 
We acquired loans in the WCB and SLTB acquisitions for which we entered into shared-loss agreements with the FDIC, or covered loans. We will share in the losses, which begin with the first dollar of loss incurred, on the loan pools covered under the shared-loss agreements. We refer to all other loans in our loan portfolio not acquired from WCB or SLTB and not covered by the shared-loss agreements as non-covered loans.
 
Pursuant to the terms of the shared-loss agreements, the FDIC is obligated to reimburse us for 80 percent of eligible losses with respect to covered assets (loans and foreclosed property). We have a corresponding obligation to reimburse the FDIC for 80 percent of eligible recoveries with respect to covered assets. The shared-loss agreements for commercial and single-family residential mortgage loans are in effect for five years and ten years, respectively, from the acquisition dates and the loss recovery provisions are in effect for eight years and ten years, respectively, from the acquisition dates.
 
The covered loan portfolio increased to $135.4 million at December 31, 2011 from $53.9 million at December 31, 2010 because of the FDIC-assisted SLTB acquisition in February 2011. The following table sets forth the composition of the covered loan portfolio by type.
 
Covered loans by property type (in thousands)
 
At
December 31,
2011
   
At
December 31,
2010
 
Commercial mortgage
  $ 37,804     $ 26,046  
Home mortgage
    36,736       2,046  
Construction and land loans
    22,875       6,143  
Multifamily
    15,944       2,688  
Commercial loans and lines of credit
    11,206       16,820  
Home equity loans and lines of credit
    10,841       135  
Installment and credit card
    6        
                 
Total covered loans
  $ 135,412     $ 53,878  
 
 The FDIC shared-loss asset represents the present value of the amounts we expect to receive from the FDIC under the shared-loss agreements. The FDIC shared-loss asset was $68.1 million at December 31, 2011 and $16.7 million at December 31, 2010. The increase was due to the initial FDIC shared-loss asset recorded in conjunction with the FDIC-assisted SLTB acquisition on February 18, 2011.
 
The acquired covered loans are and will continue to be subject to the Bank’s internal and external credit review and monitoring practices. The covered loans have the same credit quality indicators, such as risk grade and classification, as the non-covered loans, to enable the monitoring of the borrower’s credit and the likelihood of repayment. If credit deteriorates beyond the respective acquisition date fair value amount of covered loans, we will establish an allowance for credit losses through a charge to earnings.
 
    We recorded at fair value the FDIC shared-loss asset, which represented the present value of the estimated cash payments from the FDIC for future losses on covered assets. The ultimate collectability of this asset is dependent upon the performance of the underlying covered assets, the passage of time and claims paid by the FDIC. The following table presents the changes in the FDIC shared-loss asset for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011.
 
   
Twelve months ended December 31, 2011
 
(in thousands)
 
WCB
   
SLTB
   
Total
 
Balance, beginning of period
  $ 16,725     $     $ 16,725  
Acquisition
          70,293       70,293  
FDIC share of additional losses
    740       2,189       2,929  
Cash payments received from FDIC
    (8,379 )     (13,672 )     (22,051 )
Net accretion
    73       114       187  
                         
Balance, end of period
  $ 9,159     $ 58,924     $ 68,083  
 
 Forty-five days following the tenth anniversary of the WCB and SLTB acquisition dates, we will be required to perform a calculation and determine if a payment to the FDIC is necessary. The payment amount will be 50 percent of the excess, if any, of (i) 20 percent of the intrinsic loss estimate minus (ii) the sum of (a) 20 percent of the net loss amount, plus (b) 25 percent of the asset discount bid, plus (c) 3.5 percent of total loss share assets at acquisition. Our estimate for the present value of this liability was $3.8 million and $1.0 million at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
51

 
 
Covered foreclosed property
 
Covered foreclosed property at December 31, 2011 was $14.6 million and $1.0 million at December 31, 2010. We acquired these properties as part of the FDIC-assisted Western Commercial Bank and San Luis Trust Bank acquisitions. We recorded these properties at their estimated fair value, less estimated costs to sell, at the time of acquisition. Since year-end 2010, we sold $19.5 million of properties and acquired or added $33.6 million.
 
The following table presents the activity of our covered foreclosed property for the periods indicated.
 
   
Twelve months ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
# of Properties
   
$ Amount
   
# of Properties
   
$ Amount
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Beginning balance
    2     $ 977           $  
New properties acquired
    22       11,052       2       977  
New properties added
    57       22,587              
Valuation allowances
          (455 )            
Sales of properties
    (32 )     (19,545 )            
Ending balance
    49     $ 14,616       2     $ 977  
 
Investing, funding and liquidity risk
 
Liquidity risk is the risk to earnings or capital arising from the inability to meet obligations when they come due without incurring unacceptable losses. Liquidity risk includes the inability to manage unplanned decreases or changes in funding sources as well as the failure to recognize or address changes in market conditions that affect the ability to liquidate assets quickly and with minimal loss in value.
 
We manage bank liquidity risk through Board approved policies and procedures. The Directors review and approve these policies at least annually. Liquidity risk policies provide us with a framework for consistent evaluation of risk and establish risk tolerance parameters. Management’s Asset and Liability Committee meets regularly to evaluate liquidity risk, review and establish deposit interest rates, review loan and deposit in-flows and out-flows and reports quarterly to the Directors’ Balance Sheet Management Committee on compliance with policies. The Directors’ Audit Committee also engages a third party to perform a review of management’s asset and liability practices to ensure compliance with policies.
 
We enjoy a large base of core deposits (representing checking, savings and small balance non-brokered certificates of deposit). At December 31, 2011, core deposits were $1.2 billion. At December 31, 2010, core deposits were $892.7 million. The increase is a result of the core deposits acquired in connection with the EPS division acquisition as well as deposit growth throughout our branch network. Core deposits represent a significant low-cost source of funds that support our lending activities and represent a key part of our funding strategy. We seek and stress the importance of both loan and deposit relationships with customers in our business plans.
 
Alternative funding sources include large balance certificates of deposits, brokered deposits, federal funds purchased from other institutions, securities sold under agreements to repurchase and borrowings. Total alternative funds used at December 31, 2011 declined to $392.9 million from $395.1 million at December 31, 2010. The increase in core deposits allowed us to reduce these funds.
 
In addition, we have lines of credit with other financial institutions providing for federal funds facilities up to a maximum of $30.0 million. The lines of credit support short-term liquidity needs and we cannot use them for more than 30 consecutive days. These lines are unsecured, have no formal maturity date and can be revoked at any time by the granting institutions. There were no borrowings under these lines of credit at December 31, 2011 and 2010. We also have a $14.3 million secured borrowing facility with the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco, which had no balance outstanding at December 31, 2011 and 2010. In addition, we had approximately $271.9 million of available borrowing capacity on the Bank’s secured FHLB borrowing facility at December 31, 2011.
 
 
52

 
 
The primary sources of liquidity for the Company, on a stand-alone basis, include the dividends from the Bank and, historically, our ability to issue equity and debt instruments. The ability of the Company to obtain funds for its cash requirements, including payments on the junior subordinated debentures underlying our outstanding trust preferred securities and dividends on our series C preferred stock, is largely dependent upon the Bank’s earnings. The Bank is subject to restrictions under certain federal and state laws and regulations, which limit its ability to transfer funds to the Company through intercompany loans, advances or cash dividends. The California Department of Financial Institutions, or DFI, under its general supervisory authority as it relates to a bank’s capital requirements regulates dividends paid by California state banks. A California state bank may declare a dividend without the approval of the DFI as long as the total dividends declared in a calendar year do not exceed either the retained earnings or the total of net profits for three previous fiscal years less any dividends paid during such period. At January 1, 2012, there were $27.2 million of dividends available for payment under the method described. During the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, we received no dividends from the Bank. The Company had $3.2 million in cash on deposit with the Bank at December 31, 2011.
 
In order to meet our deposit, borrowings and loan obligations when they come due, we maintain a portion of our funds in liquid assets. Liquid assets include cash balances at the Reserve Bank, interest-bearing deposits with other financial institutions, and federal funds sold to other financial institutions. We also manage liquidity risk with readily saleable debt securities and debt securities that serve as collateral for borrowings.
 
At December 31, 2011, we had non-interest earning cash balances at the Reserve Bank of $34.2 million compared with $19.9 million at December 31, 2010. Interest-bearing deposits with the Reserve Bank and other financial institutions decreased to $21.2 million at December 31, 2011 from $62.5 million at December 31, 2010. The $41.3 million decrease reflects the increase in securities. We believe that these sources of liquidity will be sufficient for the Company to meet its liquidity needs over the next twelve months. A number of factors may affect funds generated from these liquidity sources. See “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of the factors that can negatively affect the amount of funds we could receive.
 
As disclosed in the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, net cash used in operating activities was $6.0 million during the twelve months ended December 31, 2011. The difference between cash used by operating activities and net income largely consisted of non-cash items including a $36.9 million gain on acquisitions.
 
Net cash of $185.9 million provided by investing activities consisted principally of $122.1 million of cash acquired in the SLTB and EPS division acquisitions and $53.8 million of proceeds from net covered and non-covered loan paydowns.
 
Net cash of $165.2 million used in financing activities reflects primarily the run-off and maturities of SLTB wholesale deposits and  borrowings.
 
Securities
 
We classify securities as ‘available-for-sale’ for accounting purposes and, as such, report them at their fair, or market, values in our balance sheets. We use quoted market prices for fair values. We report as ‘other comprehensive income or loss’, net of tax, changes in the fair value of our securities (that is, unrealized holding gains or losses) and carry these cumulative changes as accumulated comprehensive income or loss within shareholders’ equity until realized.
 
The following table presents securities, at amortized cost, by expected maturity distribution and weighted average yield (tax equivalent).  Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. 
 
   
At December 31, 2011
 
   
One year
or less
   
After one
year to
five years
   
After five
years to
ten
years
   
Over ten
years
   
Total
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Maturity distribution
                             
U.S. Treasury notes/bills
  $ 45,151     $     $     $     $ 45,151  
U.S. government agency notes
    21,209       38,003                   59,212  
U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities
          78,692       29,603       23,846       132,141  
U.S. government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
          121,392       43,155       3,611       168,158  
Private label collateralized mortgage obligations
          3,216       12,637             15,853  
Municipal securities
    80             16,647       11,845       28,572  
Other domestic debt securities
          2,500             4,651       7,151  
                                         
Total
  $ 66,440     $ 243,803     $ 102,042     $ 43,953     $ 456,238  
 
 
53

 
 
      At December 31, 2011  
   
One year
or les
   
After one
year to
five years
   
After five
years to
ten
years
   
Over ten
years
   
Total
 
      (in thousands)  
Weighted average yield
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
U.S. Treasury notes/bills
    0.16 %                       0.16 %
U.S. government agency notes
    0.33 %     1.06 %                 0.80 %
U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities
          2.54 %     2.59 %     3.70 %     2.76 %
U.S. government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
          2.41 %     2.38 %     2.74 %     2.41 %
Private label collateralized mortgage obligations
          6.50 %     5.54 %           5.73 %
Municipal securities
    7.42 %           4.01 %     4.50 %     4.22 %
Other domestic debt securities
          1.20 %           1.48 %     1.38 %
 
                                       
Total
    0.22 %     2.28 %     3.10 %     3.60 %     2.29 %
 
Securities, at amortized cost, increased by $177.2 million, or 64 percent, from $279.0 million at December 31, 2010 to $456.2 million at December 31, 2011 primarily from the deployment of excess liquidity.
 
Net unrealized holding losses were $2.5 million at December 31, 2011 and $6.5 million at December 31, 2010. As a percentage of securities, at amortized cost, net unrealized holding losses were 0.55 percent and 2.35 percent at the end of each respective period. Securities are comprised largely of U.S. Treasury bills and notes, and U.S. government agency notes, mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations. On a quarterly basis, we evaluate our individual available-for-sale securities in an unrealized loss position for other-than-temporary impairment. As part of this evaluation, we consider whether we intend to sell each security and whether it is more-likely-than-not that, we will be required to sell the security before the anticipated recovery of the security’s amortized cost basis. Should a security meet either of these conditions, we recognize an impairment charge to earnings equal to the entire difference between the security’s amortized cost basis and its fair value at the balance sheet date. For securities in an unrealized loss position that meet neither of these conditions, we consider whether we expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the security by comparing our best estimate, on a present value basis, of the expected future cash flows from the security with the amortized cost basis of the security. If our best estimate of expected future cash flows is less than the amortized cost basis of the security, we recognize an impairment charge to earnings for this estimated credit loss.
 
We determined that, as of December 31, 2011, our U.S. Treasury notes and bills, and U.S. government agency notes, mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations were temporarily impaired because these securities were in a continuous loss position for less than 12 months. We believe the cause of the gross unrealized losses was from movements in interest rates and not by the deterioration of the issuers’ creditworthiness.
 
We own one pooled trust preferred security, rated triple-A at purchase, with an amortized cost basis of $4.7 million and an unrealized loss of $2.1 million at December 31, 2011. The gross unrealized loss was mainly due to extraordinarily high investor yield requirements resulting from an illiquid market, causing this security to be valued at a discount to its acquisition cost. One credit rating agency has now rated the security triple-C while another has rated the security Baa3. The senior tranche owned by us has a collateral balance well in excess of the amortized cost basis of the tranche at December 31, 2011. Eighteen of the fifty-six issuers in the security have deferred or defaulted on their interest payments as of December 31, 2011. Our analysis determined that approximately half of the issuers would need to default on their interest payments before the senior tranche owned by us would be at risk of loss. As our estimated present value of expected cash flows to be collected was in excess of our amortized cost basis, we concluded that the gross unrealized loss on this security was temporary.
 
The majority of gross unrealized losses at December 31, 2011, relate to a type of mortgage-backed security also known as private-label collateralized mortgage obligations, or CMOs. As of December 31, 2011, the current par value of these securities was $18.1 million and the amortized cost basis, net of other-than-temporary impairment charges, was $15.9 million. At year-end 2011, the fair value of these securities was $13.0 million, representing 3 percent of our securities portfolio. Gross unrealized losses for these private-label CMO’s were $2.8 million, or 18 percent of the amortized cost basis of these securities at December 31, 2011.
 
The gross unrealized losses on these securities were primarily due to extraordinarily high investor yield requirements resulting from an illiquid market, significant uncertainty about the future condition of the mortgage market and the economy, and continued deterioration in the credit performance of loan collateral underlying these securities, causing these securities to be valued at significant discounts to their acquisition cost. Our three private-label CMO’s had credit agency ratings of less than investment grade at December 31, 2011. We performed a discounted cash flow analysis for the these three securities using the current month, last three month and last twelve month historical prepayment speed, the cumulative default rate and the loss severity rate to determine if there was other-than-temporary impairment at year-end. Based upon this analysis, we determined that the three private-label CMO’s were other-than-temporarily impaired as of December 31, 2011 (that is, securities for which we determined that it was more likely than not that the entire amortized cost basis would not be recovered), and we recognized a credit loss of $321,000 in the fourth quarter of 2011. We had previously recognized a $1,066,000 credit loss on these three securities in the first quarter of 2011. For the year ended December 31, 2011, impairment losses charged to earnings were $1,387,000. For the year ended December 31, 2010, impairment losses charged to earnings were $749,000. This included a $41,000 impairment recognized on a $1.0 million community development-related equity investment. We do not intend to sell these securities and we do not believe it likely that we will be required to sell these securities before the anticipated recovery of the remaining amortized cost basis. If current conditions in the mortgage markets and general business and economic conditions continue to deteriorate further, the fair value of our private-label CMOs may decline further and we may experience further impairment losses. We cannot predict whether we will be required to record additional impairment charges on our securities in the future.
 
 
54

 
 
Deposits
 
The following tables present the balance of each deposit category at the periods indicated:
 
   
At
December 31,
2011
   
At
December 31,
2010
   
At
December 31,
2009
 
   
Balance
   
Balance
   
Balance
 
                   
Core deposits
                 
Noninterest bearing checking
  $ 482,156     $ 331,648     $ 317,610  
Interest checking
    107,077       88,638       82,806  
Savings and money market accounts
    486,000       388,289       339,750  
Retail time deposits less than $100,000
    74,861       84,133       90,279  
                         
Total core deposits
    1,150,094       892,708       830,445  
                         
Noncore deposits
                       
Retail time deposits of $100,000 or more
    169,523       144,974       151,753  
Wholesale time deposits
    5,652       18,606       32,517  
State of California time deposits
    100,000       100,000       110,000  
Total noncore deposits
    275,175       263,580       294,270  
                         
Total core and noncore deposits
  $ 1,425,269     $ 1,156,288     $ 1,124,715  
 
Large balance certificates of deposits (that is, balances of $100,000 or more) were $275.2 million at December 31, 2011. Large balance certificates of deposits were $263.6 million at December 31, 2010. A portion of these large balance time deposits represent time deposits placed by the State Treasurer of California with the Bank. The time deposit program is one element of a pooled investment account managed by the State Treasurer for the benefit of the State of California and all participating local agencies. The pooled investment account has approximately $67.9 billion of investments of which approximately $4.1 billion represented time deposits placed at various financial institutions. At December 31, 2011and 2010, State of California time deposits placed with us, with original maturities of three to six months, were $100.0 million. We believe that the State Treasurer will continue this program; we also believe that we have the ability to establish large balance certificates of deposit rates that will enable us to attract, replace, or retain those deposits accepted in our local market area if it becomes necessary under a modified funding strategy.
 
From time to time we use brokered time deposits, categorized as wholesale time deposits in the table above, to supplement our liquidity and achieve other asset-liability management objectives. Brokered deposits are wholesale certificates of deposit accepted by us from brokers whose customers do not have any other significant relationship with us. As a result, we believe these funds are very sensitive to credit risk and interest rates, and pose greater liquidity risk to us. These customers may refuse to renew the certificates of deposit at maturity if higher rates are available elsewhere or if they perceive that our creditworthiness is deteriorating. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, we had no brokered deposits. At December 31, 2009, we had brokered deposits of $25.7 million, all of which had maturities within the following 12 months.
 
We also use the Certificate of Deposit Account Registry System, or CDARS, for our deposit customers who wish to obtain FDIC insurance on their deposits beyond that available from a single institution. We place these deposits into the CDARS network and accept in return other customers’ certificates of deposits in the same amount and at the same interest rate. We had $5.7 million of these reciprocal deposits, categorized as wholesale time deposits in the table above, at December 31, 2011.  We had $7.0 million and $6.8 million of these reciprocal deposits at the end of 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
 
55

 
 
The following table presents the maturity of large balance certificates of deposits for the periods indicated:
 
   
For the Years Ending December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Amount
   
Percentage
   
Amount
   
Percentage
   
Amount
   
Percentage
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Three months or less
  $ 132,043       48 %   $ 131,710       50 %   $ 156,720       58 %
Over three months through six months
    26,871       10 %     23,815       9 %     31,165       12 %
Over six months through one year
    41,644       15 %     44,002       17 %     40,136       15 %
Over one year
    74,617       27 %     63,890       24 %     40,516       15 %
                                                 
Total
  $ 275,175       100 %   $ 263,417       100 %   $ 268,537       100 %
 
Borrowings
 
Borrowings are comprised of federal funds purchased from other financial institutions, FHLB advances and securities sold under agreements to repurchase. At December 31, 2011, we had $117.7 million of borrowings outstanding, of which $30.0 million was comprised of securities sold under agreements to repurchase and $87.7 million of FHLB advances. For our FHLB advances, the following table presents the amounts and weighted average interest rates outstanding.
 
   
Year Ended December 31, 2011
   
Year Ended December 31, 2010
 
   
Federal Home Loan
Bank Advances
   
Weighted average
interest rate
   
Federal Home Loan
Bank Advances
   
Weighted average
interest rate
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Amount outstanding at end of period
  $ 87,719       3.01 %   $ 86,500       3.11 %
Maximum amount outstanding at any month-end during the period
  $ 138,750       2.69 %   $ 118,000       2.53 %
Average amount outstanding during the period
  $ 98,290       2.66 %   $ 88,995       3.69 %
 
The following table presents the maturities of FHLB advances at December 31, 2011.
 
   
Amount
   
Maturity
Year
   
Weighted Average
Interest Rate
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Term advances
  $ 25,551       2012       3.56 %
Term advances
    7,168       2013       2.88 %
Term advances
    32,500       2014       2.95 %
Term advances
    15,000       2015       1.76 %
Term advances
    7,500       2017       4.07 %
                         
    $ 87,719                  
 
 
56

 
 
The following table presents the maturities of securities sold under agreements to repurchase at December 31, 2011.
 
Amount
 
Maturity
Year
 
Weighted Average
Interest Rate
     
(in thousands)
     
$ 20,000  
February 2013
  3.60 %
  10,000  
December 2014
  3.72 %
$ 30,000          
 
Junior Subordinated Debentures
 
At December 31, 2011, we had $26.8 million of junior subordinated debentures outstanding from two issuances of trust preferred securities. The $10.3 million debentures due December 2035 have a variable rate of interest that resets quarterly – at March, June, September, December for each year - equal to the 3-month LIBOR rate plus 1.55%. At December 31, 2011, this rate was 2.10%. These debentures are redeemable at par and at the Company’s option at any time. The $16.5 million debentures due March 2037 have a fixed rate of interest of 6.80% until March 2012 after which they have a variable rate of interest that resets quarterly equal to the 3-month LIBOR rate plus 1.60%. These debentures are redeemable, at par, and at the Company’s option at any time on or after March 15, 2012. The weighted average interest rate paid on the debentures for 2011 was 5.00 percent and 2010 was 6.48 percent. Our interest payments for 2011 were $1.3 million and for 2010 were $1.7 million.
 
In December 2009, we purchased a $10.3 million notional forward-starting interest rate cap to limit the variable interest rate payments on our $10.3 million junior subordinated debentures. This interest rate cap became effective on December 15, 2010, has a rate cap of 4.00 percent and will expire on December 15, 2015. In September 2010, we purchased a $16.5 million notional forward-starting interest rate cap to limit the variable interest rate payments on our $16.5 million junior subordinated debentures. This interest rate cap will become effective March 15, 2012, has a rate cap of 4.00 percent and will expire on March 15, 2017.
 
Capital resources
 
We have 1,000 issued shares of preferred stock series A, $0.01 par value, with a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share. Redemption of the preferred stock series A is at our option. The redemption amount is computed at the per-share liquidation preference plus unpaid dividends at a rate of 8.5%. Each holder of preferred stock series A has the right, exercisable at the option of the holder, to convert all or some of such holder’s series A shares into common stock. The sum of each share’s liquidation preference plus unpaid dividends divided by the conversion factor of $5.63 per share represents the number of common shares issuable upon the conversion of each share of preferred stock series A. As of December 31, 2011, we reserved 329,431 of common shares for the conversion of the preferred stock series A.
 
On December 19, 2008, we participated in the U.S. Treasury Capital Purchase Program, under which we received $25 million in exchange for issuing 25,000 preferred stock series B shares and a warrant to purchase common stock to the Treasury. The common stock warrant entitled the Treasury to purchase 599,042 shares of our common stock at an exercise price of $6.26 for a term of ten years. On July 14, 2011, we redeemed all 25,000 preferred stock series B shares and exited the CPP program. On August 24, 2011, we purchased the 10-year warrant from the Treasury for $599,042. In connection with the redemption of the preferred stock series B shares, the Company accelerated the amortization of the remaining difference between the par amount and the initially recorded fair value of the preferred stock series B shares. This $1.1 million deemed dividend reduced the amount of net income available to common shareholders in 2011.
 
We redeemed the $25 million of preferred stock series B shares with the $25 million of proceeds received in exchange for issuing 25,000 preferred stock series C shares to the Treasury as a participant in the Small Business Lending Fund (SBLF) program. The preferred stock series C shares will receive non-cumulative quarterly dividends and the initial dividend rate was 5 percent. The dividend rate can fluctuate between 1 and 5 percent during the next eight quarters and is a function of the growth in qualified small business loans each quarter.
 
The Company is subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal and state banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum requirements can initiate certain mandatory — and possibly additional discretionary — actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on a company’s financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines, bank holding companies must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the company’s assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. Capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.
 
 
57

 
 
On March 3, 2010, the Company’s stockholders approved an amendment to the Company’s Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation to increase the number of authorized shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.01 per share, from 25,000,000 shares to 100,000,000 shares, and to increase the number of authorized shares of all classes of the Company’s stock from 27,500,000 shares to 102,500,000 shares.
 
In March 2010, we consummated an underwritten public offering of common stock at a price of $2.50 per share. We sold 16,560,000 common shares, which include the exercise by the underwriter of its over-allotment option, for net proceeds of $38.9 million. We contributed $36.0 million to our bank subsidiary. We intend to use the net proceeds of this public offering for general corporate purposes, including funding working capital requirements, supporting the growth of our business from internal efforts and from whole bank or failed bank acquisitions, and regulatory capital needs related to any such growth and acquisitions.
 
The following tables present the capital amounts and ratios of the Company with a comparison to the minimum ratios for the periods indicated:
 
   
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
   
(in thousands)
December 31, 2011
                   
Total capital
  $ 194,694       17.32 %   $ 89,924  
≥ 8.00 %
(to risk weighted assets)
                         
Tier I capital
  $ 180,597       16.07 %   $ 44,962  
≥ 4.00 %
(to risk weighted assets)
                         
Tier I capital
  $ 180,597       10.33 %   $ 69,906  
≥ 4.00 %
(to average assets)
                         
 
   
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
   
(in thousands)
December 31, 2010
                         
Total capital
  $ 172,599       16.79 %   $ 82,242  
≥ 8.00 %
(to risk weighted assets)
                         
Tier I capital
  $ 159,695       15.53 %   $ 41,121  
≥ 4.00 %
(to risk weighted assets)
                         
Tier I capital
  $ 159,695       11.00 %   $ 58,052  
≥ 4.00 %
(to average assets)
                         
 
The Bank is also subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal and state banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum requirements can initiate certain mandatory — and possibly additional discretionary — actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on a company’s financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, banks must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the Bank’s assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. Capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.
 
Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the following table) of Total and Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined), and of Tier 1 capital to average assets (as defined). Management believes, as of December 31, 2011, that the Bank meets all capital adequacy requirements to which it is subject.
 
As of December 31, 2011, the Bank exceeded the minimum ratios to be well-capitalized under the prompt corrective action provisions. There are no conditions or events since December 31, 2011 that we believe would change the Bank’s category.
 
 
58

 
 
The following tables present the capital amounts and ratios of the Bank with a comparison to the minimum ratios for the periods indicated:
 
   
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
 
To be Well
Capitalized Under
Prompt Corrective
Action Provision
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
   
(in thousands)
December 31, 2011
                           
Total capital
  $ 192,227       17.10 %   $ 89,944  
≥ 8.00 %
  $ 112,430  
≥ 10.00 %
(to risk weighted assets)
                                   
Tier I capital
  $ 178,126       15.84 %   $ 44,972  
≥ 4.00 %
  $ 67,458  
≥ 6.00 %
(to risk weighted assets)
                                   
Tier I capital
  $ 178,126       10.18 %   $ 69,968  
≥ 4.00 %
  $ 87,460  
≥ 5.00 %
(to average assets)
                                   
 
   
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
 
To be Well
Capitalized Under
Prompt Corrective
Action Provision
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
   
(in thousands)
December 31, 2010
                           
Total capital
  $ 167,395       16.31 %   $ 82,090  
≥ 8.00 %
  $ 102,613  
≥ 10.00 %
(to risk weighted assets)
                                   
Tier I capital
  $ 154,515       15.06 %   $ 41,045  
≥ 4.00 %
  $ 61,568  
≥ 6.00 %
(to risk weighted assets)
                                   
Tier I capital
  $ 154,515       10.63 %   $ 58,134  
≥ 4.00 %
  $ 72,668  
≥ 5.00 %
(to average assets)
                                   
 
We recognize that a strong capital position is vital to growth, continued profitability, and depositor and investor confidence. Our policy is to maintain sufficient capital at not less than the well-capitalized thresholds established by banking regulators.
 
Commitments, contingent liabilities, contractual obligations and off-balance sheet arrangements
 
In the normal course of business, we make commitments to extend credit or issue letters of credit to customers. We generally do not recognize these commitments in our balance sheet. These commitments do involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk; however, we use the same credit policies and procedures as we do for on-balance sheet credit facilities. Commitments to extend credit were $159.5 million at December 31, 2011 compared with $199.9 million at December 31, 2010. Commercial and stand-by letters of credit were $1.5 million and $1.6 million at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. The known contractual obligations of the Company at December 31, 2011 are as follows:
 
   
Payments Due
 
   
Twelve
months and
less
   
After one
year but
within three
years
   
After three
years but
within
five
years
   
After five
years
   
Total
 
   
(in thousands)
 
FHLB term advances
  $ 25,551     $ 39,668     $ 15,000     $ 7,500     $ 87,719  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
          30,000                   30,000  
Salary continuation benefits
                      752       752  
Deferred compensation benefits
    106                         106  
Severance benefits
    177                         177  
Junior subordinated debentures
                      26,805       26,805  
Operating lease obligations
    2,758       4,766       3,047       4,157       14,728  
                                         
Total
  $ 28,592     $ 74,434     $ 18,047     $ 39,214     $ 160,287  
 
We have entered into deferred compensation agreements with several of our key employees. We suspended participation and contributions to these agreements in 2007. In June 2009, we terminated the plan and we distributed employee account balances as of June 2010 to the participants who elected a lump sum payment in June 2010.
 
 
59

 
 
Interest rate risk
 
Interest rate risk is the risk to earnings or capital arising from movements in interest rates. Interest rate risk arises from differences between the timing of rate changes and the timing of cash flows (re-pricing risk), from changing rate relationships among different yield curves affecting bank activities (basis risk), from changing rate relationships across the spectrum of maturities (yield curve risk), and from interest-related options embedded in loans and products (options risk).
 
We manage bank interest risk through Board approved policies and procedures. The Directors review and approve these policies at least annually. Interest rate risk policies provide management with a framework for consistent evaluation of risk and establish risk tolerance parameters. Management’s Asset and Liability Committee meets regularly to evaluate interest rate risk, engages a third party to assist in the measurement and evaluation of risk and reports quarterly to the Directors’ Balance Sheet Management Committee on compliance with policies. The Directors’ Audit Committee also engages a third party to perform a review of management’s asset and liability practices to ensure compliance with policies.
 
We use simulation-modeling techniques that apply alternative interest rate scenarios to periodic forecasts of future business activity and assess the potential changes to net interest income. Our base scenario examines our balance sheet where we assume rate changes occur ratably over an initial 12-month horizon based upon a parallel shift in the yield curve and then is maintained at that level over the remainder of the simulation horizon. We also create alternative scenarios where we assume different types of yield curve movements. In our most recent base simulation, we estimated that net interest income would decrease approximately 0.16% within a 12-month time horizon for an assumed 100 basis point decrease in prevailing interest rates or decrease approximately 0.19% for an assumed 100 basis point increase in prevailing interest rates. In addition, we estimated that net interest income would decrease approximately 0.35% within a 12-month time horizon for an assumed 200 basis point increase in prevailing rates. These estimated changes were within the policy limits established by the Board. The table below illustrates the estimated percentage change in our net interest income in our base scenario over hypothetical 1, 3 and 5 year horizons.
 
 
 
Time Horizon
Percentage Change
 
1 Year
 
2 Years
 
3 Years
-100 bps
 
 -0.16
%
 
-1.14
%
 
-3.39
%
+100 bps
 
-0.19
%
 
-0.63
%
 
0.51
%
+200 bps
 
-0.35
%
 
-1.72
%
 
1.53
%
+400 bps
 
-0.35
%
 
0.15
%
 
5.33
%
 
    All interest-earning assets, interest-bearing liabilities and related derivative contracts are included in the interest rate sensitivity analysis at December 31, 2011. At December 31, 2011, approximately 49 percent of our loans had a fixed rate of interest and approximately 51 percent had a variable interest rate. Of loans with a variable rate of interest, approximately 34 percent use an interest rate that floats with a specified index rate such as the Wall Street Journal Prime Rate or 3-month LIBOR rate. Approximately 24 percent of our variable interest rate loans use an interest rate that adjusts periodically, such as monthly, quarterly or annually, with a specified interest rate. Finally, approximately 42 percent of our variable interest rate loans have an interest rate that remains fixed for a period of time, such as 1, 3 or 5 years, then adjusts periodically with a specified index rate.
 
    In addition, approximately 82 percent of our variable interest rate loans have a minimum, or floor, rate of interest. Of these, 48 percent were at their minimum, or floor rate of interest. In a declining rate environment, the interest rate floors contribute to the favorable impact on our net interest income. However, in a rising rate environment, these interest rate floors serve to lessen the full benefit of higher interest rates. In our most recent base simulation, an assumed 200 basis point increase in prevailing interest rates would cause 66 percent of loans at their minimum rate of interest not to be at their floor rate of interest.
 
    Our simulation model includes assumptions about anticipated prepayments on mortgage-related instruments, the estimated cash flow on loans and deposits, and our future business activity. These assumptions are inherently uncertain and, as a result, our modeling techniques cannot precisely estimate the effect of changes in net interest income. Actual results will differ from simulated results due to the timing, magnitude and frequency of interest rate changes, cash flow and business activity.
 
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
 
Not Applicable.
 
 
60

 
 
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
 
 
 62
 
 63
 
 64
 
 65
 
 66
 
 67
 
 68

 
61

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 
(c) Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm:

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders
First California Financial Group, Inc. and Subsidiaries

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of First California Financial Group, Inc. and Subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011. We also have audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011 based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Controls over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements and an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the consolidated financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall consolidated financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.
 
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of First California Financial Group, Inc. and Subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, First California Financial Group, Inc. and Subsidiaries maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

/s/ MOSS ADAMS LLP
Portland, OR
March 15, 2012

 
62

 
 
FIRST CALIFORNIA FINANCIAL GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Balance Sheets
 
   
December 31,
2011
   
December 31,
2010
 
   
(in thousands, except
share data)
 
ASSETS
 
 
   
 
 
Cash and due from banks
  $ 40,202     $ 25,487  
Interest bearing deposits with other banks
    21,230       62,516  
Securities available-for-sale, at fair value
    453,735       272,439  
Non-covered loans, net
    918,356       930,704  
Covered loans
    135,412       53,878  
Premises and equipment, net
    18,480       19,710  
Goodwill
    60,720       60,720  
Other intangibles, net
    13,887       9,915  
FDIC shared-loss receivable
    68,083       16,725  
Non-covered foreclosed property
    20,349       26,011  
Covered foreclosed property
    14,616       977  
Deferred tax assets, net
          4,563  
Cash surrender value of life insurance
    12,670       12,232  
Accrued interest receivable and other assets
    34,924       25,457  
Total assets
  $ 1,812,664     $ 1,521,334  
 
               
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
               
Non-interest checking
  $ 482,156     $ 331,648  
Interest checking
    107,077       88,638  
Savings and money market
    486,000       388,289  
Certificates of deposit, under $100,000
    74,861       84,296  
Certificates of deposit, $100,000 and over
    275,175       263,417  
Total deposits
    1,425,269       1,156,288  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
    30,000       45,000  
Federal Home Loan Bank advances
    87,719       86,500  
Junior subordinated debentures
    26,805       26,805  
Deferred tax liabilities, net
    7,370        
FDIC shared-loss liability
    3,757       988  
Accrued interest payable and other liabilities
    8,637       7,712  
Total liabilities
    1,589,557       1,323,293  
 
               
Commitments and Contingencies (Note 22)
               
Perpetual preferred stock – authorized 2,500,000 shares
               
Series A—$0.01 par value, 1,000 shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and 2010
    1,000       1,000  
Series B—$0.01 par value, no shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and 25,000 shares at December 31, 2010
          23,627  
Series C—$0.01 par value, 25,000 shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and no shares at December 31, 2010
    25,000        
Common stock, $0.01 par value; authorized 100,000,000 shares; 29,220,079 shares issued at December 31, 2011 and 28,517,161 at December 31, 2010; 29,220,079 and 28,170,760 shares outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and 2010
    292       282  
Additional paid-in capital
    173,062       175,102  
Treasury stock, no shares at cost at December 31, 2011 and 346,401 at December 31, 2010
          (3,061 )
Retained earnings
    25,427       4,827  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
    (1,674 )     (3,736 )
Total shareholders’ equity
    223,107       198,041  
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
  $ 1,812,664     $ 1,521,334  
 
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 
63

 
 
FIRST CALIFORNIA FINANCIAL GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Operations

   
For the Year Ended
 
   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(in thousands, except per share data)
 
Interest income:
                 
Interest and fees on loans
  $ 65,945     $ 53,240     $ 52,439  
Interest on securities
    6,303       5,914       12,086  
Interest on federal funds sold and interest bearing deposits
    350       196       416  
Total interest income
    72,598       59,350       64,941  
Interest expense:
                       
Interest on deposits
    8,012       7,973       12,131  
Interest on borrowings
    3,750       4,945       5,924  
Interest on junior subordinated debt
    1,342       1,736       1,832  
Total interest expense
    13,104       14,654       19,887  
Net interest income before provision for loan losses
    59,494       44,696       45,054  
Provision for loan losses
    5,346       8,337       16,646  
Net interest income after provision for loan losses
    54,148       36,359       28,408  
Noninterest income:
                       
Service charges on deposit accounts
    3,447       3,225       3,516  
Earnings on cash surrender value of life insurance
    438       441       437  
Net gain on sale of securities
    1,022       2,014       6,469  
Impairment losses on securities
    (1,387 )     (749 )     (1,507 )
Market gain on foreclosed assets
    429       691        
Gain on acquisitions
    36,922       2,312        
Other income
    3,738       862       1,119  
Total noninterest income
    44,609       8,796       10,034  
Noninterest expense:
                       
Salaries and employee benefits
    26,510       19,014       20,867  
Premises and equipment
    6,298       6,268       6,538  
Data processing
    3,500       2,564       2,403  
Legal, audit, and other professional services
    5,570       2,033       2,719  
Printing, stationary, and supplies
    366       258       757  
Telephone
    800       841       986  
Director’s fees
    460       428       521  
Advertising and marketing
    1,637       918       1,380  
Postage
    222       212       245  
Insurance and regulatory assessments
    2,199       2,944       3,376  
Loss on and expense of foreclosed property, net
    5,178       2,954       1,563  
Market value loss on loans held-for-sale
                709  
Amortization of intangible assets
    2,289       1,666       1,626  
Other expenses
    3,435       2,705       3,166  
Total noninterest expense
    58,464       42,805       46,856  
Income (loss) before provision for income taxes
    40,293       2,350       (8,414 )
Provision (benefit) for income taxes
    16,910       940       (3,753 )
Net income (loss)
  $ 23,383     $ 1,410     $ (4,661 )
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders
  $ 20,828     $ 160     $ (5,793 )
Earnings (loss) per common share:
                       
Basic
  $ 0.73     $ 0.01     $ (0.50 )
Diluted
  $ 0.71     $ 0.01     $ (0.50 )
 
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 
64

 
 
FIRST CALIFORNIA FINANCIAL GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

   
For the Year Ended
 
   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Comprehensive income (loss)
                 
Unrealized gain on securities available-for-sale
  $ 3,674     $ 4,671     $ 8,998  
                         
Unrealized gain/(loss) on interest rate caps
    (522 )     81       12  
                         
Reclassification adjustment for impairments realized in net income
    1,387       749       1,507  
                         
Reclassification adjustments for gains included in net income
    (1,022 )     (2,014 )     (6,469 )
                         
Other comprehensive income, before taxes
    3,517       3,487       4,048  
Income tax expense related to items of other comprehensive income
    (1,455 )     (1,278 )     (973 )
                         
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
    2,062       2,209       3,075  
                         
Net income (loss)
    23,383       1,410       (4,661 )
Total comprehensive income (loss)
  $ 25,445     $ 3,619     $ (1,586 )

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 
65

 
 
FIRST CALIFORNIA FINANCIAL GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity

                                                                            
Accumulated
       
   
Preferred Stock
   
Preferred Stock
   
Preferred Stock
   
Common Stock,
   
Additional
                     
Other
       
   
Series A
   
Series B
   
Series C
   
$.01 par value
   
Paid in
   
Treasury Stock
   
Retained
   
Comprehensive
       
   
Shares
   
Amount
   
Shares
   
Amount
   
Shares
   
Amount
   
Shares
   
Amount
   
Capital
   
Shares
   
Amount
   
Earnings
   
(Loss)
   
Total
 
   
(in thousands, except share data)
 
Balance at December 31, 2008
    1,000     $ 1,000       25,000     $ 22,713           $       11,462,964     $ 118     $ 135,603       344,660     $ (3,050 )   $ 11,559     $ (9,020 )   $ 158,923  
Stock options exercised
    —        —        —        —         —        —       3,125        —       14        —        —        —        —       14  
Issuance of restricted stock
    —        —        —        —         —        —       169,075        —        —        —        —        —        —        
Forfeiture of restricted stock
    —        —        —        —         —        —       (10,530 )      —        —        —        —        —        —        
Dividends on preferred stock Series B
    —        —        —        —         —        —                —        —        —        —       (1,132 )      —       (1,132 )
Amortization of preferred stock Series B discount
    —        —        —        457        —        —                —        —        —        —       (457 )      —        
Stock-based compensation cost
    —        —        —        —         —        —                —       1,018        —        —        —        —       1,018  
Forfeiture of restricted stock in lieu of taxes
    —        —        —        —         —        —       (1,741 )      —        —       1,741       (11 )      —        —       (11 )
Comprehensive income:
                                                                                                               
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
    —        —        —        —         —        —                —        —        —        —        —       3,075       3,075  
Net(loss)
    —        —        —        —         —        —                —        —        —        —       (4,661 )             (4,661 )
Balance at December 31, 2009
    1,000     $ 1,000       25,000     $ 23,170           $       11,622,893     $ 118     $ 136,635       346,401     $ (3,061 )   $ 5,309     $ (5,945 )   $ 157,226  
Issuance of common stock
     —        —        —        —        —        —       16,560,000       166       37,925        —        —        —        —       38,091  
Forfeiture of restricted stock
     —        —        —        —        —        —       (12,133 )     (2 )      —        —        —       2        —        
Dividends on preferred stock Series B
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       (1,250 )      —       (1,250 )
Amortization of preferred stock Series B discount
     —        —        —       457        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       (457 )      —        
Stock-based compensation cost
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       542        —        —        —        —       542  
Adjustment for derivatives
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       (187 )     187        
Comprehensive income:
                                                                                                             —  
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       2,022       2,022  
Net income
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       1,410        —       1,410  
Balance at December 31, 2010
    1,000     $ 1,000       25,000     $ 23,627           $       28,170,760     $ 282     $ 175,102       346,401     $ (3,061 )   $ 4,827     $ (3,736 )   $ 198,041  
Issuance of restricted stock
     —        —        —        —        —        —       1,100,564       10       (3,071 )     (346,401 )     3,061        —        —        
Forfeiture of restricted stock
     —        —        —        —        —        —       (51,245 )      —        —        —        —        —        —        
Issuance of preferred stock
     —        —        —        —       25,000       25,000        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       25,000  
Redemption of preferred stock
     —        —       (25,000 )     (25,000 )      —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       (25,000 )
Repurchase of warrant
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       (599 )      —        —        —        —       (599 )
Dividends on preferred stock Series B
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       (831 )      —       (831 )
Dividends on preferred stock Series C
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       (579 )      —       (579 )
Amortization of preferred stock Series B discount
     —        —        —       1,373        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       (1,373 )      —        
Stock-based compensation cost
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       1,630        —        —        —        —       1,630  
Comprehensive income:
                                                                                                               
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       2,062       2,062  
Net income
     —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —        —       23,383        —       23,383  
Balance at December 31, 2011
    1,000     $ 1,000           $       25,000     $ 25,000       29,220,079     $ 292     $ 173,062           $     $ 25,427     $ (1,674 )   $ 223,107  
 
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 
66

 
 
FIRST CALIFORNIA FINANCIAL GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

   
For the Year Ended
 
   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Net income (loss)
  $ 23,383     $ 1,410     $ (4,661 )
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash (used in) provided by operating activities:
                       
Provision for loan losses
    5,346       8,337       16,646  
Stock-based compensation costs
    1,630       542       1,018  
Gain on sales of securities
    (1,022 )     (2,014 )     (6,469 )
Gain on acquisitions
    (36,922 )     (2,312 )      
Loss on sale and valuation adjustments of foreclosed property
    3,634       1,380       1,205  
Market value loss on loans held-for-sale
                709  
Impairment loss on securities
    1,387       749       1,507  
Amortization of net premiums on securities available-for-sale
    3,878       3,711       1,313  
Depreciation and amortization of premises and equipment
    2,045       1,927       1,822  
Amortization of intangible assets
    2,289       1,666       1,626  
Change in FDIC shared-loss asset
    (3,116 )            
(Gain) loss on disposal of premises and equipment
    (133 )     49       78  
Proceeds from sale of, and payments received from, loans held-for-sale
                181  
Increase in cash surrender value of life insurance
    (438 )     (441 )     (437 )
Decrease in deferred tax assets, net of effects from acquisitions
    4,563       975       (5,171 )
(Increase) decrease in accrued interest receivable and other assets, net of effects from acquisitions
    (2,015 )     1,367       (3,746 )
(Decrease) increase in accrued interest payable and other liabilities, net of effects from acquisitions
    (7,449 )     59       (599 )
Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities
    (2,940 )     17,405       5,022  
Purchases of securities available-for-sale, net of effects from acquisitions
    (330,796 )     (308,107 )     (363,486 )
Proceeds from repayments and maturities of securities available-for-sale
    150,661       149,941       63,590  
Proceeds from sales of securities available-for-sale
    38,958       237,965       250,613  
Proceeds from redemption of Federal Home Loan Bank and other stock
    1,989       954        
Purchases of Federal Home Loan Bank and other stock
    (5 )     (49 )     (119 )
Net change in interest bearing deposits with other banks, net of effects from acquisitions
    103,376       (19,398 )     128,768  
Loan originations and principal collections, net of effects from acquisitions
    50,756       (40,915 )     (34,226 )
Purchases of premises and equipment, net of effects from acquisitions
    (2,145 )     (1,424 )     (1,097 )
Proceeds from sale of premises and equipment
    1,269              
Proceeds from FDIC shared-loss asset
    22,051              
Proceeds from sale of non-covered foreclosed property
    3,019       2,237       1,041  
Proceeds from sale of covered foreclosed property
    21,607       763        
Net cash acquired (paid) in acquisitions
    122,119       8,194       (48,790 )
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
    182,859       30,161       (3,706 )
Net increase (decrease) in noninterest-bearing deposits, net of effects from acquisitions
    49,257       (9,389 )     34,352  
Net decrease in interest-bearing deposits, net of effects from acquisitions
    (137,443 )     (64,340 )     1,954  
Net decrease in FHLB advances and other borrowings, net of effects from acquisitions
    (75,322 )     (11,948 )     (23,448 )
Dividends paid on preferred stock
    (1,097 )     (1,250 )     (1,132 )
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
                14  
Purchases of treasury stock
                (11 )
Redemption of preferred stock series B
    (25,000 )            —  
Issuance of preferred stock series C
    25,000              —  
Repurchase of warrant
    (599 )            —  
Issuance of common stock
          38,091        
Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities
    (165,204 )     (48,836 )     11,729  
Change in cash and due from banks
    14,715       (1,270 )     13,045  
Cash and due from banks, beginning of period
    25,487       26,757       13,712  
Cash and due from banks, end of period
  $ 40,202     $ 25,487     $ 26,757  
                         
Supplemental cash flow information:
                       
Cash paid for interest
  $ 13,236     $ 14,434     $ 19,728  
Cash paid for income taxes
  $ 8,200     $ 1,000     $ 950  
Supplemental disclosure of noncash items:
                       
Net change in fair value of securities available-for-sale, net of tax
  $ 2,343     $ 2,162     $ 3,068  
Net change in fair value of cash flow hedges, net of tax
  $ (278 )   $ 47     $ 7  
Non-covered loans transferred to foreclosed property
  $ 3,356     $ 25,660     $ 6,891  
Covered loans transferred to foreclosed property
  $ 22,587     $     $  
    Dividend declared   $ 312     $     $  
Acquisitions:
                       
Assets acquired
  $ 458,642     $ 108,628     $ 320,002  
Liabilities acquired
  $ 437,220     $ 107,241     $ 271,212  
 
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 
67

 
 
FIRST CALIFORNIA FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

NOTE 1—ORGANIZATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Organization and nature of operations—First California Financial Group, Inc., or First California or the Company, was incorporated under the laws of the State of Delaware on June 7, 2006. The Company was formed as a wholly-owned subsidiary of National Mercantile Bancorp, a California corporation, or National Mercantile, for the purposes of effecting the merger and capital stock exchange with National Mercantile and acquisition of FCB Bancorp, a California corporation, or FCB, which was completed in March 2007.

On January 23, 2009, the Bank assumed the insured, non-brokered deposits of 1st Centennial Bank, totaling approximately $270 million, from the FDIC. Under the terms of the purchase and assumption agreement between the Bank and the FDIC, the Bank also purchased certain assets from the FDIC at the close of the transaction. The Bank paid cash consideration of $48.8 million to the FDIC for the assets acquired and liabilities assumed. The Bank continues to operate the former 1st Centennial Bank’s six branch locations as part of the Bank’s branch network.

On November 5, 2010, the Bank assumed certain liabilities and acquired certain assets and substantially all of the operations of Western Commercial Bank, or WCB, located in Woodland Hills, California, from the FDIC. The Bank acquired, received and recognized certain assets with an estimated fair value of approximately $109 million, including $55 million of loans, $32 million of cash, $16.7 million of a FDIC shared-loss asset, $2 million of securities and $3 million of other assets. Liabilities with an estimated fair value of approximately $107 million were also assumed and recognized, including $105 million of deposits and $2 million of other liabilities. The Bank recorded a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $2.3 million in connection with this transaction. The transaction increased the number of the Bank’s full-service branch locations to 18 and the Bank fully integrated the former WCB branch into its full-service branch network prior to December 31, 2010.

On February 18, 2011, the Bank assumed certain liabilities and acquired certain assets and substantially all of the operations of San Luis Trust Bank, or SLTB, located in San Luis Obispo, California, from the FDIC. The Bank acquired, received and recognized certain assets with an estimated fair value of approximately $367 million, including $139 million of loans, $99 million of cash and federal funds sold, $70 million of a FDIC shared-loss asset, $41 million of securities, $13 million of foreclosed property and $5 million of other assets. Liabilities with an estimated fair value of approximately $346 million were also assumed and recognized, including $266 million of deposits, $62 million of Federal Home Loan Bank advances, $15 million in a deferred tax liability, $3 million of a FDIC shared-loss liability and $0.4 million of other liabilities. The Bank recorded a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $36.5 million in connection with this transaction. This transaction increased the number of the Bank’s full-service branch locations to 19 and the Bank fully integrated the former SLTB branch into its full-service branch network in June 2011.

On April 8, 2011, the Bank completed the acquisition of the Electronic Banking Solutions division of Palm Desert National Bank. The transaction included the division’s customer base, core deposits, and employees. The Electronic Payment Services Division, or the EPS division, its new name under the Bank, issues prepaid cards and sponsors merchant acquiring services for all national and regional networks, including Visa, MasterCard, and Discover throughout all 50 states and U.S. territories. The Bank acquired cash of $85.4 million, recognized intangible assets of $6.0 million, assumed $91 million of deposits and recognized a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $0.5 million in connection with this transaction.

The Company serves the comprehensive banking needs of businesses and consumers in Los Angeles, Orange, Ventura, San Diego, Riverside, San Luis Obispo and San Bernardino counties through 19 full-service branch locations.

Basis of presentation and consolidation—The accompanying consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and general practices within the banking industry. The consolidated financial statements include, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles, the accounts of the Company, the Bank, Wendy Road Office Development, LLC, a subsidiary of the Bank which manages and disposes of real estate, and SC Financial, an inactive subsidiary of First California. The Company has not consolidated the accounts of the First California Capital Trust I and FCB Statutory Trust I in its consolidated financial statements. As a result, the junior subordinated debentures issued by the Company to the Trusts are reflected on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet as junior subordinated debentures. Results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2011 include the effects of the FDIC-assisted San Luis Trust Bank and the Electronic Payment Services division transactions from the date of the acquisition. All material intercompany transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. In preparing these financial statements, the Company has evaluated events and transactions subsequent to December 31, 2011 for potential recognition or disclosure.

Reclassifications—Certain reclassifications have been made to the 2010 and 2009 consolidated financial statements to conform to current year presentation. These reclassifications have no impact on previously reported earnings (loss) or retained earnings.

 
68

 
 
Management’s estimates and assumptions—The preparation of the consolidated financial statements, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles, requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities as of the date of the balance sheets, and revenues and expenses for the reporting periods. Actual results could differ significantly from those estimates. Significant estimations made by us primarily involve the calculation of the allowance for loan losses, the carrying amount of deferred tax assets, the carrying amount of covered loans, the carrying amount of foreclosed property, the carrying amount of the FDIC shared-loss asset and liability, the assessments for impairment related to goodwill and securities, the estimated fair value of financial instruments and the effectiveness of derivative instruments in offsetting changes in fair value or cash flows of hedged items.

Cash and due from banks—Cash and due from banks include amounts the Company is required to maintain to meet certain average reserve and compensating balance requirements of the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company had met all reserve requirements. At December 31, 2011, the Company had an insignificant amount of cash deposits at other financial institutions in excess of FDIC insured limits.

Securities— Securities are classified as available-for-sale if the instrument may be sold in response to such factors as (1) changes in market interest rates and related changes in the prepayment risk, (2) need for liquidity, (3) changes in the availability of and the yield on alternative instruments, and (4) changes in funding sources and terms. Unrealized holding gains and losses, net of taxes, on securities available-for-sale are reported as other comprehensive income and carried as accumulated comprehensive income or loss within shareholders’ equity until realized. Fair values for securities are based on quoted market prices. Realized gains and losses on the sale of securities available-for-sale are determined using the specific-identification method.

Premiums and discounts on available-for-sale securities are recognized in interest income using the effective interest method over the period to maturity.

The fair values of investment securities are evaluated according to FASB accounting standards codification guidance. Declines in the fair value of individual securities available-for-sale below their cost that are other-than-temporary result in write-downs of the individual securities to their fair value. The portion of the write-down related to credit is included in earnings as realized losses. The portion of the write-down related to other factors is included in other comprehensive income in stockholders’ equity. At each financial statement date, management assesses each investment to determine if investments are temporarily impaired or if the impairment is other-than- temporary based upon the positive and negative evidence available. Evidence evaluated includes, but is not limited to, industry analyst reports, credit market conditions, and interest rate trends.

Non-covered loans, net of allowance for loan losses and net deferred loan fees/costs—Non-covered loans are stated at the amount of unpaid principal, reduced by an allowance for loan losses and net deferred loan fees/costs. Interest on non-covered loans is calculated by the simple-interest method on daily balances of the principal amount outstanding. Loan origination fees net of certain direct origination costs are capitalized and recognized as an adjustment of the yield over the life of the related non-covered loan.

The Company does not accrue interest on non-covered loans for which payment in full of principal and interest is doubtful, or which payment of principal or interest has been in default 90 days or more, unless the loan is well-secured and in the process of collection. Nonaccrual non-covered loans are considered impaired loans. Impaired loans are carried at the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, the loan’s market price, or the fair value of collateral if the loan is collateral dependent. When it is doubtful the full principal and interest due on a non-covered loan will be collected, interest accrual is discontinued. Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent cash payments are received or when the non-covered loan is removed from nonaccrual status. Large groups of smaller balance, homogeneous non-covered loans are collectively evaluated for impairment. Accordingly, the Company does not separately identify individual consumer and residential non-covered loans for evaluation of impairment.

The allowance for loan losses is established through a provision charged to expense. Loans are charged against the allowance when management believes that the collectability of principal is unlikely. The allowance is an amount that management believes will be adequate to absorb estimated probable losses on existing loans that may become uncollectable, based on evaluations of the collectability of loans and prior loan loss experience. The evaluation includes an assessment of the following factors: any external loan review and any regulatory examination, estimated probable loss exposure on each pool of loans, concentrations of credit, value of collateral, the level of delinquent and nonaccrual loans, trends in the portfolio volume, effects of any changes in the lending policies and procedures, changes in lending personnel, present economic conditions at the local, state and national levels, the amount of undisbursed off-balance sheet commitments, and a migration analysis of historical losses and recoveries for the prior twenty-one quarters. Individual loans are also evaluated for impairment and if a portion of a loan is impaired, the impaired amount is charged-off or a specific reserve is allocated for that loan. Various regulatory agencies, as a regular part of their examination process, periodically review the Company’s allowance for loan losses. Such agencies may require the Company to recognize additions to the allowance based on their judgment of information available to them at the time of their examinations.

 
69

 
 
Non-covered loans are reported as restructured when the Bank grants a concession(s) to a borrower experiencing financial difficulties that it would not otherwise consider. Examples of such concessions include forgiveness of principal or accrued interest, extending the maturity date or providing a lower interest rate than would be normally available for a transaction of similar risk. As a result of these concessions, restructured non-covered loans are impaired as the Bank will not collect all amounts due, both principal and interest, in accordance with the terms of the original loan agreement. Impairment reserves on non-collateral dependent restructured non-covered loans are measured by comparing the present value of expected future cash flows on the restructured loans discounted at the interest rate of the original loan agreement to the loan’s carrying value. These impairment reserves are recognized as a specific component to be provided for in the allowance for non-covered loan and lease losses.

Covered loansLoans acquired in a FDIC-assisted acquisition that are subject to a shared-loss agreement are referred to as “covered loans” and reported separately in our consolidated balance sheets. Covered loans are reported exclusive of the expected cash flow reimbursements expected from the FDIC. Acquired loans are aggregated into pools based on individually evaluated common risk characteristics and aggregate expected cash flows are estimated for each pool. A pool is accounted for as a single asset with a single interest rate, cumulative loss rate and cash flow expectation. The Bank aggregated all of the loans acquired in the FDIC-assisted acquisitions into different pools based on common risk characteristics such as accrual status, underlying collateral, type of interest rate (fixed or variable), types of amortization and other similar factors. A loan will be removed from a pool of loans only if the loan is sold, foreclosed, or assets are received in full satisfaction of the loan, and will be removed from the pool at its carrying value. If an individual loan is removed from a pool of loans, the difference between its relative carrying amount and its cash, fair value of the collateral, or other assets received will be recognized prospectively in the effective yield used to recognize the accretable yield on the remaining pool.

The cash flows expected to be received over the life of the pool were estimated by management with the assistance of a third party valuation specialist. These cash flows were input into a FASB ASC 310-30, Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with Deteriorated Credit Quality, or ASC 310-30, compliant loan accounting system which calculates the carrying value of the pools and underlying loans, book yields, effective interest income and impairment, if any, based on actual and projected events. Default rates, loss severity, and prepayment speeds assumptions are periodically reassessed and updated within the accounting system to update our expectation of future cash flows. The excess of the cash flows expected to be collected over a pool’s carrying value is considered to be the accretable yield and is recognized as interest income over the estimated life of the loan or pool using the effective yield method. The accretable yield may change due to changes in the timing and amounts of expected cash flows.

The excess of the undiscounted contractual balances due over the cash flows expected to be collected is considered to be the nonaccretable difference. The nonaccretable difference represents our estimate of the credit losses expected to occur and was considered in determining the fair value of the loans as of the acquisition date. Subsequent to the acquisition date, any increases in expected cash flows over those expected at acquisition date in excess of fair value are adjusted through an increase to the accretable yield on a prospective basis. Any subsequent decreases in expected cash flows attributable to credit deterioration are recognized by recording a provision for covered loan losses.

Premises and equipment—Premises and equipment are stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is computed by the straight-line and accelerated methods over the estimated useful lives of the assets, which range from 3 to 7 years for furniture and equipment, and 10 to 39 years for building premises. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the estimated life of the lease or life of the asset, whichever is shorter. Maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred, while major additions and improvements are capitalized. Gains and losses on dispositions are included in current operations.

Goodwill and other intangible assets—The Company has goodwill, which represents the excess of purchase price over the fair value of net assets acquired in business combinations. In accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, goodwill is not amortized and is reviewed for impairment on an annual basis or on an interim basis if an event occurs or circumstances change that would reduce the fair value of the acquired business below its carrying value. Other intangible assets consist of tradename, core deposit intangibles and contracts and customer relationship intangible. Tradename, which represents the fair value of the First California Bank name, is amortized using the straight-line method over a period of ten years. Core deposit intangibles, which represent the fair value of depositor relationships resulting from deposit liabilities assumed in acquisitions, are amortized using the straight-line method over the projected useful lives of the deposits. The contract and customer relationship intangible, which represents the fair value of the customer relationships and contracts, is amortized using the straight-line method over a period of ten years. Core deposit, contracts and customer relationship and trade name intangibles are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable. Impairment of goodwill and other intangibles is permanently recognized by writing down the asset to the extent that the carrying value exceeds the estimated fair value.

FDIC shared-loss asset— In conjunction with the FDIC-assisted Western Commercial Bank and San Luis Trust Bank transactions, the Bank entered into shared-loss agreements with the FDIC related to covered loans and covered foreclosed property. The FDIC shared-loss asset is initially recorded at fair value, based on the discounted value of expected future cash flows under the shared-loss agreements. The difference between the present value and the undiscounted cash flows the Company expects to collect from the FDIC is accreted into non-interest income over the life of the FDIC shared-loss asset. The FDIC shared-loss asset is reviewed quarterly and adjusted for any changes in expected cash flows based on recent performance and expectations for future performance of the covered portfolio. These adjustments are measured on the same basis as the related covered loans, at a pool level, and covered foreclosed property. Generally, any increases in cash flow of the covered assets over those previously expected will result in prospective increases in the loan pool yield and amortization of the FDIC shared-loss asset. Generally, any decreases in cash flow of the covered assets under those previously expected will trigger impairments on the underlying loan pools and will result in a corresponding gain on the FDIC shared-loss asset. Increases and decreases to the FDIC shared-loss asset are recorded as adjustments to other non-interest income.

 
70

 
 
Non-covered foreclosed property— The Company acquires, through foreclosure or through full or partial satisfaction of a non-covered loan, real or personal property. At the time of foreclosure, the Company obtains an appraisal of the property and records the property at its estimated fair value less costs to sell. We charge the allowance for loan losses for the loan amount in excess of the fair value of the non-covered foreclosed property received; we credit earnings for the fair value amount of the non-covered foreclosed property in excess of the non-covered loan due. Subsequent to foreclosure, the Company periodically assesses our disposition efforts and the estimated fair value less costs to sell of the non-covered foreclosed property. The Company establishes a valuation allowance through a charge to earnings for estimated declines in fair value subsequent to foreclosure. Operating income and operating expense related to non-covered foreclosed property is included in earnings as are any ultimate gains or losses on the sale of the non-covered foreclosed property. Our recognition of gain is, however, dependent on the buyer’s initial investment in the purchase of the non-covered foreclosed property meeting certain criteria.

    Covered foreclosed propertyAll foreclosed property acquired in FDIC-assisted acquisitions that are subject to a FDIC shared-loss agreement are referred to as “covered foreclosed property” and reported separately in our consolidated balance sheets. Covered foreclosed property is reported exclusive of expected reimbursement cash flows from the FDIC. Foreclosed covered loan collateral is transferred into covered foreclosed property at the collateral’s net realizable value, less estimated selling costs.

    Covered foreclosed property was initially recorded at its estimated fair value on the acquisition date based on similar market comparable valuations less estimated selling costs. Any subsequent valuation adjustments due to declines in fair value will be charged to non-interest expense, and will be mostly offset by non-interest income representing the corresponding increase to the FDIC shared-loss asset for the offsetting loss reimbursement amount. Any recoveries of previous valuation adjustments will be credited to non-interest expense with a corresponding charge to non-interest income for the portion of the recovery that is due to the FDIC.

Securities sold under repurchase agreements—The Company sells securities under repurchase agreements. These transactions are accounted for as collateralized financing transactions and recorded at the amounts at which the securities were sold. The Company has provided collateral related to these agreements and may have to provide additional collateral to the counterparty, as necessary, if the fair value of the collateral fluctuates below required levels.

Federal Home Loan Bank stock and other non-marketable securities—Federal Home Loan Bank stock represents the Company’s investment in the Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco, or the FHLB, stock and is carried at cost because it can only be redeemed at par value. The Company’s investment in FHLB stock was $10.0 million and $7.9 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, and is included in accrued interest receivable and other assets in the consolidated balance sheets. As a member of the FHLB system, the Company is required to maintain a minimum level of investment in FHLB stock based on specific percentages of its outstanding mortgages, total assets or FHLB advances. The Company may request redemption at par value of any stock in excess of the minimum required investment. Stock redemptions are at the discretion of the FHLB. The Company also has stock investments in other companies for CRA and other bank-related purposes. These stock investments were $1.5 million and $1.6 million at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, and are carried at cost which reasonably approximates its fair value. The Company reviews its investments accounted for under the cost method at least quarterly for possible impairment. This review typically includes an analysis of facts and circumstances of each investment, the expectations of the investment’s future cash flows and capital needs, and trends in the investment’s business and cash flows. The Company would reduce the investment value when the declines in value are considered to be permanent. The Company would recognize the estimated loss as an impairment loss on investment securities, a component of non-interest income. The Company recognized an impairment loss of $41,000 on one of these CRA-related cost basis investments in 2010.

Junior subordinated debentures—The Company has two statutory business trusts that are wholly-owned subsidiaries of the Company. In private placement transactions, the trusts issued fixed rate capital securities representing undivided preferred beneficial interests in the assets of the trusts. The Company is the owner of all the beneficial interests represented by the common securities of the trusts. The purpose of issuing the capital securities was to provide the Company with a cost-effective means of obtaining Tier I capital under regulatory capital rules.

Income taxes—Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are determined based on the tax effects of the differences between the book and tax basis of the various balance sheet assets and liabilities. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are reflected at currently enacted income tax rates applicable to the period in which the deferred tax assets or liabilities are expected to be realized or settled. As changes in tax laws or rates are enacted, deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted through the provision for income taxes. Deferred tax assets are recognized subject to management’s judgment that realization of such assets are more-likely-than-not. A valuation allowance is established when the Company determines that the realization of income tax benefits may not occur in future years. There was no valuation allowance at December 31, 2011 or December 31, 2010.

 
71

 
 
Accounting standards codification guidance clarifies the accounting for income taxes by prescribing a minimum recognition threshold is required for a tax position to meet before being recognized in the financial statements. The Company had no unrecognized tax benefits or uncertain tax positions at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010. The Company recognizes interest accrued and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits in income tax expense. During the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company recognized no interest or penalties in income tax expense. The Company files income tax returns in the U.S. federal jurisdiction and in California and is no longer subject to U.S. federal and California income tax examinations by tax authorities for years before 2008 and 2007, respectively.

Derivative instruments and hedging—For derivative instruments designated in cash flow hedging relationships, we assess the effectiveness of the instruments in offsetting changes in the overall cash flows of designated hedged transactions on a quarterly basis. The Company recognizes the unrealized gains or losses of derivative instruments directly in current period earnings to the extent these instruments are not effective. At December 31, 2011, the Company had $37.1 million notional interest rate caps to limit the variable interest rate payments on our $26.8 million junior subordinated debentures. Our 2011 fourth quarter effectiveness assessment indicated that these instruments were effective. At December 31, 2011, the Bank also had $120 million notional interest rate caps that do not meet the criteria for hedge accounting to manage the interest rate risk associated with our fixed rate securities and loans. The Company may enter into derivative contracts that are intended to economically hedge certain of its risks, even though hedge accounting does not apply or the Company elects not to apply hedge accounting. Derivatives not designated as hedges are marked-to-market each period through earnings.

Off-balance sheet financial instruments—In the ordinary course of business, the Company enters into off-balance sheet financial instruments consisting of commitments to extend credit, commitments under credit card arrangements, commercial letters of credit, and standby letters of credit. These financial instruments are recorded in the financial statements when they are funded or related fees are incurred or received. The Company maintains a reserve for off-balance sheet items, included as an accrued liability. The reserve is an amount that management believes will be adequate to absorb possible losses associated with off-balance sheet credit risk. The evaluations take into consideration such factors as changes in the nature and volume of the commitments to extend credit and undisbursed balances of existing lines of credit and letters of credit.

Stock-based compensation—Stock-based compensation generally includes grants of stock options and restricted stock to employees and nonemployee directors. We account for stock-based payments, including stock options, in accordance with accounting standards guidance related to share-based compensation, and recognize them in the statement of operations based on their fair values. The fair value of stock options are being measured using a lattice option pricing model while the fair value of restricted stock awards are based on the quoted price of the Company’s common stock on the date of grant.

Advertising—Advertising costs are charged to expense during the year in which they are incurred. Advertising expenses were $273,000, $48,000 and $261,000 for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Earnings (loss) per share—Basic earnings (loss) per common share is computed by dividing net income (loss) available to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding (excluding unvested restricted stock) during the period, after giving retroactive effect to stock dividends and splits. Diluted earnings (loss) per common share is calculated in a manner similar to basic earnings per share, but adjusted by assuming conversion of all potentially dilutive common stock equivalents, which include stock options and restricted shares using the treasury stock method. Diluted earnings (loss) per common share exclude common stock equivalents whose effect is antidilutive. Earnings (loss) available to common shareholders represent reported earnings (loss) less preferred stock dividends, if any.

Business combinations—Business combinations are accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting in accordance with ASC 805, Business Combinations. Under the acquisition method the acquiring entity in a business combination recognizes 100 percent of the acquired assets and assumed liabilities, regardless of the percentage owned, at their estimated fair values as of the date of acquisition. Any excess of the purchase price over the fair value of net assets and other identifiable intangible assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. To the extent the fair value of net assets acquired, including other identifiable assets, exceed the purchase price, a bargain purchase gain is recognized. Assets acquired and liabilities assumed from contingencies must also be recognized at fair value, if the fair value can be determined during the measurement period. Results of operations of an acquired business are included in the statement of operations from the date of acquisition. Acquisition-related costs, including conversion and restructuring charges, are expensed as incurred.

Fair value of financial instruments—FASB ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosure, or ASC 820, defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. ASC 820 establishes a three-level hierarchy for disclosure of assets and liabilities recorded at fair value. The classification of assets and liabilities within the hierarchy is based on whether the inputs to the valuation methodology used for measurement are observable or unobservable. Observable inputs reflect market-derived or market-based information obtained from independent sources, while unobservable inputs reflect our estimates about market data. In general, fair values determined by Level 1 inputs utilize quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities traded in active markets that the Company has the ability to access. Fair values determined by Level 2 inputs utilize inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. Level 2 inputs include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets, and inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability, such as interest rates and yield curves that are observable at commonly quoted intervals. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or liability, and include situations where there is little, if any, market activity for the asset or liability. In certain cases, the inputs used to measure fair value may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy. In such cases, the level in the fair value hierarchy within which the fair value measurement in its entirety falls has been determined based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement in its entirety. The Company’s assessment of the significance of a particular input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires judgment, and considers factors specific to the asset or liability.

 
72

 
 
NOTE 2—RECENTLY ISSUED AND ADOPTED ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

In December 2010, the FASB issued ASU No. 2010-29, Business Combinations (Topic 805): Disclosure of Supplementary Pro Forma Information for Business Combinations. This update clarifies that if comparative financial statements are presented in disclosure of supplementary pro forma information for a business combination, revenue and earnings of the combined entity should be disclosed as though the business combination occurred as of the beginning of the comparable annual prior annual reporting period only. Additionally, supplemental pro forma disclosures should include a description of the nature and amount of material, nonrecurring pro forma adjustments included in the reported pro forma revenue and earnings. This update is effective prospectively for business combinations for which the acquisition date is on or after the beginning of the first annual reporting period beginning on or after December 15, 2010. The adoption of the ASU did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In April 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-02, A Creditor’s Determination of Whether a Restructuring is a Troubled Debt Restructuring. This update provides additional guidance relating to when creditors should classify loan modifications as troubled debt restructurings. The ASU also ends the deferral issued in January 2011 of the disclosures about troubled debt restructurings required by ASU No. 2010-20. The Company adopted the provisions of ASU No. 2011-02 and the disclosure requirements of ASU No. 2010-20 in the interim reporting period ending September 30, 2011, and applied its provisions retrospectively to any restructurings that occurred. The adoption of this ASU did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements although additional disclosures regarding troubled debt restructurings have been included in the notes to the consolidated financial statements.

In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-04, Fair Value Measurements (Topic 820): Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRSs. ASU 2011-04 was issued concurrently with IFRS 13, Fair Value Measurements, to provide mainly identical guidance about fair value measurement and disclosure requirements. For U.S. GAAP, most of the changes are clarifications of existing guidance or wording changes to align with IFRS 13. ASU 2011-04 is effective during interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. Early adoption is not permitted. The Company does not expect the adoption of this ASU to have a material effect on its consolidated financial statements.

In June 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-05, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220): Presentation of Comprehensive Income. ASU 2011-05 will require companies to present the components of net income and other comprehensive income either as one continuous statement or as two consecutive statements. This standard eliminates the option to present components of comprehensive income as part of the statement of changes in stockholders’ equity. This standard does not change the items which must be reported in other comprehensive income, how such items are measured, or when they must be reclassified to net income. This standard is effective for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. Early adoption is permitted. Adoption of ASU 2011-05 is not expected to have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In September 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-08, Intangibles – Goodwill and Other – Testing Goodwill for Impairment. ASU 2011-08 provides guidance on the application of a qualitative assessment of impairment indicators in the review of goodwill impairment. The ASU provides that in the event that the qualitative review indicates that it is more likely than not that no impairment has occurred, the Company would not be required to perform a quantitative review. The provisions of ASU 2011-08 will be effective for years beginning after December 15, 2011 for both public and nonpublic entities, although earlier adoption is allowed. The Company does not expect that adoption of this standard will have a significant impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In December 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-11, Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities. ASU 2011-11 provides convergence to International Financial Reporting Standards, or IFRS, to provide common disclosure requirements for the offsetting of financial instruments. Existing GAAP guidance allowing balance sheet offsetting, including industry-specific guidance, remains unchanged. The new guidance is effective on a retrospective basis, including all prior periods presented, for interim and annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2013. The Company does not expect that adoption of this standard will have a significant impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In December 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-12, Deferral of the Effective Date for Amendments to the Presentation of Reclassifications of Items Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income in Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-05. ASU 2011-12 defers the requirements of ASU 2011-05 to display reclassification adjustments for each component of other comprehensive income in both net income and other comprehensive income and to present the components of other comprehensive income in interim financial statements. During 2012, the FASB will reconsider the reclassification requirements and the timing of their implementation. Management is currently evaluating the impact both of these ASU’s will have on the disclosures in the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 
73

 
 
NOTE 3—ACQUISITIONS

On April 8, 2011, or the EPS Transaction Date, the Bank completed the acquisition of the Electronic Banking Solutions division of Palm Desert National Bank. The transaction included the division’s customer base, core deposits, and employees. The Bank paid cash consideration of $5.5 million to purchase the EPS division. The Bank acquired cash of $85.4 million, recognized intangible assets of $6.0 million, assumed $91 million of deposits and recognized a pre-tax bargain purchase gain of $0.5 million in connection with this transaction. The Bank desired this transaction to expand its product and service offerings and diversify its sources of revenue.

Under the acquisition method of accounting, the Bank recorded the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on their estimated fair values as of the EPS Transaction Date. Results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2011 include the effects of the EPS acquisition from the EPS Transaction Date.

The following table summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired, received and recognized and the liabilities assumed and recognized as of the EPS Transaction Date.

   
(Dollars in thousands)
 
Assets Acquired:
 
 
 
Cash
  $ 85,389  
Intangible assets
    6,005  
Other assets
    89  
Total assets acquired
  $ 91,483  
Liabilities Assumed:
       
Deposits
  $ 91,018  
Deferred taxes
    195  
Total liabilities assumed
    91,213  
Net assets acquired (after-tax bargain purchase gain)
    270  
Total liabilities and net assets acquired
  $ 91,483  
 
The Bank based the allocation of the purchase price above on the fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed. The net gain represents the excess of the estimated fair value of the assets acquired over the estimated fair value of the liabilities assumed. The gain was recognized as non-interest income in the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations. Non-interest expense for the second quarter of 2011 included integration and conversion expenses related to the EPS division acquisition of approximately $350,000. The “Salaries and employee benefits”, “Data processing” and “Legal, audit, and other professional services” categories were affected on the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations.

    On February 18, 2011, or the SLTB Transaction Date, the Bank assumed certain liabilities and acquired certain assets and substantially all of the operations of SLTB from the FDIC, acting in its capacity as receiver of SLTB, pursuant to the terms of a purchase and assumption agreement entered into by the Bank and the FDIC, or the Purchase Agreement. The Bank acquired, received, and recognized certain assets with a fair value of approximately $367 million, including $139 million in loans, $99 million of cash and cash equivalents, $41 million of securities and $13 million of foreclosed property related to the transaction. These acquired assets represented approximately 20 percent of consolidated total assets at March 31, 2011. The Bank also assumed approximately $266 million of deposits and $62 million of FHLB advances related to the transaction. The Bank also recorded an FDIC shared-loss asset of $70 million, a core deposit intangible of $0.3 million, deferred tax liabilities of $15 million, a FDIC shared-loss liability of $2.6 million and a premium on time deposits acquired of $0.8 million related to the transaction. The Bank continues to operate the one former SLTB branch location as part of the Bank’s 19 branch locations. The Bank desired this transaction to expand its footprint into the California central coast region.

As part of the Purchase Agreement, the Bank and the FDIC entered into shared-loss agreements, whereby the FDIC will cover a substantial portion of any future losses on loans (and related unfunded loan commitments), foreclosed property and accrued interest on loans for up to 90 days. We refer to the acquired assets subject to the shared-loss agreements collectively as covered assets. Under the terms of the shared-loss agreements, the FDIC will absorb 80 percent of losses and share in 80 percent of loss recoveries. The shared-loss agreements for commercial and residential mortgage loans are in effect for 5 years and 10 years, respectively, from the SLTB Transaction Date and the loss recovery provisions are in effect for 8 years and 10 years, respectively, from the SLTB Transaction Date.

In March 2021, approximately ten years following the SLTB Transaction Date, the Bank is required to perform a calculation and determine if a payment to the FDIC is necessary. The payment amount will be 50 percent of the excess, if any, of (i) 20 percent of the intrinsic loss estimate ($99.0 million) minus (ii) the sum of (a) 20 percent of the net loss amount, plus (b) 25 percent of the asset discount bid ($58.0 million), plus (c) 3.5 percent of total loss share assets at acquisition. At the SLTB Transaction Date, the Bank estimated a liability, on a present value basis, of $2.6 million under this provision.

 
74

 
 
Under the acquisition method of accounting, the Bank recorded the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on their estimated fair values as of the SLTB Transaction Date. Results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2011 include the effects of the SLTB acquisition from the SLTB Transaction Date.

The following table summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired, received and recognized and the liabilities assumed and recognized as of the SLTB Transaction Date.
 
   
(Dollars in thousands)
 
Assets Acquired:
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 98,820  
Securities
    40,972  
Covered loans
    138,792  
Covered foreclosed property
    12,772  
FDIC shared-loss asset
    70,293  
Other assets
    5,510  
Total assets acquired
  $ 367,159  
Liabilities Assumed:
       
Deposits
  $ 266,149  
FHLB advances
    61,541  
FDIC shared-loss liability
    2,564  
Deferred taxes
    15,316  
Other liabilities
    437  
Total liabilities assumed
    346,007  
Net assets acquired (after-tax bargain purchase gain)
    21,152  
Total liabilities and net assets acquired
  $ 367,159  
 
The Bank based the allocation of the purchase price above on the fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed. The net gain represents the excess of the estimated fair value of the assets acquired over the estimated fair value of the liabilities assumed and is influenced significantly by the FDIC-assisted transaction process. Under the FDIC-assisted transaction process, only certain assets and liabilities are transferred to the acquirer and, depending on the nature and amount of the acquirer’s bid, the FDIC may be required to make a cash payment to the acquirer. The Bank received a cash payment from the FDIC for $34.4 million. The book value of net assets transferred to the Bank was $23.6 million (i.e., the cost basis). The pre-tax gain of $36.5 million or the after-tax gain of $21.1 million recognized by the Company is considered a bargain purchase transaction under ASC 805 “Business Combinations” since the total acquisition-date fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired exceeded the fair value of the consideration transferred. The gain was recognized as non-interest income in the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations. Non-interest expense for the first quarter of 2011 included integration and conversion expenses related to the SLTB acquisition of approximately $515,000. The “Salaries and employee benefits”, “Data processing” and “Legal, audit, and other professional services” categories were affected on the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations.

In August 2011, the Bank exercised its option to purchase at fair value approximately $100,000 of furniture, fixtures and equipment related to the one SLTB branch location from the FDIC. The Bank also negotiated and executed a new five-year lease approximating current market rent for the one branch location.

The acquisition of assets and liabilities of SLTB were significant at a level to require disclosure of one year of historical financial information and related pro forma disclosure. However, given the pervasive nature of the shared-loss agreements entered into with the FDIC, the historical information of SLTB are much less relevant for purposes of assessing the future operations of the combined entity. In addition, prior to closure, SLTB had not completed an audit of their financial statements, and the Company determined that audited financial statements would not be reasonably available for the year ended December 31, 2010. Given these considerations, the Company requested, and received, relief from the Securities and Exchange Commission from submitting certain historical and pro forma financial information of SLTB.

On November 5, 2010, or the WCB Acquisition Date, the Bank acquired certain assets and assumed certain liabilities and substantially all of the operations of WCB from the FDIC, acting in its capacity as receiver of WCB, pursuant to the terms of a purchase and assumption agreement entered into by the Bank and the FDIC, or the Purchase Agreement. The Bank acquired, received and recognized certain assets with an estimated fair value of approximately $109 million, including $55 million of loans, $32 million of cash, $16.7 million of a FDIC shared-loss asset, $2 million of securities and $3 million of other assets. Liabilities with an estimated fair value of approximately $107 million were also assumed and recognized, including $105 million of deposits and $2 million of other liabilities. As part of the purchase and assumption agreement, the Bank and the FDIC entered into shared-loss agreements, whereby the FDIC will cover a substantial portion of any future losses on loans (and related unfunded loan commitments), foreclosed property and accrued interest on loans for up to 90 days. Under the terms of the shared-loss agreements, the FDIC will absorb 80 percent of losses and share in 80 percent of loss recoveries. The shared-loss agreements for commercial and residential mortgage loans are in effect for 5 years and 10 years, respectively, from November 5, 2010 and the loss recovery provisions are in effect for 8 years and 10 years, respectively, from November 5, 2010. The Bank operates the one former WCB branch location as part of the Bank’s 19 branch locations. The Bank desired this transaction to increase its penetration and market share in its existing markets.

 
75

 
 
    The Bank received a cash payment from the FDIC for $2.4 million. The book value of assets transferred to the Bank was $111.1 million. The pre-tax gain of $2.3 million or the after-tax gain of $1.4 million recognized by the Company is considered a bargain purchase gain and was recognized as non-interest income in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2010.

NOTE 4 — SECURITIES

Securities have been classified in the consolidated balance sheets according to management’s intent and ability as available-for-sale. The amortized cost, unrealized gains, unrealized losses and estimated fair values of securities available-for-sale at December 31, 2011 and 2010, are summarized as follows:

   
December 31, 2011
 
   
Amortized
Cost
   
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
   
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
   
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
   
(in thousands)
 
U.S. Treasury notes/bills
  $ 45,151     $ 14     $ (4 )   $ 45,161  
U.S. government agency notes
    59,212       257       (23 )     59,446  
U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities
    132,141       1,616       (82 )     133,675  
U.S. government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
    168,158       384       (368 )     168,174  
Private label collateralized mortgage obligations
    15,853             (2,811 )     13,042  
Municipal securities
    28,572       813       (60 )     29,325  
Other domestic debt securities
    7,151             (2,239 )     4,912  
Securities available-for-sale
  $ 456,238     $ 3,084     $ (5,587 )   $ 453,735  
 
   
December 31, 2010
 
   
Amortized
Cost
   
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
   
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
   
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
   
(in thousands)
 
U.S. Treasury notes/bills
  $ 51,118     $ 44     $ (8 )   $ 51,154  
U.S. government agency notes
    59,426       13       (522 )     58,917  
U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities
    47,505       348       (528 )     47,325  
U.S. government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
    90,120       130       (370 )     89,880  
Private label collateralized mortgage obligations
    20,409             (3,515 )     16,894  
Municipal securities
    3,159             (157 )     3,002  
Other domestic debt securities
    7,244             (1,977 )     5,267  
Securities available-for-sale
  $ 278,981     $ 535     $ (7,077 )   $ 272,439  
 
At December 31, 2011, and 2010, there were no trading securities or securities held-to-maturity.

The following table shows the gross unrealized losses and amortized cost of the Company’s securities with unrealized losses aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position at December 31, 2011 and 2010. In the opinion of management, these securities are considered only temporarily impaired due to the fluctuation in market interest rates since purchase and temporary disruption in the credit markets as well as the Company’s intent and ability to hold them until fair values recover.
 
 
76

 
 
   
At December 31, 2011
 
   
Less Than 12 Months
   
Greater Than 12 Months
   
Total
 
   
Amortized
Cost
   
Unrealized
Losses
   
Amortized
Cost
   
Unrealized
Losses
   
Amortized
Cost
   
Unrealized
Losses
 
   
(in thousands)
 
U.S. Treasury notes/bills
  $ 10,029     $ (4 )   $     $     $ 10,029     $ (4 )
U.S. government agency notes
    10,000       (23 )                 10,000       (23 )
U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities
    40,889       (82 )                 40,889       (82 )
U.S. government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
    99,894       (368 )                 99,894       (368 )
Private-label collateralized mortgage obligations
                15,853       (2,811 )     15,853       (2,811 )
Municipal securities
    4,039       (60 )                 4,039       (60 )
Other domestic debt securities
                7,151       (2,239 )     7,151       (2,239 )
 
  $ 164,851     $ (537 )   $ 23,004     $ (5,050 )   $ 187,855     $ (5,587 )

   
At December 31, 2010
 
   
Less Than 12 Months
   
Greater Than 12 Months
   
Total
 
   
Amortized
Cost
   
Unrealized
Losses
   
Amortized
Cost
   
Unrealized
Losses
   
Amortized
Cost
   
Unrealized
Losses
 
   
(in thousands)
 
U.S. Treasury notes/bills
  $ 20,107     $ (8 )   $     $     $ 20,107     $ (8 )
U.S. government agency notes
    41,401       (522 )                 41,401       (522 )
U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities
    33,584       (528 )                 33,584       (528 )
U.S. government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
    57,069       (370 )                 57,069       (370 )
Private-label collateralized mortgage obligations
                20,409       (3,515 )     20,409       (3,515 )
Municipal securities
    3,069       (157 )                 3,069       (157 )
Other domestic debt securities
    2,500       (28 )     4,744       (1,949 )     7,244       (1,977 )
 
  $ 157,730     $ (1,613 )   $ 25,153     $ (5,464 )   $ 182,883     $ (7,077 )
 
At December 31, 2011, there were five securities that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for 12 months or more and forty-two securities that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for less than 12 months. At December 31, 2010, there were five securities that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for 12 months or more and fifty securities that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for less than 12 months.

On a quarterly basis, the Company evaluates its individual available-for-sale securities in an unrealized loss position for OTTI. As part of this evaluation, the Company considers whether it intends to sell each security and whether it is more likely than not that it will be required to sell the security before its anticipated recovery of the amortized cost basis. If either of these conditions is met, the Company recognizes an OTTI charge to earnings equal to the entire difference between the security’s amortized cost basis and its fair value at the balance sheet date. For securities in an unrealized loss position that meet neither of these conditions, the Company considers whether it expects to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the security by comparing its best estimate of the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected from the security with the amortized cost basis of the security. If the Company’s best estimate of the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected is less than the amortized cost basis, the difference is considered the credit loss.

For all the securities in its available-for-sale portfolio, the Company does not intend to sell any security and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell any security before its anticipated recovery of the remaining amortized cost basis.

The Company has determined that, as of December 31, 2011, all of the gross unrealized losses on its U.S. Treasury notes/bills, U.S. government agency notes, U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities, U.S. government collateralized mortgage obligations and municipal securities are temporary because the gross unrealized losses were caused mainly by movements in interest rates and not by the deterioration of the issuers’ creditworthiness; these securities were all with credit agency ratings of at least A+ at December 31, 2011. For its U.S. Treasury notes/bills, U.S. government agency notes, U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities and U.S. government collateralized mortgage obligations the Company expects to recover the entire amortized cost basis of these securities because it determined that the strength of the issuers’ guarantees through direct obligations or support from the U.S. government is sufficient to protect the Company from losses based upon current expectations. As a result, the Company expects to recover the entire amortized cost basis of these securities.

 
77

 
 
The Company owns one pooled trust preferred security, rated triple-A at purchase, with an amortized cost basis of $4.7 million and an unrealized loss of $2.1 million at December 31, 2011. The gross unrealized loss is mainly due to extraordinarily high investor yield requirements resulting from an illiquid market, causing this security to be valued at a discount to its acquisition cost. One credit rating agency has now rated the security Baa3 while another has rated the security triple-C-. The senior tranche owned by the Company has a collateral balance well in excess of the amortized cost basis of the tranche at December 31, 2011. Eighteen of the fifty-six issuers in the security have deferred or defaulted on their interest payments as of December 31, 2011. The Company’s analysis determined that approximately half of the issuers would need to default on their interest payments before the senior tranche owned by the Company would be at risk of loss. As the Company’s estimated present value of expected cash flows to be collected is in excess of the amortized cost basis, the Company considers the gross unrealized loss on this security to be temporary.

The majority of gross unrealized losses at December 31, 2011 relate to a type of mortgage-backed security also known as private-label collateralized mortgage obligations, or CMOs. As of December 31, 2011, the fair value of these securities was $13.0 million, representing 3 percent of our securities portfolio. Gross unrealized losses related to these securities amounted to $2.8 million, or 18 percent of the amortized cost basis of these securities as of December 31, 2011. The gross unrealized losses on these securities were primarily due to extraordinarily high investor yield requirements resulting from an illiquid market, significant uncertainty about the future condition of the mortgage market and the economy, and continued deterioration in the credit performance of loan collateral underlying these securities, causing these securities to be valued at significant discounts to their acquisition cost. Three private-label CMO’s had credit agency ratings of less than investment grade at December 31, 2011. To assess whether it expects to recover the entire amortized cost basis of its private-label CMO’s, the Company performed a cash flow analysis for the three securities rated less than investment grade at December 31, 2011. In performing the cash flow analysis for each security, the Company utilized a third-party model which considers borrower characteristics and the particular attributes of the loans underlying the Company’s securities, which estimates future cash flows based upon the estimated prepayments, default rates and loss severities input by the Company. The Company estimated the prepayments, default rates and loss severities of each individual security based upon the 3-month historical collateral performance of each security. This model then allocated the projected loan level cash flows and losses to the various security classes in each security structure in accordance with the structure’s prescribed cash flow and loss allocation rules. When the credit enhancement for the senior securities in a structure is derived from the presence of subordinated securities, losses are generally allocated first to the subordinated securities until their principal balance is reduced to zero. The projected cash flows are based on a number of assumptions and expectations, and the results from this model can vary significantly with changes in assumptions and expectations.

Based upon this analysis, three private-label CMO’s were determined to be other-than-temporarily impaired as of December 31, 2011 (that is, securities for which the Company determined that it was more likely than not that the entire amortized cost basis would not be recovered), and a credit loss of $321,000 was recognized in earnings in the fourth quarter of 2011. The Company had previously recognized a $1,066,000 OTTI credit loss on these three securities in the first quarter of 2011. The Company does not intend to sell these securities and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell these securities before its anticipated recovery of the remaining amortized cost basis. If current conditions in the mortgage markets and general business and economic conditions continue to deteriorate further, the fair value of the Company’s mortgage-related securities may decline further and the Company may experience OTTI of additional securities in future periods, as well as further impairment of securities that were identified as other-than-temporarily impaired at December 31, 2011. The Company cannot predict whether it will be required to record additional OTTI charges on its securities in the future.

The Company has committed to contribute capital of $1.0 million to participate in a community development-related investment fund whose purpose is to develop and revitalize economically depressed areas. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010 the Company had contributed capital, net of distributions, of $816,000 and $855,000, respectively. During 2010, the fund recognized impairment losses on certain investments within the fund and the Company recognized its proportionate share of those impairment losses of $41,000. The Company will continue to monitor the investment values within the fund at each reporting date and can provide no assurance there will not be an other-than-temporary impairment in future periods.

The following table presents the other-than-temporary impairment activity related to credit loss, which is recognized in earnings, for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010.

   
For the Years Ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Beginning balance
  $ 2,256     $ 1,507     $  
Addition of other-than-temporary impairment that was not previously recognized
          120       1,507  
Additional increases to the amount related to the credit loss for which an other-than-temporary impairment was previously recognized
    1,387       664        
Reduction for securities sold during the period
          (35 )      
Ending balance
  $ 3,643     $ 2,256     $ 1,507  

 
78

 
 
Proceeds from the sale of securities for the year ended December 31, 2011 amounted to $39.0 million resulting in gross realized gains of $1.1 million and gross realized losses of $0.1 million, respectively. Proceeds from sale of securities for the year ended December 31, 2010 were $238.0 million resulting in gross realized gains of $2.4 million and gross realized losses of $0.4 million, respectively. Proceeds from the sale of securities for the year ended December 31, 2009 were $251.1 million and resulted in gross realized gains of $6.9 million and gross realized losses of $0.4 million, respectively.

The amortized cost and estimated fair value of securities by contractual maturities are shown below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. Mortgage-backed securities may mature earlier than their contractual maturities because of principal prepayments.


   
At December 31, 2011
 
   
Amortized
Cost
   
Fair
Value
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Due in one year or less
  $ 66,440     $ 66,472  
Due after one year through five years
    40,503       40,598  
Due after five years through ten years
    96,907       96,928  
Due after ten years
    252,388       249,737  
 
  $ 456,238     $ 453,735  
 
As of December 31, 2011, securities with an estimated fair value of $49.2 million were pledged to secure public and other deposits, as required by law, repurchase agreements, and the Federal Reserve Bank’s discount window.

NOTE 5 – NON-COVERED LOANS AND ALLOWANCE FOR NON-COVERED LOAN LOSSES

The loans not acquired in the SLTB and WCB acquisitions and which are not covered by the related shared-loss agreements with the FDIC are referred to as non-covered loans. The non-covered loan portfolio by type consists of the following:

(in thousands)
 
At
December 31,
2011
   
At
December 31,
2010
 
Commercial mortgage
  $ 393,376     $ 399,634  
Commercial loans and lines of credit
    180,421       213,576  
Home mortgage
    106,350       108,076  
Multifamily
    187,333       135,639  
Construction and land loans
    35,082       55,260  
Home equity loans and lines of credit
    28,645       29,828  
Installment and credit card
    4,896       5,724  
Total non-covered loans
    936,103       947,737  
Allowance for loan losses
    (17,747 )     (17,033 )
Non-covered loans, net
  $ 918,356     $ 930,704  
 
At December 31, 2011, loans with a balance of $668.2 million were pledged as security for Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco, or FHLB, advances.  Non-covered loan balances include net deferred loan costs of $3.4 million and $0.4 million at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.

Most of the Company’s lending activity is with customers located in Los Angeles, Orange, Ventura, Riverside, San Bernardino, San Diego and San Luis Obispo Counties and most loans are secured by or dependent on real estate. Although the Company has no significant exposure to any individual customer, economic conditions, particularly the recent sustained decline in real estate values in Southern California, could adversely affect customers and their ability to satisfy their obligations under their loan agreements.

 
79

 
 
Changes in the allowance for non-covered loan losses were as follows:

   
Twelve months ended December 31,
 
(in thousands)
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Beginning balance
  $ 17,033     $ 16,505     $ 8,048  
Provision for loan losses
    5,346       8,337       16,646  
Loans charged-off
    (5,177 )     (8,535 )     (8,580 )
Recoveries on loans previously charged-off
    545       726       391  
Balance, end of period
  $ 17,747     $ 17,033     $ 16,505  
 
The following table details activity in the allowance for non-covered loan losses by portfolio segment for the year ended December 31, 2011. Allocation of a portion of the allowance to one segment of the loan portfolio does not preclude its availability to absorb losses in other segments.
 
   
Commercial
               
Construction
   
Home
   
Home
             
(in thousands)
 
Mortgage
   
Commercial
   
Multifamily
   
and Land
   
Mortgage
   
Equity
   
Installment
   
Total
 
                                                 
Allowance for credit losses:
                                               
                                                 
Beginning balance
  $ 6,134     $ 4,934     $ 2,273     $ 1,698     $ 1,496     $ 416     $ 82     $ 17,033  
                                                                 
Charge-offs
    (312 )     (3,988 )     (71 )     (191 )     (475 )     (39 )     (101 )     (5,177 )
                                                                 
Recoveries
          508       17       15                   5       545  
                                                                 
Provision
    269       4,767       667       (708 )     253       13       85       5,346  
                                                                 
Ending balance
  $ 6,091     $ 6,221     $ 2,886     $ 814     $ 1,274     $ 390     $ 71     $ 17,747  
                                                                 
Ending balance; individually evaluated for impairment
  $     $ 3,057     $     $     $     $     $     $ 3,057  
                                                                 
Ending balance; collectively evaluated for impairment
    6,091       3,164       2,886       814       1,274       390       71       14,690  
                                                                 
Non-covered loan balances:
                                                               
                                                                 
Ending balance
  $ 393,376     $ 180,421     $ 187,333     $ 35,082     $ 106,350     $ 28,645     $ 4,896     $ 936,103  
                                                                 
Ending balance; individually evaluated for impairment
  $     $ 11,594     $ 837     $     $ 1,387     $     $ 42     $ 13,860  
                                                                 
Ending balance; collectively evaluated for impairment
  $ 393,376     $ 168,827     $ 186,496     $ 35,082     $ 104,963     $ 28,645     $ 4,854     $ 922,243  
 
 
80

 
 
The following table details activity in the allowance for non-covered loan losses by portfolio segment for the year ended December 31, 2010. Allocation of a portion of the allowance to one segment of the loan portfolio does not preclude its availability to absorb losses in other segments.
 
   
Commercial
               
Construction
   
Home
   
Home
             
(in thousands)
 
Mortgage
   
Commercial
   
Multifamily
   
and Land
   
Mortgage
   
Equity
   
Installment
   
Total
 
                                                 
Allowance for credit losses:
                                               
                                                 
Beginning balance
  $ 4,850     $ 4,796     $ 3,277     $ 2,460     $ 605     $ 453     $ 64     $ 16,505  
                                                                 
Charge-offs
    (648 )     (5,480 )     (1,170 )     (560 )     (422 )     (199 )     (56 )     (8,535 )
                                                                 
Recoveries
    138       225             177       174             12       726  
                                                                 
Provision
    1,794       5,393       166       (379 )     1,139       162       62       8,337  
                                                                 
Ending balance
  $ 6,134     $ 4,934     $ 2,273     $ 1,698     $ 1,496     $ 416     $ 82     $ 17,033  
                                                                 
Ending balance; individually evaluated for impairment
  $     $ 1,627     $ 150     $ 168     $ 18     $     $     $ 1,963  
                                                                 
Ending balance; collectively evaluated for impairment
    6,134       3,307       2,123       1,530       1,478       416       82       15,070  
                                                                 
Non-covered loan balances:
                                                               
                                                                 
Ending balance
  $ 399,634     $ 213,576     $ 135,639     $ 55,260     $ 108,076     $ 29,828     $ 5,724     $ 947,737  
                                                                 
Ending balance; individually evaluated for impairment
  $ 1,458     $ 12,376     $ 668     $ 698     $ 1,967     $     $     $ 17,167  
                                                                 
Ending balance; collectively evaluated for impairment
  $ 398,176     $ 201,200     $ 134,971     $ 54,562     $ 106,109     $ 29,828     $ 5,724     $ 930,570  

Nonaccrual loans are those loans for which management has discontinued accrual of interest because reasonable doubt exists as to the full and timely collection of either principal or interest. Nonaccrual loans are also considered impaired loans. Total non-covered nonaccrual loans totaled $13.9 million at December 31, 2011 as compared to $18.2 million at December 31, 2010. The allowance for loan losses maintained for non-covered nonaccrual loans was $3.1 million and $2.0 million at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. Had these loans performed according to their original terms, additional interest income of $0.8 million and $1.6 million would have been recognized in the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

The following table sets forth the amounts and categories of our non-covered nonaccrual loans at the dates indicated.
 
   
At December 31, 2011
   
At December 31, 2010
 
Nonaccrual loans
 
 
   
 
 
Aggregate loan amounts
 
 
   
 
 
Construction and land
  $     $ 698  
Commercial mortgage
          1,458  
Multifamily
    837       668  
Commercial loans
    11,594       13,450  
Home mortgage
    1,387       1,967  
Installment
    42        
Total non-covered nonaccrual loans
  $ 13,860     $ 18,241  
 
 
81

 
 
Included in non-covered nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2011 were nine restructured loans totaling $2.8 million. The nine loans consist of one home mortgage loan and eight commercial loans. Interest income recognized on these loans was $34,000 for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011. We have no commitments to lend additional funds to these borrowers.

Included in non-covered nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2010 were eight restructured loans totaling $2.3 million. The eight loans consist of one home mortgage loan and seven commercial loans. Interest income recognized on these loans was $27,000 for the year ended December 31, 2010. We had no commitments to lend additional funds to these borrowers.

Credit Quality Indicators

    All loans are risk rated based on analysis of the current state of the borrower’s credit quality. This analysis of credit quality includes a review of all sources of repayment, the borrower’s current financial and liquidity status and all other relevant information. The Company utilizes a ten grade risk rating system, where a higher grade represents a higher level of credit risk. The ten grade risk rating system can be generally classified by the following categories: Pass, Special Mention, Substandard, Doubtful and Loss. The risk ratings reflect the relative strength of the sources of repayment.

    Pass loans are generally considered to have sufficient sources of repayment in order to repay the loan in full in accordance with all terms and conditions. These borrowers may have some credit risk that requires monitoring, but full repayment is expected. Special Mention loans are considered to have potential weaknesses that warrant close attention by management. Special Mention is considered a transitory grade and generally, the Company does not have a loan stay graded Special Mention for longer than six months. If any potential weaknesses are resolved, the loan is upgraded to a Pass grade. If negative trends in the borrower’s financial status or other information is presented that indicates the repayment sources may become inadequate, the loan is downgraded to a Substandard grade. Substandard loans are considered to have well-defined weaknesses that jeopardize the full and timely repayment of the loan. Substandard loans have a distinct possibility of loss if the deficiencies are not corrected. Additionally, when management has assessed a potential for loss but a distinct possibility of loss is not recognizable, the loan is still classified as Substandard. Doubtful loans have insufficient sources of repayment and a high probability of loss. Loss loans are considered to be uncollectible and of such little value that they are no longer considered bankable assets. These internal risk ratings are reviewed continuously and adjusted due to changes in borrower status and likelihood of loan repayment.

    The table below presents the non-covered loan portfolio by credit quality indicator as of December 31, 2011.

         
Special
                         
   
Pass
   
Mention
   
Substandard
   
Doubtful
   
Loss
   
Total
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Home mortgage
  $ 103,239     $ 1,326     $ 1,785     $     $     $ 106,350  
Commercial mortgage
    366,078       17,798       9,500                   393,376  
Construction and land
    31,623       196       3,263                   35,082  
Multifamily
    178,064       2,972       6,297                   187,333  
Commercial loans and lines
    155,850       4,030       11,937       8,604             180,421  
Home equity loans and lines
    28,139             506                   28,645  
Installment
    4,516       268       112                   4,896  
Total    $ 867,509     $ 26,590     $ 33,400     $ 8,604     $     $ 936,103  

 
82

 
 
    The table below presents the non-covered loan portfolio by credit quality indicator as of December 31, 2010.

         
Special
                         
   
Pass
   
Mention
   
Substandard
   
Doubtful
   
Loss
   
Total
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Home mortgage
  $ 103,669     $     $ 4,407     $     $     $ 108,076  
Commercial mortgage
    372,961       20,899       5,774                   399,634  
Construction and land
    46,137       133       8,990                   55,260  
Multifamily
    127,549       4,187       3,903                   135,639  
Commercial loans and lines
    188,548       4,401       20,449       178             213,576  
Home equity loans and lines
    28,378       1,405       45                   29,828  
Installment
    5,412       289       23                   5,724  
Total   $ 872,654     $ 31,314     $ 43,591     $ 178     $     $ 947,737  
 
    Loans are tracked by the number of days borrower payments are past due. The tables below present an age analysis of nonaccrual and past due non-covered loans, segregated by class of loan, as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.

   
At December 31, 2011
 
   
Accruing
loans 30-59
days past
due
 
Accruing
loans 60-89
days past
due
 
Accruing loans
90+ days
past due
 
Total
Accruing
past due
loans
 
Nonaccrual
past due
loans
 
Current
loans
 
Total
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Commercial loans and lines
 
$
41
 
$
1,071
 
$
 
$
1,112
 
$
11,594
 
$
167,715
 
$
180,421
 
Commercial mortgage
   
648
   
   
   
648
   
   
392,728
   
393,376
 
Multifamily
   
1,010
   
   
   
1,010
   
837
   
185,486
   
187,333
 
Construction and land
   
   
   
   
   
   
35,082
   
35,082
 
Home mortgage
   
   
   
   
   
1,387
   
104,963
   
106,350
 
Home equity loans and lines
   
406
   
100
   
   
506
   
   
28,139
   
28,645
 
Installment
   
172
   
1
   
   
173
   
42
   
4,681
   
4,896
 
Total
 
$
2,277
 
$
1,172
 
$
 
$
3,449
 
$
13,860
 
$
918,794
 
$
936,103
 

   
At December 31, 2010
 
   
Accruing
loans 30-59
days past
due
 
Accruing
loans 60-89
days past
due
 
Accruing
loans 90+
days past
due
 
Total
Accruing
past due
loans
 
Nonaccrual
past due
loans
 
Current
loans
 
Total
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Commercial loans and lines
 
$
896
 
$
449
 
$
 
$
1,345
 
$
13,449
 
$
198,782
 
$
213,576
 
Commercial mortgage
   
658
   
686
   
   
1,344
   
1,458
   
396,832
   
399,634
 
Multifamily
   
632
   
   
   
632
   
668
   
134,339
   
135,639
 
Construction and land
   
   
8,293
   
   
8,293
   
698
   
46,269
   
55,260
 
Home mortgage
   
   
   
   
   
1,968
   
106,108
   
108,076
 
Home equity loans and lines
   
   
   
   
   
   
29,828
   
29,828
 
Installment
   
7
   
9
   
   
16
   
   
5,708
   
5,724
 
Total
 
$
2,193
 
$
9,437
 
$
 
$
11,630
 
$
18,241
 
$
917,866
 
$
947,737
 

The Company considers a loan to be impaired when, based on current information and events, the Company does not expect to be able to collect all amounts due according to the loan contract, including scheduled interest payments. Impaired loans are determined by periodic evaluation on an individual loan basis. The average investment in non-covered impaired loans was $17.6 million and $26.0 million in the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. There was no interest income recognized on non-covered impaired loans in the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Non-covered impaired loans were $13.9 million and $17.2 million at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. Of the $13.9 million of non-covered impaired loans at December 31, 2011, $11.1 million had specific reserves totaling $3.1 million. Of the $17.2 million of non-covered impaired loans at December 31, 2010, $12.5 million had specific reserves totaling $2.0 million.

 
83

 
 
Impaired non-covered loans as of December 31, 2011 are set forth in the following table.
 
(in 000’s)
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance
   
Recorded
Investment
with no
Allowance
   
Recorded
Investment
with
Allowance
   
Total
Recorded
Investment
   
Related
Allowance
   
Average
Recorded
Investment
   
Interest
Income
Recognized
 
                                           
Commercial loans and lines
  $ 13,776     $ 471     $ 11,123     $ 11,594     $ 3,057     $ 9,374     $  
Multifamily
    837       837             837             140        
Home mortgage
    1,887       1,387             1,387             1,035        
Installment
    42       42             42             4        
Total
  $ 16,542     $ 2,737     $ 11,123     $ 13,860     $ 3,057     $ 10,553     $  

Impaired non-covered loans as of December 31, 2010 are set forth in the following table.
 
(in 000’s)
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance
   
Recorded
Investment
with no
Allowance
   
Recorded
Investment
with
Allowance
   
Total
Recorded
Investment
   
Related
Allowance
   
Average
Recorded
Investment
   
Interest
Income
Recognized
 
                                           
Commercial loans and lines
  $ 19,211     $ 1,691     $ 10,685     $ 12,376     $ 1,627     $ 5,701     $  
Commercial mortgage
    1,458       1,458             1,458             486        
Multifamily
    905             668       668       150       670        
Home mortgage
    2,542       1,530       437       1,967       18       1,189        
Construction
    698             698       698       168       223        
Total
  $ 24,814     $ 4,679     $ 12,488     $ 17,167     $ 1,963     $ 8,269     $  
 
    The average recorded investment in impaired non-covered loans shown in the above tables represents the average investment for the period in the non-covered loans impaired at each respective period-end.

Troubled Debt Restructurings

    The Company offers a variety of modifications to borrowers. The modification categories offered can generally be described in the following categories:

Rate modification – A modification in which the interest rate is changed.

Term modification – A modification in which the maturity date, timing of payments, or frequency of payments is changed.

Interest only modification – A modification in which the loan is converted to interest only payments for a period of time.

Payment modification – A modification in which the dollar amount of the payment is changed, other than an interest only modification described above.

Combination modification – Any other type of modification, including the use of multiple categories above.

 
84

 
 
    The following tables present non-covered loan troubled debt restructurings as of December 31, 2011 and 2010.

   
December 31, 2011
 
   
Accrual Status
   
Nonaccrual Status
   
Total Modifications
 
     #     $     #     $     #     $  
Commercial mortgage
    6     $ 878           $       6     $ 878  
Commercial loans & lines
                8       2,665       8       2,665  
Multifamily
    1       725                   1       725  
Home mortgage
                1       158       1       158  
Total
    7     $ 1,603       9     $ 2,823       16     $ 4,426  

   
December 31, 2010
 
   
Accrual Status
   
Nonaccrual Status
   
Total Modifications
 
    #     $     #     $     #     $  
Commercial mortgage
    1     $ 658           $       1     $ 658  
Commercial loans & lines
    3       1,276       7       2,132       10       3,408  
Multifamily
                                   
Home mortgage
                1       158       1       158  
Total
    4     $ 1,934       8     $ 2,290       12     $ 4,224  

    The Bank’s policy is that loans placed on nonaccrual status will typically remain on nonaccrual status until all principal and interest payments are brought current and the prospect for future payment performance in accordance with the loan agreement appear relatively certain. The Bank’s policy generally refers to six months of payment performance as sufficient to warrant a return to accrual status.

    The following tables present newly restructured non-covered loans that occurred during the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

   
Twelve months ended December 31, 2011
 
   
Term Modifications
   
Payment Modifications
   
Combo Modifications
   
Total Modifications
 
    #     $     #     $     #     $     #     $  
Pre-modification outstanding recorded investment:
   
(in thousands)
                       
Commercial loans & lines
        $       2     $ 83       3     $ 1,280       5     $ 1,363  
Multifamily
                            1       626       1       626  
Installment
                            1       5       1       5  
Total
        $       2     $ 83       5     $ 1,911       7     $ 1,994  

   
Twelve months ended December 31, 2011
 
   
Term Modifications
   
Payment Modifications
   
Combo Modifications
   
Total Modifications
 
    #      $     #      $     #      $     #     $  
Post-modification outstanding recorded investment:
   
(in thousands)
                       
Commercial loans & lines
        $       2     $ 83       3     $ 1,280       5     $ 1,363  
Multifamily
                            1       614       1       614  
Installment
                            1       5       1       5  
Total
        $       2     $ 83       5     $ 1,899       7     $ 1,982  
 
 
85

 
 
   
Twelve months ended December 31, 2010
 
   
Term Modifications
   
Payment Modifications
   
Combo Modifications
   
Total Modifications
 
    #     $     #     $     #     $     #     $  
Pre-modification outstanding recorded investment:
   
(in thousands)
                       
Commercial loan & lines
    2     $ 545       3     $ 2,487       7     $ 617       12     $ 3,649  
Home mortgage
                            1       158       1       158  
Total
    2     $ 545       3     $ 2,487       8     $ 775       13     $ 3,807  

   
Twelve months ended December 31, 2010
 
   
Term Modifications
   
Payment Modifications
   
Combo Modifications
   
Total Modifications
 
    #     $     #     $     #     $     #     $  
Post-modification outstanding recorded investment:
   
(in thousands)
                       
Commercial loans & lines
    2     $ 545       3     $ 2,487       7     $ 579       12     $ 3,611  
Home mortgage
                            1       158       1       158  
Total
    2     $ 545       3     $ 2,487       8     $ 737       13     $ 3,769  
 
    During the twelve months ended December 31, 2011, one non-covered loan for $4,000 modified as a troubled debt restructuring had a payment default occurring within 12 months of the restructure date. There were no non-covered loans modified as a troubled debt restructuring and had a payment default occurring within 12 months of the restructure date during the twelve months ended December 31, 2010.

NOTE 6 – COVERED LOANS AND FDIC SHARED-LOSS ASSET

Covered assets consist of loans receivable and foreclosed property that we acquired in the FDIC-assisted SLTB and WCB acquisitions for which we entered into shared-loss agreements with the FDIC. The Bank will share in the losses with the FDIC, which begin with the first dollar of loss incurred on the loan pools (including single-family residential mortgage loans, commercial loans and foreclosed property) covered under our shared-loss agreements. We refer to all other loans not covered under our shared-loss agreements as non-covered loans.

Pursuant to the terms of the shared-loss agreements, the FDIC is obligated to reimburse the Bank for 80 percent of eligible losses with respect to covered assets. The Bank has a corresponding obligation to reimburse the FDIC for 80 percent of eligible recoveries with respect to covered loans. The shared-loss agreements for commercial and single-family residential mortgage loans are in effect for five years and ten years, respectively, from the acquisition date and the loss recovery provisions are in effect for eight years and ten years, respectively, from the acquisition date.

The following table reflects the estimated fair value of the acquired loans at the acquisition dates.

   
Western Commercial
   
San Luis Trust Bank
       
   
November 5, 2010
   
February 18, 2011
   
Total
 
                   
Home mortgage
  $ 2,484     $ 64,524     $ 67,008  
Commercial mortgage
    25,920       15,948       41,868  
Construction and land loans
    7,599       23,395       30,994  
Multifamily
          18,450       18,450  
Commercial loans and lines of credit
    19,486       2,353       21,839  
Home equity loans and lines of credit
          13,669       13,669  
Installment and credit card
          453       453  
 Total
  $ 55,489     $ 138,792     $ 194,281  

 
86

 

In estimating the fair value of the covered loans at the acquisition date, we (a) calculated the amount and timing of contractual undiscounted principal and interest payments and (b) estimated the amount and timing of undiscounted expected principal and interest payments. The difference between these two amounts represents the nonaccretable difference. On the acquisition date, the amount by which the undiscounted expected cash flows exceed the estimated fair value of the acquired loans is the “accretable yield.” The accretable yield is then measured at each financial reporting date and represents the difference between the remaining undiscounted expected cash flows and the current carrying value of the loans.

The following table presents a reconciliation of the undiscounted contractual cash flows, nonaccretable difference, accretable yield, and the fair value of covered loans for each respective acquired loan portfolio at the acquisition dates.

   
Western Commercial
   
San Luis Trust Bank
       
   
November 5, 2010
   
February 18, 2011
   
Total
 
                   
Undiscounted contractual cash flows
  $ 81,431     $ 252,263     $ 333,694  
Undiscounted cash flows not expected to be collected (nonaccretable difference)
    (20,094 )     (81,586 )     (101,680 )
Undiscounted cash flows expected to be collected
    61,337       170,677       232,014  
Accretable yield at acquisition
    (5,848 )     (31,885 )     (37,733 )
Estimated fair value of loans acquired at acquisition
  $ 55,489     $ 138,792     $ 194,281  

The following tables present the changes in the accretable yield for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 for each respective acquired loan portfolio.
 
   
Twelve months ended December 31, 2011
 
   
Western Commercial
   
San Luis Trust Bank
   
Total
 
                   
Balance, beginning of period
  $ 5,457     $     $ 5,457  
Additions resulting from acquisitions
          31,885       31,885  
Accretion to interest income
    (3,836 )     (10,089 )     (13,925 )
Reclassifications (to)/from nonaccretable difference
    7,778       33,522       41,300  
Balance, end of period
  $ 9,399     $ 55,318     $ 64,717  
 
   
Twelve months ended December 31, 2010
 
   
Western Commercial
   
San Luis Trust Bank
   
Total
 
                         
Balance, beginning of period
  $     $     $  
Additions resulting from acquisition
    5,848             5,848  
Accretion to interest income
    (391 )           (391 )
Reclassifications (to)/from nonaccretable difference
                 
Balance, end of period
  $ 5,457     $     $ 5,457  

 
87

 
 
The following table sets forth the composition of the covered loan portfolio by type.

Covered loans by property type (in thousands)
 
At
December 31,
2011
   
At
December 31,
2010
 
Commercial mortgage
  $ 37,804     $ 26,046  
Home mortgage
    36,736       2,046  
Construction and land loans
    22,875       6,143  
Multifamily
    15,944       2,688  
Commercial loans and lines of credit
    11,206       16,820  
Home equity loans and lines of credit
    10,841       135  
Installment and credit card
    6        
Total covered loans
  $ 135,412     $ 53,878  

The FDIC shared-loss asset represents the present value of the amounts we expect to receive from the FDIC under our shared-loss agreements. We accrete into noninterest income over the life of the FDIC shared-loss asset the difference between the present value and the undiscounted cash flows we expect to collect from the FDIC. The FDIC shared-loss asset was $68.1 million at December 31, 2011 and $16.7 million at December 31, 2010.

    The FDIC shared-loss asset was initially recorded at fair value, which represented the present value of the estimated cash payments from the FDIC for future losses on covered assets. The ultimate collectability of this asset is dependent upon the performance of the underlying covered assets, the passage of time and claims paid by the FDIC. The following table presents the changes in the FDIC shared-loss asset for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011.
 
   
Twelve months ended December 31, 2011
 
(in thousands)
 
WCB
   
SLTB
   
Total
 
Balance, beginning of period
  $ 16,725     $     $ 16,725  
Acquisition
          70,293       70,293  
FDIC share of additional losses
    740       2,189       2,929  
Cash payments received from FDIC
    (8,379 )     (13,672 )     (22,051 )
Net accretion
    73       114       187  
Balance, end of period
  $ 9,159     $ 58,924     $ 68,083  
 
Forty-five days following the tenth anniversary of the WCB and SLTB acquisition dates, the Company will be required to perform a calculation and determine if a payment to the FDIC is necessary. The payment amount will be 50 percent of the excess, if any, of (i) 20 percent of the intrinsic loss estimate minus (ii) the sum of (a) 20 percent of the net loss amount, plus (b) 25 percent of the asset discount bid, plus (c) 3.5 percent of total loss share assets at acquisition. The Company’s estimate for the present value of this liability was $3.8 million and $1.0 million at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.

    We evaluated each of the acquired loans under ASC 310-30, Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with Deteriorated Credit Quality, or ASC 310-30, to determine loans for which 1) there was evidence of credit deterioration since origination and 2) it was probable that we would not collect all contractually required payments receivable. We determined the best indicator of such evidence was an individual loan’s accrual status. Therefore, an individual loan on nonaccrual at the acquisition date (generally 90 days or greater contractually past due) was deemed to be non-performing credit impaired and therefore within the scope of ASC 310-30. Acquired loans that were accruing at the acquisition date were separately identified and labeled performing credit impaired loans.

    Pursuant to an AICPA letter dated December 18, 2009, the AICPA summarized the SEC Staff’s view regarding the accounting in subsequent periods for discount accretion associated with non-credit impaired loans acquired in a business combination or asset purchase. Regarding the accounting for such loans, in the absence of further standard setting, the AICPA understands that the SEC Staff would not object to an accounting policy based on contractual cash flows or an accounting policy based on expected cash flows. We believe analogizing to ASC 310-30 is an appropriate method to follow in accounting for the credit-related portion of the fair value discount on the performing credit impaired loans. By doing so, these loans, which are labeled performing credit impaired, are only being accreted up to the cash flows that we expected to receive at acquisition of the loan. Given the lending practices of the institution from which the loans were acquired, and in estimating the expected cash flows for each designated pool, all loans acquired were recognized to have some degree of credit impairment.

 
88

 
 
On the acquisition dates, the amounts by which the undiscounted expected cash flows exceed the estimated fair value of the acquired loans is the accretable yield. The accretable yield is taken into interest income over the life of the loans using the effective yield method. The accretable yield changes over time due to both accretion and as actual and expected cash flows vary from the acquisition date estimated cash flows. The accretable yield is then measured at each financial reporting date and represents the difference between the remaining undiscounted expected cash flows and the current carrying value of the loans. The remaining undiscounted expected cash flows are calculated at each financial reporting date based on information then currently available. Increases in expected cash flows over those originally estimated increase the carrying value of the pool and are recognized as interest income prospectively. Decreases in expected cash flows compared to those originally estimated decrease the carrying value of the pool and are recognized by recording a provision for credit losses and establishing an allowance for credit losses. As the accretable yield increases due to cash flow expectations, the offset is a change to the nonaccretable difference.

The acquired covered loans are and will continue to be subject to the Bank’s internal and external credit review and monitoring practices. The covered loans have the same credit quality indicators, such as risk grade and classification, as the non-covered loans, to enable the monitoring of the borrower’s credit and the likelihood of repayment. If credit deteriorates beyond the respective acquisition date fair value amount of covered loans under ASC 310-30, such deterioration will be reserved for and a provision for credit losses will be charged to earnings with a partially offsetting noninterest income item reflected in the increase of the FDIC shared-loss asset.

At December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, there was no allowance for the covered loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 related to deterioration, as the credit quality deterioration was not beyond the acquisition date fair value amounts of the covered loans.

Loans are tracked by the number of days borrower payments are past due. The tables below present an age analysis of nonaccrual and past due covered loans, segregated by class of loan, as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.

 
At December 31, 2011
 
 
Accruing loans 30-59 days past due
 
Accruing loans 60-89 days past due
 
Accruing loans 90+ days past due
 
Total Accruing past due loans
 
Nonaccrual past due loans
 
Current loans
 
Total
 
 
(in thousands)
 
Commercial loans and lines
  $ 109     $     $     $ 109     $ 1,338     $ 9,759     $ 11,206  
Commercial mortgage
                            3,043       34,761       37,804  
Multifamily
    97                   97       3,670       12,177       15,944  
Construction and land
    755                   755       3,920       18,200       22,875  
Home mortgage
    793       909       511       2,213       6,389       28,134       36,736  
Home equity loans and lines
    243                   243       187       10,411       10,841  
Installment
                                  6       6  
Total
  $ 1,997     $ 909     $ 511     $ 3,417     $ 18,547     $ 113,448     $ 135,412  
 
 
At December 31, 2010
 
 
Accruing loans 30-59 days past due
 
Accruing loans 60-89 days past due
 
Accruing loans 90+ days past due
 
Total Accruing past due loans
 
Nonaccrual past due loans
 
Current loans
 
Total
 
 
(in thousands)
 
Commercial loans and lines
  $ 1,056     $ 180     $ 400     $ 1,636     $ 1,074     $ 14,110     $ 16,820  
Commercial mortgage
    1,353                   1,353       1,024       23,669       26,046  
Multifamily
                            428       2,260       2,688  
Construction and land
    2,289                   2,289       1,799       2,055       6,143  
Home mortgage
                                  2,046       2,046  
Home equity loans and lines
                                  135       135  
Total
  $ 4,698     $ 180     $ 400     $ 5,278     $ 4,325     $ 44,275     $ 53,878  

 
89

 
 
The increases in these amounts since December 31, 2010 were due to the FDIC-assisted San Luis Trust Bank acquisition in February 2011. At December 31, 2011, included in covered non-accrual loans were restructured loans totaling $9.6 million.

At December 31, 2010, included in covered non-accrual loans was one restructured commercial mortgage loan for $0.9 million. Interest income recognized on this loan was $18,000 for the year ended December 31, 2010. We had no commitment to lend additional funds to this borrower.

    The table below presents the covered loan portfolio by credit quality indicator as of December 31, 2011.

   
Pass
   
Special Mention
   
Substandard
   
Doubtful
   
Loss
   
Total
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Home mortgage
  $ 11,213     $ 5,953     $ 19,570     $     $     $ 36,736  
Commercial mortgage
    17,888       10,737       9,179                   37,804  
Construction and land
    4,447       4,129       14,299                   22,875  
Multifamily
    9,247             6,697                   15,944  
Commercial loans and lines of credit
    3,076       2,057       5,952       121             11,206  
Home equity loans and lines
    8,513       1,327       1,001                   10,841  
Installment
    2             4                   6  
 
  $ 54,386     $ 24,203     $ 56,702     $ 121     $     $ 135,412  

    The table below presents the covered loan portfolio by credit quality indicator as of December 31, 2010.

   
Pass
   
Special Mention
   
Substandard
   
Doubtful
   
Loss
   
Total
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Home mortgage
  $ 1,210     $     $ 836     $     $     $ 2,046  
Commercial mortgage
    18,171       2,855       4,849       171             26,046  
Construction and land
    231             4,803       1,109             6,143  
Multifamily
    2,260             428                   2,688  
Commercial loans and lines of credit
    9,386       1,297       4,535       1,602             16,820  
Home equity loans and lines
    135                               135  
 
  $ 31,393     $ 4,152     $ 15,451     $ 2,882     $     $ 53,878  
 
NOTE 7–FORECLOSED PROPERTY

Non-covered foreclosed property at December 31, 2011 consists of a $14.0 million completed office complex project consisting of 16 buildings in Ventura County, a $2.8 million unimproved land property of 161 acres located in an unincorporated section of western Los Angeles County known as Liberty Canyon and a $1.8 million industrial building in Costa Mesa, California. The remainder represents one multifamily property, repossessed equipment and two single-family residences.

 
90

 

    The following table presents the activity of our non-covered foreclosed property for the periods indicated.

   
As of and for the twelve months ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
# of Properties
   
$ Amount
   
# of Properties
   
$ Amount
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Beginning balance
    8     $ 26,011       1     $ 4,893  
New properties added
    4       3,356       10       25,660  
Valuation allowances
          (5,784 )           (2,305 )
Sales of properties
    (5 )     (3,234 )     (3 )     (2,237 )
Ending balance
    7     $ 20,349       8     $ 26,011  

Covered foreclosed property at December 31, 2011 was $14.6 million and $1.0 million at December 31, 2010. We acquired these properties as part of the FDIC-assisted Western Commercial Bank and San Luis Trust Bank acquisitions. We recorded these properties at their estimated fair value, less estimated costs to sell, at the time of acquisition. Since year-end 2010, we sold $19.5 million of properties and acquired or added $33.6 million.
 
The following table presents the activity of our covered foreclosed property for the periods indicated.

   
As of and for the twelve months ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
# of Properties
   
$ Amount
   
# of Properties
   
$ Amount
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Beginning balance
    2     $ 977           $  
New properties acquired
    22       11,052       2       977  
New properties added
    57       22,587              
Valuation allowances
          (455 )            
Sales of properties
    (32 )     (19,545 )            
Ending balance
    49     $ 14,616       2     $ 977  

NOTE 8—PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT

The major classifications of premises and equipment at December 31, 2011 and 2010 are summarized as follows:

   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Land
  $ 4,292     $ 4,792  
Buildings
    11,594       12,180  
Leasehold improvements
    6,347       5,833  
Furniture, fixtures and equipment
    11,535       11,206  
 
    33,768       34,011  
Less accumulated amortization and depreciation
    (15,288 )     (14,301 )
 
  $ 18,480     $ 19,710  
 
Depreciation and amortization expense was $2,045,000, $1,927,000 and $1,822,000 in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

NOTE 9—GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS

Goodwill was $60.7 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010. No impairment loss was recognized for the periods ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

 
91

 
 
Other intangible assets and related accumulated amortization is as follows:

   
At December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Core deposit intangibles
  $ 15,204     $ 12,543  
Trade name
    4,000       4,000  
Contracts and customer relationship intangible
    3,600        
      22,804       16,543  
Less accumulated amortization
    (8,917 )     (6,628 )
    $ 13,887     $ 9,915  

Core deposit intangibles, net of accumulated amortization, were $8.5 million at December 31, 2011 and $7.4 million at December 31, 2010. The increase since year end 2010 was due to the new core deposit intangibles for the San Luis Trust Bank and the EPS division acquisitions. Amortization expense was $1.6 million and $1.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

Trade name, net of accumulated amortization, was $2.1 million at December 31, 2011 and $2.5 million at December 31, 2010 representing the fair value of the Bank name recorded as part of the acquisition of FCB. Amortization expense for each of the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 was $0.4 million.

A contracts and customer relationship intangible of $3.6 million was recognized related to the EPS division acquisition. Amortization expense for 2011 was $270,000.

Amortization expense of other intangibles for 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $2.3 million, $1.7 million and $1.6 million, respectively. Estimated amortization expense for the next 5 years and thereafter is expected to be as follows:

Year
 
Amount
 
   
(in thousands)
 
2012
  $ 2,195  
2013
    2,107  
2014
    2,088  
2015
    2,070  
2016
    1,969  
Thereafter
    3,458  
 
  $ 13,887  
 
NOTE 10—CERTIFICATES OF DEPOSIT

At December 31, 2011, the scheduled maturities for all certificates of deposit are as follows:

Year
 
Under
$100,000
   
$100,000
and Over
   
Total
 
   
(in thousands)
 
2012
  $ 55,201     $ 206,328     $ 261,529  
2013
    12,657       35,735       48,392  
2014
    5,481       19,670       25,151  
2015
    562       7,978       8,540  
2016 and later
    960       5,464       6,424  
 
  $ 74,861     $ 275,175     $ 350,036  
 
 
92

 
 
NOTE 11—LINES OF CREDIT AND BORROWED FUNDS

The Bank has lines of credit with two financial institutions providing for federal funds facilities up to a maximum of $30.0 million. The lines of credit support short-term liquidity and cannot be used for more than 30 consecutive business days, depending on the lending institution. These lines are unsecured, have no formal maturity date, and can be revoked at any time by the granting institution. There were no borrowings outstanding under these agreements at December 31, 2011 and 2010.

As a state nonmember bank, the Bank also has a secured borrowing facility of $14.3 million with the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, there were no borrowings outstanding under this agreement.

The Bank, as a member of the FHLB, has entered into credit arrangements with the FHLB, with maximum borrowing capacity of approximately $508.2 million at December 31, 2011. Borrowings under the credit arrangements are collateralized by FHLB stock as well as loans or other instruments which may be pledged. The Bank’s borrowing capacity is determined based on the estimated market value of certain eligible loans and securities pledged as collateral; however, the FHLB has a blanket lien against the Bank’s entire loan portfolio as collateral for borrowings. As of December 31, 2011, borrowings outstanding with the FHLB were as follows:

                   
   
Amount
   
Maturity
Year
   
Weighted Average
Interest Rate
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Overnight advances
  $              
Term advances
    25,551       2012       3.56 %
Term advances
    7,168       2013       2.88 %
Term advances
    32,500       2014       2.95 %
Term advances
    15,000       2015       1.76 %
Term advances
    7,500       2017       4.07 %
 
  $ 87,719                  

As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, $7.5 million of our FHLB advances are ten-year putable advances with a weighted average rate of 4.07%, $17.5 million are seven-year putable advances with a weighted average rate of 4.24% and $17.5 million are five-year putable advances with a weighted average rate of 4.12%.

The following tables show securities sold under agreements to repurchase for the dates and periods shown (in thousands):

   
2011
 
   
Year-end
   
Average
 
   
Balance
   
Rate
   
Balance
   
Rate
 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements
  $ 30,000       3.64 %   $ 30,657       3.64 %
 
   
2010
 
   
Year-end
   
Average
 
   
Balance
   
Rate
   
Balance
   
Rate
 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements
  $ 45,000       3.64 %   $ 45,000       3.64 %
 
The maximum amount of overnight borrowings outstanding at any month-end during 2010 was $35 million. There were no borrowings outstanding as of any month-end during 2011.
 
The Company had $271.9 million of unused borrowing capacity available from the FHLB at December 31, 2011 based upon pledged collateral.

 
93

 
 

NOTE 12—JUNIOR SUBORDINATED DEBENTURES

In December 2005 and January 2007 the Company, or an acquired company, issued junior subordinated debentures to the Trusts. These junior subordinated debentures are effectively subordinated to all of our borrowings. The Company also owns the common stock of each of the Trusts. The balance of the equity of the Trusts is comprised of mandatorily redeemable preferred securities and is included in “accrued interest receivable and other assets” on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.

As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company had $26.8 million in junior subordinated debentures outstanding from two issuances of trust preferred securities. Junior subordinated debentures as of December 31, 2011 consisted of the following (in thousands):

           
As of December 31, 2011
 
   
Interest Rate
 
Maturity Date
 
Effective
Interest Rate
   
Balance
 
FCB Statutory Trust I
 
3-month LIBOR + 1.55%
 
December 15, 2035
    2.10 %   $ 10,310  
First California Capital Trust I
 
Fixed until March 2012
 
March 15, 2037
    6.80 %     16,495  
 
 
 
 
 
    4.99 %   $ 26,805  
 
On March 15, 2012, First California Capital Trust I will convert to a variable annual rate, which resets quarterly, equal to the 3-month LIBOR rate plus 1.60% per annum.

The Company does not consolidate the Trusts into the consolidated financial statements.

On March 1, 2005, the FRB adopted a final rule that allows the continued inclusion of trust preferred securities in the Tier 1 capital of holding companies, subject to stricter quantitative limits and qualitative standards. Under the final ruling, qualifying mandatory preferred securities may be included in Tier 1 capital, subject to a limit of 25 percent of all core capital. Amounts of restricted core capital elements in excess of this limit generally may be included in Tier 2 capital. The qualitative limits became effective March 31, 2011, after a six-year transition period. As of December 31, 2011, the entire balance of junior subordinated debentures is included in Tier 1 capital for regulatory capital purposes. However, Dodd-Frank excludes trust preferred securities issued on or after May 19, 2010 from tier 1 capital. In addition, for depository institution holding companies with total consolidated assets of more than $15 billion at December 31, 2009, trust preferred securities issued before May 19, 2010 will be phased-out of tier 1 capital over a three-year period.

NOTE 13—DERIVATIVES AND HEDGING ACTIVITY

Risk Management Objective of Using Derivatives

The Company is exposed to certain risks arising from both its business operations and economic conditions. The Company principally manages its exposures to a wide variety of business and operational risks through management of its core business activities. The Company manages economic risks, including interest rate, liquidity, and credit risk, primarily by managing the amount, sources, and duration of its assets and liabilities and through the use of derivative financial instruments. Specifically, the Company enters into derivative financial instruments to manage exposures that arise from business activities that result in the receipt or payment of future known and uncertain cash amounts, the value of which are determined by interest rates. The Company’s derivative financial instruments are used to manage differences in the amount, timing, and duration of the Company’s known or expected cash receipts and its known or expected cash payments principally related to certain variable-rate loan assets and borrowings. The Company does not use derivatives for trading or speculative purposes.

 
94

 
 
Fair Values of Derivative Instruments on the Balance Sheet

The table below presents the fair value of the Company’s derivative financial instruments as well as their classification on the balance sheets as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.

 
Tabular Disclosure of Fair Values of Derivative Instruments
 
Asset Derivatives
 
Liability Derivatives
 
As of December 31,
2011
 
As of December 31,
2010
 
As of December 31,
2011
 
As of December 31,
2010
(in thousands)
Balance
Sheet
Location
 
Fair
Value
 
Balance
Sheet
Location
 
Fair
Value
 
Balance
Sheet
Location
 
Fair
Value
 
Balance
Sheet
Location
 
Fair
Value
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate products
Other  Assets
 
$
175
 
Other  Assets
 
$
697
 
Other  Liabilities
 
$
 
Other  Liabilities
 
$
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total derivatives designated as hedging instruments
 
 
$
175
 
 
 
$
697
 
 
 
$
 
 
 
$
Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate products
Other  Assets
 
$
291
 
Other  Assets
 
$
 
Other  Liabilities
 
$
 
Other  Liabilities
 
$
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
 
 
$
291
 
 
 
$
 
 
 
$
 
 
 
$
 
Cash Flow Hedges of Interest Rate Risk

The Company’s objectives in using interest rate derivatives are to add stability to interest income and expense and to manage its exposure to interest rate movements. To accomplish this objective, the Company primarily uses interest rate caps as part of its interest rate risk management strategy. For hedges of the Company’s variable-rate borrowings, interest rate caps designated as cash flow hedges involve the receipt of variable amounts from a counterparty if interest rates rise above the strike rate on the contract in exchange for an up-front premium. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company had three interest rate caps with a notional amount of $37.1 million that were designated as cash flow hedges associated with the Company’s variable-rate borrowings. Two of the caps are forward-starting and were not effective during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010.

The effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives designated and that qualify as cash flow hedges is recorded in Other Comprehensive Income and is subsequently reclassified into earnings in the period that the hedged forecasted transaction affects earnings. The ineffective portion of the change in fair value of the derivatives is recognized directly in earnings. During 2011 and 2010, such derivatives were used to hedge the forecasted variable cash outflows associated with subordinated debt related to trust preferred securities. No hedge ineffectiveness was recognized during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010.

Amounts reported in Other Comprehensive Income related to derivatives will be reclassified to interest expense as interest payments are made on the Company’s variable-rate liabilities. During the next twelve months, the Company estimates that an additional $72,904 will be reclassified as an addition to interest expense.

Non-designated Hedges

    Derivatives not designated as hedges are not speculative and are utilized as part of the Company’s overall interest rate risk management strategy. During 2011, the Company purchased six interest rate caps with an aggregate notional amount of $120 million and hedge accounting does not apply; therefore, all changes in the fair value of the caps are recognized in earnings each period.
 

 
 
95

 
Effect of Derivative Instruments on the Statement of Operations

The tables below present the effect of the Company’s derivative financial instruments on the statement of operations for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.
 
Derivatives in Cash Flow Hedging Relationships  
Amount of Gain or (Loss) Recognized in OCI on Derivative (Effective Portion)
  Location of Gain or (Loss) Reclassified from Accumulated OCI into Income (Effective Portion)  
Amount of Gain or (Loss) Reclassified from Accumulated OCI into Income (Effective Portion)
  Location of Gain or (Loss) Recognized in Income on Derivative (Ineffective Portion)  
Amount of Gain or (Loss) Recognized in Income on Derivative (Ineffective Portion)
 
 
Year Ended December 31,
   
Year Ended December 31,
   
Year Ended December 31,
 
 
2011
   
2010
 
2009
   
2011
   
2010
 
2009
   
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
Interest Rate Products
  $ (278 )   $ 47   $ 7  
Interest expense
  $ (25 )   $   $  
Other non-interest income
  $   $   $  
                                                                     
                                                                     
Total
  $ (278 )   $ 47   $ 7       $ (25 )   $   $       $   $   $  
 
 
 
Derivatives not Designated as Hedging Relationships
 
Location of Gain or (Loss) Recognized in Income on Derivative
 
Amount of Gain or (Loss) Recognized in Income on Derivative
 
   
Year Ended December 31,
 
   
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
Interest Rate Products
 
Other non-interest income
  $ (84 $   $  
                         
                         
Total
      $ (84 $   $  

Credit-risk-related Contingent Features

The Company has agreements with certain of its derivative counterparties that contain a provision where if the Company defaults on any of its indebtedness, including default where repayment of the indebtedness has not been accelerated by the lender, then the Company could also be declared in default on its derivative obligations. Similarly, the Company could be required to settle its obligations under certain of its agreements if the Company fails to maintain its status as a well or adequately capitalized institution. As of December 31, 2011, the Company did not have any derivatives that were in a net liability position related to these agreements.

The Company has no derivatives payable, thus, consideration of the Company’s own credit risk is not applicable.

NOTE 14—INCOME TAXES

The components of the income tax provision (benefit) consisted of the following for the years shown:

   
At December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Current taxes:
                 
Federal
  $ 5,052     $ 644     $ 814  
State
    1,622       245       604  
Total current taxes
    6,674       889       1,418  
Deferred taxes (benefit):
                       
Federal
    7,556       224       (3,528 )
State
    2,680       (173 )     (1,643 )
Total deferred taxes (benefit)
    10,236       51       (5,171 )
Total income tax provision (benefit)
  $ 16,910     $ 940     $ (3,753 )

 
96

 
 
A reconciliation of the amounts computed by applying the federal statutory rate of 34% for 2011 and 2010 to the income before income tax provision (benefit) and the effective tax rate are as follows:

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Amount
   
Rate
   
Amount
   
Rate
   
Amount
   
Rate
 
   
(in thousands)
 
                                     
Tax provision at statutory rate
  $ 13,698       34.0 %   $ 799       34.0 %   $ (2,861 )     34.0 %
Increase (reduction) in taxes resulting from:
                                               
State taxes, net of federal tax benefit
    2,740       6.8 %     35       1.5 %     (602 )     7.1 %
Permanent differences
    (197 )     -0.5 %     (124 )     -5.3 %     (351 )     4.2 %
Other
    669       1.7 %     230       9.8 %     61       -0.7 %
    $ 16,910       42.0 %   $ 940       40.0 %   $ (3,753 )     44.6 %

The major components of the net deferred tax assets (liabilities) at December 31, 2011 and 2010 are as follows:

   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(Dollars in thousands)
 
Deferred tax assets:
 
 
   
 
 
Unrealized loss on securities available-for-sale
  $ 1,054     $ 2,751  
Accrued expenses
    1,280       1,277  
Nonaccrual interest
    200       416  
Allowance for loan losses
    7,111       7,051  
Securities other-than-temporary impairment reserve
    941       487  
State taxes
    515       78  
Reserve for foreclosed asset losses
    3,556       1,307  
Other
    1,143       935  
Total deferred tax assets
    15,800       14,302  
 
               
Deferred tax liabilities:
               
Depreciation
    (3,071 )     (2,815 )
FHLB stock dividend
    (382 )     (496 )
Deferred income
    (471 )     (1 )
Deferred loan costs
    (1,641 )     (1,541 )
Core deposit intangibles
    (1,184 )     (1,484 )
Trade name
    (869 )     (1,015 )
Goodwill
    (868 )     (559 )
Section 597 gain
    (14,061 )     (951 )
Other
    (623 )     (877 )
Total deferred tax liabilities
    (23,170 )     (9,739 )
Net deferred tax asset (liability)
  $ (7,370 )   $ 4,563  
 
The Company establishes a valuation allowance if, based on the weight of available evidence, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company believes that it is more-likely-than-not that future taxable earnings will be sufficient to realize its deferred tax assets and has not provided an allowance.

NOTE 15—SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

The Company has 1,000 issued shares of preferred stock series A, $0.01 par value, with a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share. Redemption of the preferred stock series A is at the Company’s option. The redemption amount is computed at the per-share liquidation preference plus unpaid dividends at a rate of 8.5%. Each holder of preferred stock series A has the right, exercisable at the option of the holder, to convert all or some of such holder’s series A shares into common stock. The number of shares of common stock to be issued upon conversion of each share of preferred stock series A shall be determined by dividing the sum of each share’s liquidation preference plus unpaid dividend by the conversion factor of $5.63 per share. As of December 31, 2011, the number of common shares which would be issued upon conversion of the preferred stock series A is 329,431.

On December 19, 2008, we participated in the U.S. Treasury Capital Purchase Program, or the CPP, under which we received $25 million in exchange for issuing 25,000 preferred stock series B shares and a warrant to purchase common stock to the Treasury. The common stock warrant entitled the Treasury to purchase 599,042 shares of our common stock at an exercise price of $6.26 for a term of ten years. On July 14, 2011, we redeemed all 25,000 preferred stock series B shares and exited the CPP program. On August 24, 2011, we purchased the 10-year warrant from the Treasury for $599,042. In connection with the redemption of the preferred stock series B shares, the Company accelerated the amortization of the remaining difference between the par amount and the initially recorded fair value of the preferred stock series B shares. This $1.1 million deemed dividend reduced the amount of net income available to common shareholders in 2011.

 
97

 
 
We redeemed the $25 million of preferred stock series B shares with the $25 million of proceeds received in exchange for issuing 25,000 preferred stock series C shares to the Treasury as a participant in the Small Business Lending Fund (SBLF) program. The preferred stock series C shares will receive non-cumulative quarterly dividends and the initial dividend rate was 5 percent. The dividend rate can fluctuate between 1 percent and 5 percent during the next eight quarters and is a function of the growth in qualified small business loans each quarter.

On March 3, 2010, the Company’s stockholders approved an amendment to the Company’s Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation to increase the number of authorized shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.01 per share, from 25,000,000 shares to 100,000,000 shares, and to increase the number of authorized shares of all classes of the Company’s stock from 27,500,000 shares to 102,500,000 shares.

In March 2010, we consummated an underwritten public offering of common stock at a price of $2.50 per share. We sold 16,560,000 common shares, which include the exercise by the underwriter of its over-allotment option, for net proceeds of $38.9 million. We contributed $36.0 million to our bank subsidiary. We intend to use the net proceeds of this public offering for general corporate purposes, including funding working capital requirements, supporting the growth of our business from internal efforts and from whole bank or failed bank acquisitions, and regulatory capital needs related to any such growth and acquisitions.

NOTE 16—EARNINGS (LOSS) PER SHARE

The weighted average number of shares outstanding for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was 28,715,521, 24,411,496 and 11,604,648, respectively. Basic earnings (loss) per share excludes dilution and is computed by dividing income available to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period. Diluted earnings (loss) per share reflect the potential dilution that could occur if common shares were issued pursuant to the exercise of common stock options under the Company’s stock option plans and if common shares were issued from the conversion of the convertible preferred stock. The dilutive calculation excludes 599,042 warrants and 647,421, 781,174 and 806,030 weighted average options outstanding for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively, for which the exercise price exceeded the average market price of the Company’s common stock during these periods.

The following table illustrates the computations of basic and diluted earnings (loss) per share for the periods indicated.

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Diluted
   
Basic
   
Diluted
   
Basic
   
Diluted
   
Basic
 
   
(in thousands, except per share data)
 
                                     
Net income (loss) as reported
  $ 23,383     $ 23,383     $ 1,410     $ 1,410     $ (4,661 )   $ (4,661 )
Less preferred stock dividend declared
    (2,555 )     (2,555 )     (1,250 )     (1,250 )     (1,132 )     (1,132 )
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders
  $ 20,828     $ 20,828     $ 160     $ 160     $ (5,793 )   $ (5,793 )
Weighted average common shares outstanding
    28,716       28,716       24,411       24,411       11,605       11,605  
Warrants
                                   
Restricted stock
    417             21                    
Options
                                   
Convertible preferred stock
    318             303                    
Weighted average common shares outstanding
    29,451       28,716       24,735       24,411       11,605       11,605  
Earnings (loss) per common share
  $ 0.71     $ 0.73     $ 0.01     $ 0.01     $ (0.50 )   $ (0.50 )

NOTE 17—EMPLOYEE BENEFITS

The Company has adopted a 401(k) savings investment plan which allows employees to defer certain amounts of compensation for income tax purposes under Section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code. Essentially all eligible employees may elect to defer and contribute up to statutory limits. The Company may, at its discretion, make matching contributions, the total of which may not exceed 15% of eligible compensation. For the years ending December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, the Company made matching contributions of $350,000, $319,000 and $291,000, respectively, to the plan.

 
98

 
 
As part of the Mergers, the Company acquired life insurance to support life insurance benefits for several key employees and salary continuation benefits for certain executives. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the cash surrender value of the life insurance was $12.7 million and $12.2 million, respectively. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company recognized a liability for salary continuation benefits of $752,000 and $583,000, respectively. Payments under the salary continuation plan commence when the respective executive reaches the age of 65 and continue for a period up to 20 years. For the years ending December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, salary continuation expense was $169,000, $112,000 and $87,000, respectively.

The Company has entered into deferred compensation agreements with several of its key employees. Under the agreement, benefits are to be paid in a lump sum or equal monthly installments for a period up to five years upon the employee’s termination with the Company or within 30 days of the employee’s death. The Company also has deferred compensation arising through deferred severance payments to two former executives. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, a liability of $282,000 and $765,000, respectively, for deferred compensation, including deferred severance was included in other liabilities in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.

The Company has established and sponsors an irrevocable trust commonly referred to as a “Rabbi Trust” related to severance payments due to a former executive. The trust assets are consolidated in the Company’s balance sheets in other assets and the related liability is included in other liabilities. The asset and liability balances related to this trust as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 were $177,000 and $442,000, respectively.

NOTE 18—STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION

Stock Incentive Plans—In June 2007, the Company’s Board of Directors approved the First California 2007 Omnibus Equity Incentive Plan, or the Plan. The Plan was amended in May 2011 by a vote of the Company’s stockholders. The Plan authorizes the issuance of awards for up to 3,000,000 shares of the Company’s common stock in the form of incentive stock options, non-statutory stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units and other stock-based awards.

The Company issues restricted stock to employees and directors under share-based compensation plans. For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, stock-based compensation expense relating to restricted stock awards was $1,474,000, $218,000 and $406,000, respectively. A summary of non-vested restricted stock shares as of December 31, 2010 and changes during the year ended December 31, 2011, is presented below:

Non-Vested Shares
 
Number of
Shares
   
Weighted
Average
Price
 
Outstanding, December 31, 2010
    114,645     $ 5.12  
Granted
    1,087,032       3.76  
Vested
    (36,746 )     5.45  
Forfeited
    (51,245 )     3.78  
Outstanding, December 31, 2011
    1,113,686     $ 3.85  
 
The weighted average fair values of restricted stock awards granted during the year ended December 31, 2011 were $3.76. No restricted stock awards were granted in 2010. As of December 31, 2011, total unrecognized compensation cost related to restricted stock awards amounted to $2.5 million. This cost is expected to be recognized over a remaining period of 2.2 years.

The activity of stock options for the year ended December 31, 2011 is as shown:

   
Number
of
Shares
   
Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
   
Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term
(years)
   
Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
(Dollars in
thousands)
 
Outstanding, December 31, 2010
    737,410     $ 7.99       3.91     $ 2,543  
Granted
    3,100       3.58                  
Exercised
                           
Forfeited/Expired
    (150,502 )     8.41                  
Outstanding, December 31, 2011
    590,008       7.86       3.69       2,117  
Exercisable, December 31, 2011
    403,476     $ 8.62       3.23     $ 1,547  
 
 
99

 
 
    The estimated per share weighted average grant date fair value of options granted during the year ended December 31, 2011 was $1.63. No stock options were granted in 2010.  The estimated per share weighted average grant date fair value of options granted during the year ended December 31, 2009 was $1.87.  There were no proceeds from options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010. Proceeds from options exercised during the year ended December 31, 2009 were $14,000. The total fair value of the shares granted during the year ended December 31, 2011 was $5,000. At December 31, 2011, there was $285,866 of total unrecognized compensation cost related to non-vested stock option awards granted under the share-based compensation plans. The cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 0.8 years.

Under the fair value method, stock option compensation expense is measured on the date of grant using an option-pricing model. In accordance with the FASB codification accounting guidance related to stock-based compensation, the fair values of the stock options were estimated using a lattice option pricing model. For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, compensation expense related to stock options was $156,000, $324,000 and $611,000, respectively.

The Company uses the lattice binomial model formula to determine the fair value of stock options using the following estimates and assumptions. The expected volatility assumption used in the lattice option pricing model is based upon the weekly historical volatility of the Company’s stock price using a blend of the unweighted standard deviation of closing price with a weighted mean reversion formula. The risk-free interest rate assumption is for the expected term of the share options and is based upon the U.S. Treasury implied forward yield curve at the time of the grant. The dividend yield assumption is based upon the Company’s capital planning model. The fair value of the options at the grant dates also follows. The weighted average values used for the 2011 and 2009 stock option grants are shown below.

   
2011 Grants
   
2010 Grants
   
2009 Grants
 
                   
Expected option term
 
8.0 years
      N/A    
6.2 years
 
Expected volatility
    43.7 %     N/A       31.8 %
Expected dividend yield
    0.0 %     N/A       0.0 %
Risk-free interest rate
    2.51 %     N/A       3.08 %
Stock option fair value
  $ 1.63       N/A     $ 1.87  

NOTE 19—TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES

Certain directors, executive officers, and principal shareholders are customers of and have had banking transactions with the Company, and the Company expects to have such transactions in the future. All loans and commitments to lend included in such transactions were made in compliance with applicable laws on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other persons and do not involve more than the normal risk of collectibility or present any other unfavorable features. There was no extension of credit to related parties at December 31, 2011. There was one extension of credit to related parties at December 31, 2010. The outstanding balance of the loan to related parties was $3,050 at December 31, 2010. Deposits of related parties held by the Company at December 31, 2011 amounted to approximately $432,000.

NOTE 20—CONCENTRATIONS OF CREDIT RISK

The Company maintains balances in correspondent bank accounts which may at times exceed federally insured limits. Management believes that its risk of loss associated with such balances is minimal due to financial strength of the correspondent banks. The Company has not experienced any losses in such accounts.

Substantially all of the Company’s loans, commitments, and commercial and standby letters of credit have been granted to customers in the Company’s market areas, primarily Los Angeles, Orange, Ventura, San Diego, Riverside, San Luis Obispo and San Bernardino County, California. Many of such customers are also depositors of the Company. The concentrations of credit by type of loan are set forth in Notes 5 and 6. The distribution of commitments to extend credit approximates the distribution of loans outstanding. Commercial and standby letters of credit were granted primarily to commercial borrowers as of December 31, 2011. The Company’s loan policies require the extension of a non-real estate secured credit to any single borrower or group of related borrowers between $2.0 million and $5.0 million to be approved by the officer credit review committee and credit in excess of $5.0 million to be approved by the director credit review committee. The Company’s loan policies require the extension of a real estate secured credit to any single borrower or group of related borrowers between $2.0 million and $7.5 million to be approved by the officer credit review committee and credit in excess of $7.5 million to be approved by the director credit review committee.

NOTE 21—FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH OFF-BALANCE SHEET RISK

In the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers, the Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit and the issuance of letters of credit. These instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk in excess of the amounts recognized in the balance sheets. The contract amounts of those instruments reflect the extent of involvement the Company has in particular classes of financial instruments.

 
100

 
 
The Company’s exposure to credit loss, in the event of nonperformance by the other party to the financial instrument for commitments to extend credit and letters of credit written, is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional obligations as it does for on-balance sheet instruments. The Company may or may not require collateral or other security to support financial instruments with credit risk, depending on its loan underwriting guidelines.

The following summarizes the Company’s outstanding commitments:

   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Financial instruments whose contract amounts contain credit risk:
 
 
   
 
 
Commitments to extend credit
  $ 159,530     $ 199,937  
Commercial and standby letters of credit
    1,475       1,615  
 
  $ 161,005     $ 201,552  
 
Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the Company upon an extension of credit, is based on management’s credit evaluation of the counterparty. Collateral held varies but may include accounts receivable, inventory, property and equipment, and income-producing properties.

Letters of credit written are conditional commitments issued by the Company to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. Those guarantees are primarily issued to support public and private borrowing arrangements, including commercial paper, bond financing, and similar transactions. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The Company holds cash, marketable securities, or real estate as collateral supporting those commitments for which collateral is deemed necessary.

As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company maintained a reserve for unfunded commitments of $101,000. The reserve is included in accrued interest payable and other liabilities on the balance sheets.

Guarantees —As successor to all the rights and obligations of National Mercantile and FCB, the Company has unconditionally guaranteed, on a subordinated basis, all distributions and payments under the First California Trust’s and FCB Statutory Trust I’s capital securities upon liquidation, redemption, or otherwise, but only to the extent either the First California Trust or the FCB Statutory Trust I, as the case may be, fails to pay such distributions under the fixed/floating rate deferrable interest debentures such trust holds from the Company. See “Junior Subordinated Debentures” under Note 12 above.

NOTE 22—COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

In the normal course of business, we make commitments to extend credit or issue letters of credit to customers. We generally do not recognize these commitments in our balance sheet. These commitments do involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk; however, we use the same credit policies and procedures as we do for on-balance sheet credit facilities. Commitments to extend credit were $159.5 million at December 31, 2011 compared with $199.9 million at December 31, 2010. Commercial and stand-by letters of credit were $1.5 million and $1.6 million at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.

The Company has entered into deferred compensation agreements with several of its key employees. Under the agreement, benefits are to be paid in a lump sum or equal monthly installments for a period up to five years upon the employee’s termination with the Company or within 30 days of the employee’s death. The Company also has deferred compensation arising through deferred severance payments to two former executives.

 
101

 
 
Rental expense on operating leases included in occupancy expense in the consolidated statements of operations was $2,900,000 in 2011, $2,754,000 in 2010 and $2,859,000 in 2009. Estimated operating lease commitments for the next 5 years and thereafter is as follows:

Year
 
Amount
 
   
(in thousands)
 
2012
  $ 2,758  
2013
    2,694  
2014
    2,072  
2015
    1,622  
2016
    1,425  
Thereafter
    4,157  
 
  $ 14,728  
 
The nature of the Company’s business causes it to be involved in ordinary routine legal proceedings from time to time. Although the ultimate outcome and amount of liability, if any, with respect to these legal proceedings to which we are currently a party cannot presently be ascertained with certainty, in the opinion of management, based upon information currently available to us, except as described below, any resulting liability is not likely to have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flow.

In February 2011, First California Bank was named as a defendant in a putative class action alleging that the manner in which the Bank posted charges to its consumer demand deposit accounts breached an implied obligation of good faith and fair dealing and violates the California Unfair Competition Law. The action also alleges that the manner in which the Bank posted charges to its consumer demand deposit accounts is unconscionable, constitutes conversion and unjustly enriches the Bank. The action is pending in the Superior Court of Los Angeles County. The action seeks to establish a class consisting of all similarly situated customers of the Bank in the State of California. The case is in early stages, as the court stayed the filing of a responsive pleading and the commencement of formal discovery pending the parties’ informal exchange of information and attempt to resolve the matter informally. If no informal resolution is reached, management intends to defend this action vigorously. A court status conference is scheduled for March 29, 2012. At this state of the case, the Company has not established an accrual for probable losses as the probability of a material adverse result cannot be determined and the Company cannot reasonably estimate a range of potential exposures, if any.

Three lawsuits, entitled Wardlaw, et al. v. First California Bank, et al. (Case No. SC114232) (the “Wardlaw Action”), Lou Correa for State Senate, et al. v. First California Bank, et al. (Case No. BC479872) (the “Correa Action”), and Committee to Re-elect Lorreta Sanchez, et al. v. First California Bank, et al. (Case No. BC479873) (the “Sanchez Action”) were filed in the Superior Court of the State of California, County of Los Angeles on September 23, 2011, February 29, 2012, and February 29, 2012, respectively, by various former clients of political campaign and non-profit organization treasurer Kinde Durkee. Plaintiffs in the three cases claim, among other things, that the Bank aided and abetted a fraud and unlawful conversion by Ms. Durkee of funds held in accounts at the Bank. Based largely on the same alleged conduct, plaintiffs also assert claims for alleged violation of California Business & Professions Code Section 17200 and for declaratory relief. Plaintiffs seek compensatory and punitive damages, as well as various forms of equitable and declaratory relief.

The Bank moved to dismiss the complaint in the Wardlaw Action on November 30, 2011. On December 6, 2011, the Wardlaw Action was designated as complex and transferred to the Superior Court’s complex litigation division. In connection with the transfer, the court issued an order vacating all previously scheduled hearings, including the hearing on the Bank’s motion to dismiss. The Wardlaw Action is stayed pending a status conference scheduled for March 26, 2012. On February 29, 2012, plaintiffs in the Correa and Sanchez Actions filed Notices of Related Case, seeking to relate the actions to the Wardlaw Action and the interpleader. At this state of the cases, the Company has not established an accrual for probable losses as the probability of a material adverse result cannot be determined and the Company cannot reasonably estimate a range of potential exposures, if any. The Company intends to defend the actions vigorously.

On September 23, 2011, the Bank filed a Complaint-in-Interpleader in the Superior Court of the State of California, County of Los Angeles (Case No. BC470182), pursuant to which the Bank interplead the sum of $2,539,049.27 as the amounts on deposit in accounts at the Bank that were controlled by Ms. Durkee on behalf of the several hundred named defendants (the “Interpleader Action”). On December 6, 2011, the Interpleader Action was designated as complex and transferred to the Superior Court’s complex litigation division. The Interpleader Action is stayed pending a status conference scheduled for March 26, 2012. On November 18, 2011, Defendants Ted Lieu, as Treasurer for Ted Lieu for Assembly 2008, Ted Lieu for State Senate 2011, Ted Lieu for State Senate 2014, Friends of Lieu 2010, Friends of Ted Lieu, and Assembly Ted Lieu Office Holder Account (the “Lieu Defendants”) filed a cross-complaint against the Bank and other defendants named in the Wardlaw Action, including Ms. Durkee, alleging substantially the same facts and causes of action as plaintiffs in the Wardlaw, Correa and Sanchez Actions. On March 5, 2012, the Lieu Defendants entered a request for dismissal of their cross-complaint.

 
102

 
 
NOTE 23—REGULATORY MATTERS

The Company is subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal and state banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum requirements can initiate certain mandatory — and possibly additional discretionary — actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on a company’s financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines, bank holding companies must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the company’s assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. Capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the following table) of Total and Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined), and of Tier 1 capital to average assets (as defined). Management believes, as of December 31, 2011, that the Company meets all capital adequacy requirements to which it is subject.

The preferred stock Series C shares issued to the U.S. Treasury under the SBLF program qualify as Tier 1 capital.

The following tables present the capital amounts and ratios of the Company with a comparison to the minimum ratios for the periods indicated:

   
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
   
(in thousands)
December 31, 2011
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
Total capital
  $ 194,694       17.32 %   $ 89,924  
8.00%
(to risk weighted assets)
                       
 
Tier I capital
  $ 180,597       16.07 %   $ 44,962  
≥ 4.00%
(to risk weighted assets)
                       
 
Tier I capital
  $ 180,597       10.33 %   $ 69,906  
≥ 4.00%
(to average assets)
                       
 
 
 
103

 

 
 
 
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
 
 
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
 
 
(in thousands)
December 31, 2010
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
Total capital
  $ 172,599       16.79 %   $ 82,242  
≥ 8.00%
(to risk weighted assets)
                       
 
Tier I capital
  $ 159,695       15.53 %   $ 41,121  
≥ 4.00%
(to risk weighted assets)
                       
 
Tier I capital
  $ 159,695       11.00 %   $ 58,052  
≥ 4.00%
(to average assets)
                       
 
 
Common stockholders are entitled to receive dividends when and as declared by the Board of Directors, out of funds legally available therefore, subject to the restrictions set forth in the Delaware General Corporation Law, or the DGCL. The DGCL provides that a corporation may declare and pay dividends out of any surplus, and, if it has no surplus, out of any net profits for the fiscal year in which the dividend was declared or for the preceding fiscal year (provided that the payment will not reduce capital to an amount less than the aggregate amount of the capital represented by the issued and outstanding stock of all classes having a preference upon the distribution of assets). In addition, First California may not pay dividends on its capital stock if it is in default or has elected to defer payments of interest under its junior subordinated debentures.

The Bank is also subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal and state banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum requirements can initiate certain mandatory — and possibly additional discretionary — actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on a company’s financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, banks must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the Bank’s assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. Capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the following table) of Total and Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined), and of Tier 1 capital to average assets (as defined). Management believes, as of December 31, 2011, that the Bank meets all capital adequacy requirements to which it is subject.

As of December 31, 2011, the Bank was categorized as well-capitalized under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action. To be categorized as well-capitalized, the Bank must maintain minimum Total risk-based capital, Tier 1 risk-based capital, and Tier 1 leverage capital ratios as set forth in the table below. There are no conditions or events since December 31, 2011 that management believes may have changed the Bank’s category.

The following tables present the capital amounts and ratios of the Bank with a comparison to the minimum ratios for the periods indicated:

   
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy
Purposes
 
To be Well
Capitalized Under
Prompt Corrective
Action Provision
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
   
(in thousands)
December 31, 2011
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total capital
  $ 192,227       17.10 %   $ 89,944  
≥ 8.00%
  $ 112,430  
≥ 10.00%
(to risk weighted assets)
                       
 
       
 
Tier I capital
  $ 178,126       15.84 %   $ 44,972  
≥ 4.00%
  $ 67,458  
≥ 6.00%
(to risk weighted assets)
                       
 
       
 
Tier I capital
  $ 178,126       10.18 %   $ 69,968  
≥ 4.00%
  $ 87,460  
≥ 5.00%
(to average assets)
                       
 
       
 
 
 
104

 
 
 
 
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy
Purposes
 
To be Well
Capitalized Under
Prompt Corrective
Action Provision
 
 
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
 
(in thousands)
December 31, 2010
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total capital
  $ 167,395       16.31 %   $ 82,090  
≥ 8.00%
  $ 102,613  
≥ 10.00%
(to risk weighted assets)
                       
 
       
 
Tier I capital
  $ 154,515       15.06 %   $ 41,045  
≥ 4.00%
  $ 61,568  
≥ 6.00%
(to risk weighted assets)
                       
 
       
 
Tier I capital
  $ 154,515       10.63 %   $ 58,134  
≥ 4.00%
  $ 72,668  
≥ 5.00%
(to average assets)
                       
 
       
 
 
The Bank is subject to various federal or state statutory and regulatory restrictions on its ability to pay dividends and capital distributions to its shareholder.

Under California law, banks may declare a cash dividend out of their net profits up to the lesser of retained earnings or the net income for the last three fiscal years (less any distributions made to shareholders during such period), or with the prior written approval of the DFI, in an amount not exceeding the greatest of (i) the retained earnings of the Bank, (ii) the net income of the Bank for its last fiscal year or (iii) the net income of the Bank for its current fiscal year. In addition, under federal law, banks are prohibited from paying any dividends if after making such payment they would fail to meet any of the minimum regulatory capital requirements. The federal regulators also have the authority to prohibit state banks from engaging in any business practices which are considered to be unsafe or unsound, and in some circumstances the regulators might prohibit the payment of dividends on that basis even though such payments would otherwise be permissible.

The Bank may from time to time be permitted to make additional capital distributions to its shareholder with the consent of the DFI. It is not anticipated that such consent could be obtained unless the distributing bank were to remain “well capitalized” following such distribution.

In February 2010, the Board of Directors of the Company and the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco, or the Reserve Bank, entered into an informal agreement, or the informal agreement, between the Company and the Reserve Bank. The informal agreement required the Board to take all appropriate steps to fully utilize its financial and managerial resources to assist the Company and the Bank in functioning in a safe and sound manner pursuant to Regulation Y of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System. It also restricted the ability of the Company to: (a) receive dividends or any other form of payment or distribution representing a reduction of capital from the Bank without the prior written approval from the Reserve Bank; (b) declare or pay dividends, make any payments on trust preferred securities, or make any other capital distributions, without the prior written approval of the Reserve Bank; (c) directly or indirectly incur, renew, increase or guarantee any debt, without prior written approval of the Reserve Bank; (d) directly or indirectly issue any trust preferred securities without the prior written approval of the Reserve Bank; and (e) purchase, redeem, or otherwise acquire, directly or indirectly, any of its stock without the prior written approval of the Reserve Bank. The Reserve Bank terminated the informal agreement in January 2011. The Company complied fully with the agreement and had received approval to pay all dividends on the Series B Preferred Stock and all payments on its trust preferred securities during the term of the agreement.

NOTE 24—FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

The accounting framework for fair value measurements defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value under GAAP, and expands disclosures about fair value measurement. This standard applies to all financial assets and liabilities that are being measured and reported at fair value on a recurring and non-recurring basis.

Fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. The following table presents information about the Company’s assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring and non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2011 and indicates the fair value hierarchy of the valuation techniques utilized by the Company to determine such fair value. In general, fair values determined by Level 1 inputs utilize quoted prices (unadjusted) for identical instruments that are highly liquid, observable and actively traded in over-the-counter markets. Fair values determined by Level 2 inputs utilize inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. Level 2 inputs include quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active and model-derived valuations whose inputs are observable and can be corroborated by market data. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs that are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant to the fair value of the assets or liabilities. In certain cases, the inputs used to measure fair value may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy. In such cases, the level in the fair value hierarchy within which the fair value measurement in its entirety falls has been determined based on the lowest level input tat is significant to the fair value measurement in its entirety. The Company’s assessment of the significance of a particular input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires judgment, and considers factors specific to the asset or liability.

 
105

 
 
The Company uses fair value to measure certain assets and liabilities on a recurring basis when fair value is the primary measure for accounting. This is done primarily for available-for-sale securities and derivatives. Fair value is used on a nonrecurring basis to measure certain assets when applying lower of cost or market accounting or when adjusting carrying values, such as for loans held for sale, impaired loans, and other real estate owned. Fair value is also used when evaluating impairment on certain assets, including securities, goodwill, core deposit and other intangibles, for valuing assets and liabilities acquired in a business combination and for disclosures of financial instruments as required by accounting standards related to fair value disclosure reporting.

The following tables present information on the assets measured and recorded at fair value on a recurring and nonrecurring basis at and for the year ended December 31, 2011.

   
 
   
Financial Assets Measured at Fair Value on a
Recurring Basis at
December 31, 2011, Using
 
   
Fair value at
December 31, 2011
   
Quoted prices in
active markets
for identical
assets
(Level 1)
   
Other
observable
inputs
(Level 2)
   
Significant
unobservable
inputs
(Level 3)
 
   
(in thousands)
 
U.S. Treasury notes/bills
  $ 45,161     $     $ 45,161     $  
U.S. government agency notes
    59,446             59,446        
U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities
    133,675             133,675        
U.S. government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
    168,174             168,174        
Private label collateralized mortgage obligations
    13,042             13,042        
Municipal securities
    29,325             29,325        
Other domestic debt securities
    4,912             4,912        
Interest rate caps
    466             466        
Total assets measured at fair value
  $ 454,201     $     $ 454,201     $  
 
   
 
   
Financial Assets Measured at Fair Value on a
Non-Recurring Basis at
December 31, 2011, Using
   
 
 
   
Fair value at
December 31, 2011
   
Quoted prices in
active markets
for identical
assets
(Level 1)
   
Other
observable
inputs
(Level 2)
   
Significant
unobservable
inputs
(Level 3)
   
Total
losses
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Non-covered impaired loans
  $ 8,066     $     $     $ 8,066     $ (622 )
Non-covered foreclosed property
    20,349                   20,349       (5,770 )
Covered foreclosed property
    14,616                   14,616        
Total assets measured at fair value
  $ 43,031     $     $     $ 43,031     $ (6,290 )
 
 
106

 
 
The following tables present information on the assets measured and recorded at fair value on a recurring and nonrecurring basis at and for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
   
 
   
Financial Assets Measured at Fair Value on a
Recurring Basis at
December 31, 2010, Using
 
   
Fair value at
December 31, 2010
   
Quoted prices in
active markets
for identical
assets
(Level 1)
   
Other
observable
inputs
(Level 2)
   
Significant
unobservable
inputs
(Level 3)
 
   
(in thousands)
 
U.S. Treasury notes/bills
  $ 51,154     $     $ 51,154     $  
U.S. government agency notes
    58,917             58,917        
U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities
    47,325             47,325        
U.S. government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
    89,880             89,880        
Private label collateralized mortgage obligations
    16,894             16,894        
Municipal securities
    3,002             3,002        
Other domestic debt securities
    5,267             5,267        
Interest rate caps
    697             697        
Total assets measured at fair value
  $ 273,136     $     $ 273,136     $  

   
 
   
Financial Assets Measured at Fair Value on a
Non-Recurring Basis at
December 31, 2010, Using
   
 
 
   
Fair value at
December 31, 2010
   
Quoted prices in
active markets
for identical
assets
(Level 1)
   
Other
observable
inputs
(Level 2)
   
Significant
unobservable
inputs
(Level 3)
   
Total
losses
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Non-covered impaired loans
  $ 10,526     $     $     $ 10,526     $ (4,395 )
Non-covered foreclosed property
    26,011                   26,011       (1,481 )
Covered foreclosed property
    977                   977        
Total assets measured at fair value
  $ 37,514     $     $     $ 37,514     $ (5,876 )
 
The following methods were used to estimate the fair value of each class of financial instrument above:

Available-for-sale securities—Fair values for securities are based on quoted market prices of identical securities, where available (Level 1). When quoted prices of identical securities are not available, the fair value estimate is based on quoted market prices of similar securities, adjusted for differences between the securities (Level 2). Adjustments may include amounts to reflect differences in underlying collateral, interest rates, estimated prepayment speeds, and counterparty credit quality. In determining the fair value the securities categorized as Level 2, the Company obtains a report from a nationally recognized broker-dealer detailing the fair value of each security in our portfolio as of each reporting date. The broker-dealer uses observable market information to value our securities, with the primary source being a nationally recognized pricing service. The Company reviews the market prices provided by the broker-dealer for our securities for reasonableness based upon our understanding of the marketplace and we consider any credit issues relating to the bonds. As the Company has not made any adjustments to the market quotes provided to us and they are based on observable market data, they have been categorized as Level 2 within the fair value hierarchy.

Non-covered and covered impaired loans—Impaired loans are measured and recorded at the fair value of the loan’s collateral on a nonrecurring basis as the impaired loans shown are collateral dependent. The fair value of each loan’s collateral is generally based on estimated market prices from an independently prepared appraisal, which is then adjusted for the cost related to liquidating such collateral; such valuation inputs result in a nonrecurring fair value measurement that is categorized as a Level 3 measurement.

Non-covered and covered foreclosed property—Foreclosed property is initially measured at fair value at acquisition and carried at the lower of this new cost basis or fair value on a nonrecurring basis. The foreclosed property shown is collateral dependent and, accordingly, is measured based on the fair value of such collateral. The fair value of collateral is generally based on estimated market prices from an independently prepared appraisal, which is then adjusted for the estimated cost related to liquidating such collateral; such valuation inputs result in a nonrecurring fair value measurement that is categorized as a Level 3 measurement.

The Company is required to disclose estimated fair values for our financial instruments during annual and interim reporting periods. Fair value estimates, methods and assumptions, set forth below for our financial instruments, are made solely to comply with the requirements of the disclosures regarding fair value of financial instruments. The following describes the methods and assumptions used in estimating the fair values of financial instruments, excluding financial instruments already recorded at fair value as described above.

 
107

 
 
Cash and cash equivalents— The carrying amounts of cash and interest bearing deposits at other banks is assumed to be the fair value given the liquidity and short-term nature of these deposits.

Non-covered and covered loans—Loans are not measured at fair value on a recurring basis. Therefore, the following valuation discussion relates to estimating the fair value to be disclosed under fair value disclosure requirements. Loans were divided into four major groups. The loan groups included (1) loans that mature or re-price in three months or less, (2) loans that amortize or mature in more than three months, (3) impaired loans, and (4) loans acquired in the Western Commercial Bank and San Luis Trust Bank acquisistions. We estimated the fair value of the loans that mature or re-price within three months, impaired loans and loans acquired in the Western Commercial Bank and San Luis Trust Bank acquisitions at their carrying value. We used discounted cash flow methodology to estimate the fair value of loans that amortize or mature in more than three months. We developed pools of these loans based on similar characteristics such as underlying type of collateral, fixed or adjustable rate of interest, payment or amortization method, credit risk categories and other factors. We projected monthly principal and interest cash flows based on the contractual terms of the loan, adjusted for assumed prepayments and defaults, and discounted these at a rate that considered funding costs, a market participant’s required rate of return and adjusted for servicing costs and a liquidity discount. Loans are not normally purchased and sold by the Company, and there are no active trading markets for much of this portfolio.

FDIC shared-loss asset—The fair value of the FDIC shared-loss asset represents the present value of the amounts we expect to receive from the FDIC under our shared-loss agreements and is based upon estimated cash flows from our covered assets discounted by a rate reflective of the creditworthiness of the FDIC as would be required by market.

Bank owned life insurance assets—Fair values of insurance policies owned are based on the insurance contract’s cash surrender value.

Interest rate caps—The fair values of interest rate caps are estimated using the market standard methodology of discounting the future expected cash receipts that would occur if variable interest rates rise above the strike rate of the caps. The variable interest rates used in the calculations of projected receipts on the caps are based on an expectation of future interest rates derived from observable market interest rates curves and volatilities. In addition, the Company incorporates credit valuation adjustments to appropriately reflect nonperformance risk in the fair value measurements of its derivatives. The credit valuation adjustments are calculated by determining the total expected exposure of the derivatives (which incorporates both the current and potential future exposure) and then applying the counterparties’ credit spreads to the exposure. The total expected exposure of a derivative is derived using market-observable inputs, such as yield curves and volatilities. For the counterparties’ credit spreads, the credit spreads over LIBOR used in the calculations represent implied credit default swap spreads obtained from a third party credit data provider. In adjusting the estimated fair value of its derivative contracts for the effect of nonperformance risk, the Company has considered the impact of netting and any applicable credit enhancements.

Deposits—The fair values disclosed for demand deposits are, by definition, equal to the amount payable on demand at the reporting date (that is, their carrying amounts). The carrying amounts of variable-rate money market accounts and fixed-term certificates of deposit (CDs) approximate their fair values at the reporting date. Fair values for fixed-rate CDs are estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies interest rates currently being offered on certificates to a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on time deposits.

Federal Home Loan Bank advances and other borrowings—The fair value of the FHLB advances and other borrowings is estimated using a discounted cash flow analysis based on the Company’s current incremental borrowing rates for similar types of borrowing arrangements.

Junior subordinated debentures—The fair value of the debentures is estimated using a discounted cash flow analysis based on current incremental borrowing rates for similar types of borrowing arrangements.

Off-balance sheet instruments—Off-balance sheet instruments include unfunded commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit. The fair value of these instruments is not considered practicable to estimate because of the lack of quoted market prices and the inability to estimate fair value without incurring excessive costs.

 
108

 
 
The following table estimates fair values and the related carrying amounts of the Company’s financial instruments:

   
For the years ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
Carrying
Amount
   
Estimated
Fair Value
   
Carrying
Amount
   
Estimated
Fair Value
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Financial assets:
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
Cash, due from banks and interest bearing deposits with other banks
  $ 61,432     $ 61,432     $ 88,003     $ 88,003  
Securities available-for-sale
    453,735       453,735       272,439       272,439  
FHLB and other stock
    11,567       11,567       9,458       9,458  
Bank owned life insurance assets
    12,670       12,670       12,232       12,232  
Non-covered loans, net
    918,356       822,081       930,704       777,059  
Covered loans
    135,412       137,147       53,878       53,878  
FDIC shared-loss asset
    68,083       68,083       16,725       16,725  
Interest rate cap
    466       466       697       697  
Financial liabilities:
                               
Demand deposits, money market and savings
  $ 1,075,233     $ 1,075,233     $ 808,575     $ 808,575  
Time certificates of deposit
    350,036       351,815       347,713       350,787  
FHLB advances and other borrowings
    117,719       123,375       131,500       137,485  
Junior subordinated debentures
    26,805       14,173       26,805       14,617  
FDIC shared-loss liability
    3,757       3,757       988       988  
 
 
109

 
 
    These fair value disclosures represent the Company’s best estimates based on relevant market information and information about the financial instruments. Fair value estimates are based on judgments regarding future expected loss experience, current economic conditions, risk characteristics of the various instruments, and other factors. These estimates are subjective in nature and involve uncertainties and matters of significant judgment and therefore cannot be determined with precision. Changes in the above methodologies and assumptions could significantly affect the estimates.

NOTE 25—SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

On February 28, 2012, the Bank entered into a definitive agreement and plan of merger to acquire Premier Service Bank, a state-chartered commercial bank headquartered in Riverside, California for $2.0 million. As part of the merger, the Bank will acquire certain assets and assume certain liabilities and substantially all of the operations, including two full-service branches located in Riverside and Corona, California, of Premier Service Bank. The Bank will acquire approximately $140 million of assets, including $104 million of loans related to the transaction. The Bank will assume approximately $112 million of deposits related to the transaction. The transaction is expected to close in the third quarter of 2012.
   
    On February 28, 2012, the Company announced plans to realign branch offices within its banking regions, which includes the closing and consolidation of four branches located in Brea, Temecula, Thousand Oaks and Woodland Hills. The closing of the branches, which is scheduled for mid-year 2012, will result in pre-tax cost savings of approximately $1.4 million in 2012 and $2.7 million annually, thereafter. One-time charges related to the branch consolidation are not expected to be material.

NOTE 26—PARENT COMPANY ONLY FINANCIAL INFORMATION

The following financial information presents the condensed balance sheet of the Company on a parent-only basis as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related condensed statements of operations and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2011.

Balance Sheet
 
   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Cash and due from banks
  $ 3,218     $ 4,500  
Investment in subsidiary bank
    246,977       218,924  
Other assets
    1,991       2,740  
 
               
Total assets
  $ 252,186     $ 226,164  
 
               
Junior subordinated debentures
  $ 26,805     $ 26,805  
Other liabilities
    2,274       1,318  
 
               
Total liabilities
    29,079       28,123  
                 
Shareholders’ equity:
               
Preferred stock
    26,000       24,627  
Common stock
    292       282  
Additional paid-in-capital
    173,062       175,102  
Treasury stock
          (3,061 )
Retained earnings
    25,427       4,827  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
    (1,674 )     (3,736 )
 
               
Total shareholders’ equity
    223,107       198,041  
 
               
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
  $ 252,186     $ 226,164  

 
110

 

Statements of Operations

   
Year ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Interest income
  $ 88     $ 121     $ 204  
Interest expense
    1,342       1,736       1,884  
 Net interest expense
    (1,254 )     (1,615 )     (1,680 )
Other operating income
                 
Other operating expense
    2,757       1,278       2,590  
 Loss before equity in net income (loss) of the Bank
    (4,011 )     (2,893 )     (4,270 )
Equity in net income (loss) of subsidiaries
    25,712       3,340       (1,925 )
Income (loss) before income tax benefit
    21,701       447       (6,195 )
Income tax benefit
    (1,682 )     (963 )     (1,534 )
Net income (loss)
  $ 23,383     $ 1,410     $ (4,661 )
 
Statements of Cash Flow

   
Year ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Cash flows from operating activities:
                 
Net income (loss)
  $ 23,383     $ 1,410     $ (4,661 )
Adjustment to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:
                       
Equity in (net income) loss of subsidiaries, net
    (25,712 )     (3,340 )     1,925  
Stock-based compensation costs
    1,630       542       1,018  
Net increase (decrease) in other assets and other liabilities
    1,113       (190 )     900  
Net cash provided by (used in) operations
    414       (1,578 )     (818 )
Cash flows from investing activities:
                       
Investment in subsidiary
          (36,000 )     (29,500 )
Net cash used in investing activities
          (36,000 )     (29,500 )
Cash flows from financing activities:
                       
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
                14  
Issuance of common stock
          38,091        
Repurchase of warrant
    (599 )            
Purchases of treasury stock
                (11 )
Dividends paid on preferred stock
    (1,097 )     (1,250 )     (1,132 )
Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities
    (1,696 )     36,841       (1,129 )
Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents
    (1,282 )     (737 )     (31,447 )
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year
    4,500       5,237       36,684  
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year
  $ 3,218     $ 4,500     $ 5,237  
Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information:
                       
Cash paid for interest
  $ 1,317     $ 1,755     $ 1,756  
Cash paid for income taxes, net
  $ 8,200     $ 1,000     $ (2,643 )
 
 
111

 

NOTE 27 — QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (Unaudited)

The following tables present the unaudited quarterly financial data for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009:

   
2011 Quarters
   
2010 Quarters
   
2009 Quarters
 
                                                                         
   
4th
   
3rd
   
2nd
   
1st
   
4th
   
3rd
   
2nd
   
1st
   
4th
   
3rd
   
2nd
   
1st
 
       
   
(in thousands, except per share data)
 
       
Net interest income
  $ 15,597     $ 15,618     $ 15,500     $ 12,779     $ 12,110     $ 11,107     $ 10,806     $ 10,673     $ 11,091     $ 11,396     $ 11,897     $ 10,670  
                                                                                                 
Service charges, fees & other income
    2,488       2,091       2,234       1,239       1,199       1,116       1,824       1,079       1,232       1,291       1,304       1,244  
                                                                                                 
Gain on acquisitions
    1,720             466       34,736       2,312                                            
                                                                                                 
Gain (loss) on securities
    2       209       490       (1,066 )     (160 )     1,181       130       114       1,217       1,639       1,435       671  
                                                                                                 
Operating expenses
    14,101       12,033       14,017       18,313       12,453       9,684       10,751       9,916       11,909       11,294       12,876       10,777  
                                                                                                 
Provision for loan losses
    796       1,550       500       2,500       1,199       3,618       1,766       1,754       6,350       4,117       1,110       5,069  
                                                                                                 
Income (loss) before income tax
    4,910       4,335       4,173       26,875       1,809       102       243       196       (4,719 )     (1,085 )     650       (3,261 )
Income tax provision
    2,048       1,819       1,756       11,287       727       38       96       79       (1,855 )     (949 )     433       (1,383 )
Net income (loss)
  $ 2,862     $ 2,516     $ 2,417     $ 15,588     $ 1,082     $ 64     $ 147     $ 117     $ (2,864 )   $ (136 )   $ 217     $ (1,878 )
                                                                                                 
Earnings (loss) per common share:
                                                                                               
                                                                                                 
Basic
  $ 0.09     $ 0.03     $ 0.07     $ 0.54     $ 0.03     $ (0.01 )   $ (0.01 )   $ (0.02 )   $ (0.27 )   $ (0.04 )   $ (0.04 )   $ (0.18 )
                                                                                                 
Diluted
  $ 0.09     $ 0.03     $ 0.07     $ 0.54     $ 0.03     $ (0.01 )   $ (0.01 )   $ (0.02 )   $ (0.27 )   $ (0.04 )   $ (0.04 )   $ (0.18 )

 
112

 

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosures

None.

Controls and Procedures

(a) Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures: An evaluation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) was carried out under the supervision and with the participation of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer, Chief Operating Officer/Chief Financial Officer and several other members of the Company’s senior management as of the end of the period covered by this report. Based upon that evaluation, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Operating Officer/Chief Financial Officer concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures as currently in effect are effective.

(b) Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting: The management of First California Financial Group, Inc., or First California or the Company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. The Company’s internal control system was designed to provide reasonable assurance to the Company’s management and Board of Directors regarding the preparation and fair presentation of published financial statements in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles. All internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations. Therefore, even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation.

Management maintains a comprehensive system of controls intended to ensure that transactions are executed in accordance with management’s authorization, assets are safeguarded, and financial records are reliable. Management also takes steps to see that information and communication flows are effective and to monitor performance, including performance of internal control procedures.

As of December 31, 2011, First California management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on the framework established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based on this assessment, management has determined that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, is effective.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements should they occur. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree or compliance with the control procedures may deteriorate.

Moss Adams LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, has issued their report on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011.

    (c) Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm:

    The effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, has been audited by Moss Adams LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report, which is included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
(d) Changes in Internal Controls: There was no change in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting during the Company’s most recently completed fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Other Information

None.
 
 
114

 
 
PART III

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Information required by this Item will appear in the proxy statement to be delivered to our stockholders in connection with the 2012 annual meeting of stockholders, or the 2012 Proxy Statement, and such information is herein incorporated by reference from the 2012 Proxy Statement.

Executive Compensation

Information required by this Item will appear in the 2012 Proxy Statement, and such information is herein incorporated by reference from the 2012 Proxy Statement.

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

Information required by this Item will appear in the 2012 Proxy Statement, and such information is herein incorporated by reference from the 2012 Proxy Statement.

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

Information required by this Item will appear in the 2012 Proxy Statement, and such information is herein incorporated by reference from the 2012 Proxy Statement.

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

Information required by this Item will appear in the 2012 Proxy Statement, and such information is herein incorporated by reference from the 2012 Proxy Statement.

PART IV

Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules
 
(a)(1)
The following consolidated financial statements of First California Financial Group, Inc. are filed as part of this Annual Report.
   
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010
 
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
 
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
 
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
 
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
   
(a)(2)
Financial Statement Schedules
   
 
Financial statement schedules other than those listed above have been omitted because they are either not applicable or the information is otherwise included.
   
(a)(3)
Exhibits. The following is a list of exhibits filed as a part of this Annual Report.

 
115

 

The agreements included as exhibits to this Annual Report on Form 10-K contain representations and warranties by each of the parties to the applicable agreement. These representations and warranties have been made solely for the benefit of the other parties to the applicable agreement and:

 
should not be treated as categorical statements of fact, but rather as a way of allocating the risk to one of the parties if those statements prove to be inaccurate;
     
 
may have been qualified in such agreement by disclosures that were made to the other party in connection with the negotiation of the applicable agreement;
     
 
may apply contract standards of “materiality” that are different from “materiality” under the applicable securities laws; and
     
 
were made only as of the date of the applicable agreement or such other date or dates as may be specified in the agreement.

First California acknowledges that, notwithstanding the inclusion of the foregoing cautionary statements, it is responsible for considering whether additional specific disclosures of material information regarding material contractual provisions are required to make the statements in this Form 10-K not misleading.

Additional information about the Company may be found elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K and in the Company’s other public filings, which are available without charge through the SEC’s Web site at www.sec.gov.

Exhibit
Number
 
Description
     
2.1
 
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of June 15, 2006, by and among First California Financial Group, Inc., FCB Bancorp and National Mercantile Bancorp (Appendix A to the Joint Proxy Statement-Prospectus filed on February 21, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
2.2
 
Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of January 23, 2009, by and among the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, as Receiver of 1st Centennial Bank, First California Bank and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (Exhibit 2.2 to Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on December 8, 2009 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by reference).
     
2.3
 
Purchase and Assumption Agreement-Whole Bank, All Deposits, dated as of November 5, 2010, among the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, Receiver of Western Commercial Bank, Woodland Hills, California, the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and First California Bank (Exhibit 2.1 to Form 8-K filed on November 12, 2010 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
2.4
 
Purchase and Assumption Agreement-Whole Bank, All Deposits, among the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, Receiver of San Luis Trust Bank, San Luis Obispo, California, the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and First California Bank, dated as of February 18, 2011 (Exhibit 2.1 to Form 8-K filed on February 25, 2011 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
3.1
 
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of First California Financial Group, Inc. (filed herewith).
     
3.2
 
Amended and Restated By-Laws of First California Financial Group, Inc. (Exhibit 3.2 to Form 10-Q filed on August 13, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
3.3
 
Certificate of Designations with respect to the Series A Preferred Stock (included in Exhibit 3.1).
     
3.4
 
Certificate of Designations with respect to the Series B Preferred Stock (Exhibit 3.1 to Form 8-K filed on December 22, 2008 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
3.5
 
Certificate of Designations with respect to the Series C Preferred Stock (Exhibit 4.2 to Form 8-K filed on July 15, 2011 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
4.1
 
Indenture, dated as of September 30, 2005, governing Fixed/Floating Rate Junior Subordinated Deferrable Interest Debentures due 2035, between FCB Bancorp, as Issuer, and Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee (Exhibit 4.1 to Form 8-K filed on October 27, 2005 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
4.2
 
First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of March 12, 2007, by and between First California Financial Group, Inc., as Successor to FCB Bancorp, and Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee (Exhibit 4.3 to Form 10-K filed on April 2, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
 
 
 
 
 
116

 
 
Exhibit
Number
 
Description
     
4.3
 
Indenture, dated as of January 25, 2007, governing Fixed/Floating Rate Junior Subordinated Deferrable Interest Debentures due 2037, between National Mercantile Bancorp, and Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee (Exhibit 10.4 to Form 8-K filed on January 30, 2007 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
4.4
 
First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of March 12, 2007, by and between First California Financial Group, Inc., as Successor to National Mercantile, and Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee (Exhibit 4.5 to Form 10-K filed on April 2, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
4.5
 
Specimen of Common Stock Certificate. (Exhibit 4.3 to Form S-8 filed on March 19, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
4.6
 
Form of Capital Security Certificate evidencing the capital securities of First California Capital Trust I (Exhibit 4.1 to Form 8-K filed on January 30, 2007 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
4.7
 
Form of Common Security Certificate evidencing common securities of First California Capital Trust I (Exhibit 4.3 to Form 8-K filed on January 30, 2007 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
4.8
 
Form of National Mercantile Bancorp Fixed/Floating Rate Junior Subordinated Deferrable Interest Debenture due 2037 (Exhibit 4.2 to Form 8-K filed on January 30, 2007 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
4.9
 
Warrant to purchase up to 599,042 shares of Common Stock, issued on December 19, 2008 (Exhibit 4.2 to Form 8-K filed on December 22, 2008 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
4.10
 
Form of Certificate for the Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B (Exhibit 4.3 to the Registration Statement on Form S-3 filed on January 16, 2009 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
4.11
 
Form of Certificate for the Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C (filed herewith).
     
10.1*
 
Employment Agreement, dated January 1, 1999, between National Mercantile Bancorp and Scott A. Montgomery (Exhibit 10.1 to Form S-4/A filed on December 5, 2006 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.2*
 
Letter dated June 15, 2006 amending Employment Agreement between National Mercantile Bancorp and Scott A. Montgomery (Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K filed on June 21, 2006 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.3*
 
Employment Agreement, dated June 15, 2006, between First California Financial Group, Inc. and C. G. Kum (Exhibit 99.2 to Form 8-K filed on June 21, 2006 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.4*
 
First California Financial Group, Inc. 2005 NMB Stock Incentive Plan (formerly known as the National Mercantile Bancorp 2005 Stock Incentive Plan) (Exhibit 4.1 to Form S-8 filed on May 25, 2005 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.5*
 
Amendment No. 1 to First California Financial Group, Inc. 2005 NMB Stock Incentive Plan (formerly known as the National Mercantile Bancorp 2005 Stock Incentive Plan) (Exhibit 10.7 to Form S-8 filed on March 19, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
 
 
117

 
 
Exhibit
Number
 
Description
     
10.6*
 
Form of Stock Option Agreement under First California Financial Group, Inc. 2005 NMB Stock Incentive Plan (formerly known as the National Mercantile 2005 Stock Incentive Plan) (Exhibit 10.1 to Form S-8 filed on May 25, 2005 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.7*
 
Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement under the First California Financial Group, Inc. 2005 NMB Stock Incentive Plan (formerly known as the National Mercantile 2005 Stock Incentive Plan) (Exhibit 10.2 to Form S-8 filed on May 25, 2005 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.8*
 
First California Financial Group, Inc. 1994 NMB Stock Option Plan (formerly known as National Mercantile Bancorp 1994 Stock Option Plan) (Exhibit 10.7 to Form S-4 filed on October 23, 2006 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.9*
 
Amendment No. 1 to First California Financial Group, Inc. 1994 NMB Stock Option Plan (formerly known as the National Mercantile Bancorp 1994 Stock Option Plan) (Exhibit 10.4 to Form S-8 filed on March 19, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.10*
 
Form of Stock Option Agreement under the First California Financial Group, Inc. 1994 NMB Stock Option Plan (formerly known as the National Mercantile Bancorp 1994 Stock Option Plan) (Exhibit 10.8 to Form S-4 filed on October 23, 2006 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.11*
 
First California Financial Group, Inc. FCB 2005 Stock Option Plan (formerly known as the FCB Bancorp 2005 Stock Option Plan) (Exhibit 10.1 to Form S-4/A filed on September 1, 2005 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.12*
 
Amendment No. 1 to First California Financial Group, Inc. FCB 2005 Stock Option Plan (formerly known as the FCB Bancorp 2005 Stock Option Plan) (Exhibit 10.2 to Form S-8 filed on March 19, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.13*
 
First California 2007 Omnibus Equity Incentive Plan (Appendix B to the Proxy Statement filed on May 30, 2007 in connection with the 2007 annual meeting of stockholders and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.14
 
Registration Rights Agreement, dated June 15, 2006, by and between First California Financial Group, Inc. and the Stockholders party thereto (Exhibit 10.10 to Form S-4 filed on October 23, 2006 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.15
 
Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust of National Mercantile Capital Trust I, dated as of June 27, 2001 (Exhibit 10.11 to Form S-4/A filed on January 11, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.16
 
Guarantee Agreement of National Mercantile Bancorp for trust preferred securities dated July 16, 2001 (Exhibit 10.12 to Form S-4/A filed on January 11, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.17
 
Lease, dated as of November 12, 2003, between Century Park and Mercantile National Bank relating to Suite 800 offices at 1880 Century Park East, Los Angeles, California (Exhibit 10.10 to Form 10-KSB filed on March 30, 2004 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
 
 
118

 
 
Exhibit
Number
 
Description
     
10.18
 
Lease, dated as of September 19, 2003, between Metropolitan Life Insurance Company and Mercantile National Bank relating to offices at 3070 Bristol Street, Costa Mesa, California (Exhibit 10.11 to Form 10-KSB filed on March 31, 2005 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.19
 
Lease, dated as of November 12, 2003, between Century Park and Mercantile National Bank relating to ground floor offices at 1880 Century Park East, Los Angeles, California (Exhibit 10.12 to Form 10-KSB filed on March 31, 2005 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.20
 
Lease, dated as of March 30, 2005, between Brighton Enterprises, LLC and Mercantile National Bank relating to offices at 9601 Wilshire Boulevard, Beverly Hills, California (Exhibit 10.13 to Form 10-KSB filed on March 31, 2005 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.21
 
Lease, dated as of September 10, 2004, between Encino Corporate Plaza, LP and Mercantile National Bank relating to offices at 16661 Ventura Boulevard, Encino, California (Exhibit 10.14 to Form 10-KSB filed on March 31, 2005 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.22*
 
Mercantile National Bank Deferred Compensation Plan and Form of Agreement (Exhibit 10.15 to Form 10-KSB filed on March 31, 2005 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.23*
 
Salary Continuation Agreement, dated March 27, 2003, with Chong Guk Kum (Exhibit 10.4 to Form S-4/A filed on September 1, 2005 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by reference).
     
10.24*
 
Split Dollar Agreement, dated March 27, 2003, with Chong Guk Kum (Exhibit 10.5 to Form S-4/A filed on September 1, 2005 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by reference).
     
10.25*
 
Salary Continuation Agreement, dated May 11, 2006, with Romolo Santarosa (Exhibit 10.13 to Form 10-Q filed on May 15, 2006 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by reference).
     
10.26*
 
Split Dollar Agreement, dated May 11, 2006, with Romolo Santarosa (Exhibit 10.14 to Form 10-Q filed on May 15, 2006 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by reference).
     
10.27*
 
Salary Continuation Agreement, dated March 27, 2003, with Thomas E. Anthony (Exhibit 10.6 to Form S-4/A filed on September 1, 2005 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by reference).
     
10.28*
 
Split Dollar Agreement, dated March 27, 2003, with Thomas E. Anthony (Exhibit 10.7 to Form S-4/A filed on September 1, 2005 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by reference).
     
10.29*
 
First California Bank Split Dollar Agreement, dated July 31, 2006, with John W. Birchfield (Exhibit 99.1 to Form 8-K filed on August 2, 2006 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by reference).
     
10.30*
 
First California Bank Split Dollar Agreement, dated July 31, 2006, with Richard D. Aldridge (Exhibit 99.2 to Form 8-K filed on August 2, 2006 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by reference).
     
10.31*
 
409A Amendment to the First California Bank Salary Continuation Agreement for Chong Guk Kum (Exhibit 99.1 to Form 8-K filed on June 7, 2006 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.32*
 
409A Amendment to the First California Bank Salary Continuation Agreement for Thomas E. Anthony (Exhibit 99.2 to Form 8-K filed on June 7, 2006 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by this reference).
 
 
119

 
 
Exhibit
Number
 
Description
     
10.33
 
Placement Agreement, dated January 24, 2007, among National Mercantile Bancorp, First California Capital Trust I, FTN Financial Capital Markets and Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc. (Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K filed on January 30, 2007 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.34
 
Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust among National Mercantile Bancorp, as sponsor, the Administrators named therein, and Wilmington Trust Company, as institutional and Delaware trustee (Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K filed on January 30, 2007 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.35
 
Guarantee Agreement between National Mercantile Bancorp and Wilmington Trust Company, as guarantee trustee (Exhibit 10.3 to Form 8-K filed on January 30, 2007 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.36
 
Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust, dated as of September 30, 2005, by and among Wilmington Trust Company, as Delaware Trustee and as Institutional Trustee, FCB Bancorp, as Sponsor, and C. G. Kum and Romolo Santarosa, as Administrators (Exhibit 4.2 to Form 8-K filed on October 27, 2005 by FCB Bancorp and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.37*
 
First California Financial Group, Inc. Amended 1996 NMB Stock Incentive Plan (formerly known as the National Mercantile Bancorp Amended 1996 Stock Incentive Plan) (Exhibit 10.6 to Form 10-KSB filed on April 15, 2003 by National Mercantile Bancorp and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.38*
 
Amendment No. 1 to First California Financial Group, Inc. Amended 1996 NMB Stock Incentive Plan (formerly known as the National Mercantile Bancorp Amended 1996 Stock Incentive Plan) (Exhibit 10.6 to Form S-8 filed on March 19, 2007 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.39*
 
Form of Stock Option Agreement under the First California Financial Group, Inc. Amended 1996 NMB Stock Incentive Plan (formerly known as the National Mercantile Bancorp Amended 1996 Stock Incentive Plan) (Exhibit 10.4 to Form 10-KSB filed on March 31, 2005 by National Mercantile and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.40
 
Letter Agreement, dated December 19, 2008, including the Securities Purchase Agreement – Standard Terms incorporated by reference therein, between the Company and the U.S. Treasury (Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K filed on December 22, 2008 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.41*
 
409A Amendment to the First California Bank Salary Continuation Agreement and Split Dollar Agreement between the Bank and C. G. Kum, dated December 29, 2008 (filed as Exhibit 10.46 to Form 10-K filed on March 31, 2009 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.42*
 
409A Amendment to the First California Bank Salary Continuation Agreement and Split Dollar Agreement between the Bank and Romolo Santarosa, dated December 29, 2008 (filed as Exhibit 10.47 to Form 10-K filed on March 31, 2009 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.43*
 
409A Amendment to the First California Bank Salary Continuation Agreement and Split Dollar Agreement between the Bank and Richard Glass, dated December 29, 2008 (filed as Exhibit 10.48 to Form 10-K filed on March 31, 2009 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
 
 
120

 
 
Exhibit
Number
 
Description
     
10.44
 
Lease, dated as of November 23, 2007, between Westlake Plaza Center East, LLC and First California Bank relating to Suite 300 offices at 3027 Townsgate Road, Westlake Village, California (filed as Exhibit 10.49 to Form 10-K filed on March 31, 2009 by First California Financial Group, Inc. and incorporated herein by this reference).
     
10.45*
 
Amendment to the First California Bank Split Dollar Agreement between the Bank and C.G. Kum, dated December 16, 2009 (filed herewith).
     
10.46*
 
Split Dollar Agreement between the Bank and Edmond Sahakian, dated April 24, 2006 (filed herewith).
     
10.47*
 
Change in Control Agreement between the Bank and Romolo Santarosa, dated December 16, 2009 (filed herewith).
     
10.48*
 
Change in Control Agreement between the Bank and Edmond Sahakian, dated December 16, 2009 (filed herewith).
     
10.49*
 
Change in Control Agreement between the Bank and Cheryl Knight, dated December 16, 2009 (filed herewith).
     
10.50*
 
Change in Control Agreement between the Bank and Donald Macaulay, dated December 16, 2009 (filed herewith).
     
10.51*
 
Change in Control Agreement between the Bank and William Schack, dated December 16, 2009 (filed herewith).
     
 
     
 
     
24.1
 
Power of Attorney (included on signature page to this Annual Report on Form 10-K).
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
 
101.INS
  
XBRL Instance Document
   
101.SCH
  
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document
   
101.CAL
  
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document
   
101.DEF
  
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document
   
101.LAB
  
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document
   
101.PRE
  
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document
 

*
Indicates a management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.
 
 
121

 
 
SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
 
 
FIRST CALIFORNIA FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
       
Date: March 15, 2012
 
By:
/s/ C. G. KUM
 
 
 
C. G. Kum
Director, President and Chief Executive Officer
 
POWER OF ATTORNEY

KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints C. G. Kum and Romolo Santarosa, and each of them severally, his or her true and lawful attorney-in-fact with power of substitution and resubstitution to sign in his or her name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to do any and all things and execute any and all instruments that such attorney may deem necessary or advisable under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and any rules, regulations and requirements of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission in connection with this Annual Report on Form 10-K and any and all amendments hereto, as fully for all intents and purposes as he or she might or could do in person, and hereby ratifies and confirms all said attorneys-in-fact and agents, each acting alone, and his or her substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this registration statement has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacity and on the dates indicated:

Signature
 
Title
 
Date
         
/S/ C. G. KUM
 
Director, President and Chief
 
March 15, 2012
C. G. Kum
 
Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)
   
         
         
/S/ ROMOLO SANTAROSA
 
Senior Executive Vice President and
 
March 15, 2012
Romolo Santarosa
 
Chief Operating Officer/Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer and Principal Accounting Officer)
   
         
/S/ RICHARD D. ALDRIDGE
 
Director
 
March 15, 2012
Richard D. Aldridge
       
         
         
/S/ DONALD E. BENSON
 
Director
 
March 15, 2012
Donald E. Benson
       
         
/S/ JOHN W. BIRCHFIELD
 
Director
 
March 15, 2012
John W. Birchfield
       
         
/S/ JOSEPH N. COHEN
 
Director
 
March 15, 2012
Joseph N. Cohen
       
         
/S/ ROBERT E. GIPSON
 
Chairman of the Board of Directors
 
March 15, 2012
Robert E. Gipson
       
 
 
122

 
 
Signature
 
Title
 
Date
         
/S/ ANTOINETTE HUBENETTE, M.D.
 
Director
 
March 15, 2012
Antoinette Hubenette, M.D.
       
         
/S/ THOMAS TIGNINO
 
Director
 
March 15, 2012
Thomas Tignino
       

 
123